1 /* vi:set ts=8 sts=4 sw=4:
3 * VIM - Vi IMproved by Bram Moolenaar
5 * Do ":help uganda" in Vim to read copying and usage conditions.
6 * Do ":help credits" in Vim to see a list of people who contributed.
7 * See README.txt for an overview of the Vim source code.
11 * spell.c: code for spell checking
13 * The spell checking mechanism uses a tree (aka trie). Each node in the tree
14 * has a list of bytes that can appear (siblings). For each byte there is a
15 * pointer to the node with the byte that follows in the word (child).
17 * A NUL byte is used where the word may end. The bytes are sorted, so that
18 * binary searching can be used and the NUL bytes are at the start. The
19 * number of possible bytes is stored before the list of bytes.
21 * The tree uses two arrays: "byts" stores the characters, "idxs" stores
22 * either the next index or flags. The tree starts at index 0. For example,
23 * to lookup "vi" this sequence is followed:
26 * n = where "v" appears in byts[i + 1] to byts[i + len]
29 * n = where "i" appears in byts[i + 1] to byts[i + len]
32 * find that byts[i + 1] is 0, idxs[i + 1] has flags for "vi".
34 * There are two word trees: one with case-folded words and one with words in
35 * original case. The second one is only used for keep-case words and is
38 * There is one additional tree for when not all prefixes are applied when
39 * generating the .spl file. This tree stores all the possible prefixes, as
40 * if they were words. At each word (prefix) end the prefix nr is stored, the
41 * following word must support this prefix nr. And the condition nr is
42 * stored, used to lookup the condition that the word must match with.
44 * Thanks to Olaf Seibert for providing an example implementation of this tree
45 * and the compression mechanism.
47 * http://www.irb.hr/hr/home/ristov/papers/RistovLZtrieRevision1.pdf
48 * More papers: http://www-igm.univ-mlv.fr/~laporte/publi_en.html
50 * Matching involves checking the caps type: Onecap ALLCAP KeepCap.
52 * Why doesn't Vim use aspell/ispell/myspell/etc.?
53 * See ":help develop-spell".
56 /* Use SPELL_PRINTTREE for debugging: dump the word tree after adding a word.
57 * Only use it for small word lists! */
59 # define SPELL_PRINTTREE
62 /* Use DEBUG_TRIEWALK to print the changes made in suggest_trie_walk() for a
65 # define DEBUG_TRIEWALK
69 * Use this to adjust the score after finding suggestions, based on the
70 * suggested word sounding like the bad word. This is much faster than doing
71 * it for every possible suggestion.
72 * Disadvantage: When "the" is typed as "hte" it sounds quite different ("@"
73 * vs "ht") and goes down in the list.
74 * Used when 'spellsuggest' is set to "best".
76 #define RESCORE(word_score, sound_score) ((3 * word_score + sound_score) / 4)
79 * Do the opposite: based on a maximum end score and a known sound score,
80 * compute the the maximum word score that can be used.
82 #define MAXSCORE(word_score, sound_score) ((4 * word_score - sound_score) / 3)
85 * Vim spell file format: <HEADER>
91 * <HEADER>: <fileID> <versionnr>
93 * <fileID> 8 bytes "VIMspell"
94 * <versionnr> 1 byte VIMSPELLVERSION
97 * Sections make it possible to add information to the .spl file without
98 * making it incompatible with previous versions. There are two kinds of
100 * 1. Not essential for correct spell checking. E.g. for making suggestions.
101 * These are skipped when not supported.
102 * 2. Optional information, but essential for spell checking when present.
103 * E.g. conditions for affixes. When this section is present but not
104 * supported an error message is given.
106 * <SECTIONS>: <section> ... <sectionend>
108 * <section>: <sectionID> <sectionflags> <sectionlen> (section contents)
110 * <sectionID> 1 byte number from 0 to 254 identifying the section
112 * <sectionflags> 1 byte SNF_REQUIRED: this section is required for correct
115 * <sectionlen> 4 bytes length of section contents, MSB first
117 * <sectionend> 1 byte SN_END
120 * sectionID == SN_INFO: <infotext>
121 * <infotext> N bytes free format text with spell file info (version,
124 * sectionID == SN_REGION: <regionname> ...
125 * <regionname> 2 bytes Up to 8 region names: ca, au, etc. Lower case.
126 * First <regionname> is region 1.
128 * sectionID == SN_CHARFLAGS: <charflagslen> <charflags>
129 * <folcharslen> <folchars>
130 * <charflagslen> 1 byte Number of bytes in <charflags> (should be 128).
131 * <charflags> N bytes List of flags (first one is for character 128):
132 * 0x01 word character CF_WORD
133 * 0x02 upper-case character CF_UPPER
134 * <folcharslen> 2 bytes Number of bytes in <folchars>.
135 * <folchars> N bytes Folded characters, first one is for character 128.
137 * sectionID == SN_MIDWORD: <midword>
138 * <midword> N bytes Characters that are word characters only when used
139 * in the middle of a word.
141 * sectionID == SN_PREFCOND: <prefcondcnt> <prefcond> ...
142 * <prefcondcnt> 2 bytes Number of <prefcond> items following.
143 * <prefcond> : <condlen> <condstr>
144 * <condlen> 1 byte Length of <condstr>.
145 * <condstr> N bytes Condition for the prefix.
147 * sectionID == SN_REP: <repcount> <rep> ...
148 * <repcount> 2 bytes number of <rep> items, MSB first.
149 * <rep> : <repfromlen> <repfrom> <reptolen> <repto>
150 * <repfromlen> 1 byte length of <repfrom>
151 * <repfrom> N bytes "from" part of replacement
152 * <reptolen> 1 byte length of <repto>
153 * <repto> N bytes "to" part of replacement
155 * sectionID == SN_REPSAL: <repcount> <rep> ...
156 * just like SN_REP but for soundfolded words
158 * sectionID == SN_SAL: <salflags> <salcount> <sal> ...
159 * <salflags> 1 byte flags for soundsalike conversion:
163 * <salcount> 2 bytes number of <sal> items following
164 * <sal> : <salfromlen> <salfrom> <saltolen> <salto>
165 * <salfromlen> 1 byte length of <salfrom>
166 * <salfrom> N bytes "from" part of soundsalike
167 * <saltolen> 1 byte length of <salto>
168 * <salto> N bytes "to" part of soundsalike
170 * sectionID == SN_SOFO: <sofofromlen> <sofofrom> <sofotolen> <sofoto>
171 * <sofofromlen> 2 bytes length of <sofofrom>
172 * <sofofrom> N bytes "from" part of soundfold
173 * <sofotolen> 2 bytes length of <sofoto>
174 * <sofoto> N bytes "to" part of soundfold
176 * sectionID == SN_SUGFILE: <timestamp>
177 * <timestamp> 8 bytes time in seconds that must match with .sug file
179 * sectionID == SN_NOSPLITSUGS: nothing
181 * sectionID == SN_WORDS: <word> ...
182 * <word> N bytes NUL terminated common word
184 * sectionID == SN_MAP: <mapstr>
185 * <mapstr> N bytes String with sequences of similar characters,
186 * separated by slashes.
188 * sectionID == SN_COMPOUND: <compmax> <compminlen> <compsylmax> <compoptions>
189 * <comppatcount> <comppattern> ... <compflags>
190 * <compmax> 1 byte Maximum nr of words in compound word.
191 * <compminlen> 1 byte Minimal word length for compounding.
192 * <compsylmax> 1 byte Maximum nr of syllables in compound word.
193 * <compoptions> 2 bytes COMP_ flags.
194 * <comppatcount> 2 bytes number of <comppattern> following
195 * <compflags> N bytes Flags from COMPOUNDRULE items, separated by
198 * <comppattern>: <comppatlen> <comppattext>
199 * <comppatlen> 1 byte length of <comppattext>
200 * <comppattext> N bytes end or begin chars from CHECKCOMPOUNDPATTERN
202 * sectionID == SN_NOBREAK: (empty, its presence is what matters)
204 * sectionID == SN_SYLLABLE: <syllable>
205 * <syllable> N bytes String from SYLLABLE item.
207 * <LWORDTREE>: <wordtree>
209 * <KWORDTREE>: <wordtree>
211 * <PREFIXTREE>: <wordtree>
214 * <wordtree>: <nodecount> <nodedata> ...
216 * <nodecount> 4 bytes Number of nodes following. MSB first.
218 * <nodedata>: <siblingcount> <sibling> ...
220 * <siblingcount> 1 byte Number of siblings in this node. The siblings
221 * follow in sorted order.
223 * <sibling>: <byte> [ <nodeidx> <xbyte>
224 * | <flags> [<flags2>] [<region>] [<affixID>]
225 * | [<pflags>] <affixID> <prefcondnr> ]
227 * <byte> 1 byte Byte value of the sibling. Special cases:
228 * BY_NOFLAGS: End of word without flags and for all
230 * For PREFIXTREE <affixID> and
231 * <prefcondnr> follow.
232 * BY_FLAGS: End of word, <flags> follow.
233 * For PREFIXTREE <pflags>, <affixID>
234 * and <prefcondnr> follow.
235 * BY_FLAGS2: End of word, <flags> and <flags2>
236 * follow. Not used in PREFIXTREE.
237 * BY_INDEX: Child of sibling is shared, <nodeidx>
238 * and <xbyte> follow.
240 * <nodeidx> 3 bytes Index of child for this sibling, MSB first.
242 * <xbyte> 1 byte byte value of the sibling.
244 * <flags> 1 byte bitmask of:
245 * WF_ALLCAP word must have only capitals
246 * WF_ONECAP first char of word must be capital
247 * WF_KEEPCAP keep-case word
248 * WF_FIXCAP keep-case word, all caps not allowed
251 * WF_REGION <region> follows
252 * WF_AFX <affixID> follows
254 * <flags2> 1 byte Bitmask of:
255 * WF_HAS_AFF >> 8 word includes affix
256 * WF_NEEDCOMP >> 8 word only valid in compound
257 * WF_NOSUGGEST >> 8 word not used for suggestions
258 * WF_COMPROOT >> 8 word already a compound
259 * WF_NOCOMPBEF >> 8 no compounding before this word
260 * WF_NOCOMPAFT >> 8 no compounding after this word
262 * <pflags> 1 byte bitmask of:
263 * WFP_RARE rare prefix
264 * WFP_NC non-combining prefix
265 * WFP_UP letter after prefix made upper case
267 * <region> 1 byte Bitmask for regions in which word is valid. When
268 * omitted it's valid in all regions.
269 * Lowest bit is for region 1.
271 * <affixID> 1 byte ID of affix that can be used with this word. In
272 * PREFIXTREE used for the required prefix ID.
274 * <prefcondnr> 2 bytes Prefix condition number, index in <prefcond> list
277 * All text characters are in 'encoding', but stored as single bytes.
281 * Vim .sug file format: <SUGHEADER>
285 * <SUGHEADER>: <fileID> <versionnr> <timestamp>
287 * <fileID> 6 bytes "VIMsug"
288 * <versionnr> 1 byte VIMSUGVERSION
289 * <timestamp> 8 bytes timestamp that must match with .spl file
292 * <SUGWORDTREE>: <wordtree> (see above, no flags or region used)
295 * <SUGTABLE>: <sugwcount> <sugline> ...
297 * <sugwcount> 4 bytes number of <sugline> following
299 * <sugline>: <sugnr> ... NUL
301 * <sugnr>: X bytes word number that results in this soundfolded word,
302 * stored as an offset to the previous number in as
303 * few bytes as possible, see offset2bytes())
306 #if defined(MSDOS) || defined(WIN16) || defined(WIN32) || defined(_WIN64)
307 # include "vimio.h" /* for lseek(), must be before vim.h */
312 #if defined(FEAT_SPELL) || defined(PROTO)
314 #ifndef UNIX /* it's in os_unix.h for Unix */
315 # include <time.h> /* for time_t */
318 #define MAXWLEN 250 /* Assume max. word len is this many bytes.
319 Some places assume a word length fits in a
320 byte, thus it can't be above 255. */
322 /* Type used for indexes in the word tree need to be at least 4 bytes. If int
323 * is 8 bytes we could use something smaller, but what? */
330 /* Flags used for a word. Only the lowest byte can be used, the region byte
332 #define WF_REGION 0x01 /* region byte follows */
333 #define WF_ONECAP 0x02 /* word with one capital (or all capitals) */
334 #define WF_ALLCAP 0x04 /* word must be all capitals */
335 #define WF_RARE 0x08 /* rare word */
336 #define WF_BANNED 0x10 /* bad word */
337 #define WF_AFX 0x20 /* affix ID follows */
338 #define WF_FIXCAP 0x40 /* keep-case word, allcap not allowed */
339 #define WF_KEEPCAP 0x80 /* keep-case word */
341 /* for <flags2>, shifted up one byte to be used in wn_flags */
342 #define WF_HAS_AFF 0x0100 /* word includes affix */
343 #define WF_NEEDCOMP 0x0200 /* word only valid in compound */
344 #define WF_NOSUGGEST 0x0400 /* word not to be suggested */
345 #define WF_COMPROOT 0x0800 /* already compounded word, COMPOUNDROOT */
346 #define WF_NOCOMPBEF 0x1000 /* no compounding before this word */
347 #define WF_NOCOMPAFT 0x2000 /* no compounding after this word */
349 /* only used for su_badflags */
350 #define WF_MIXCAP 0x20 /* mix of upper and lower case: macaRONI */
352 #define WF_CAPMASK (WF_ONECAP | WF_ALLCAP | WF_KEEPCAP | WF_FIXCAP)
354 /* flags for <pflags> */
355 #define WFP_RARE 0x01 /* rare prefix */
356 #define WFP_NC 0x02 /* prefix is not combining */
357 #define WFP_UP 0x04 /* to-upper prefix */
358 #define WFP_COMPPERMIT 0x08 /* prefix with COMPOUNDPERMITFLAG */
359 #define WFP_COMPFORBID 0x10 /* prefix with COMPOUNDFORBIDFLAG */
361 /* Flags for postponed prefixes in "sl_pidxs". Must be above affixID (one
362 * byte) and prefcondnr (two bytes). */
363 #define WF_RAREPFX (WFP_RARE << 24) /* rare postponed prefix */
364 #define WF_PFX_NC (WFP_NC << 24) /* non-combining postponed prefix */
365 #define WF_PFX_UP (WFP_UP << 24) /* to-upper postponed prefix */
366 #define WF_PFX_COMPPERMIT (WFP_COMPPERMIT << 24) /* postponed prefix with
367 * COMPOUNDPERMITFLAG */
368 #define WF_PFX_COMPFORBID (WFP_COMPFORBID << 24) /* postponed prefix with
369 * COMPOUNDFORBIDFLAG */
372 /* flags for <compoptions> */
373 #define COMP_CHECKDUP 1 /* CHECKCOMPOUNDDUP */
374 #define COMP_CHECKREP 2 /* CHECKCOMPOUNDREP */
375 #define COMP_CHECKCASE 4 /* CHECKCOMPOUNDCASE */
376 #define COMP_CHECKTRIPLE 8 /* CHECKCOMPOUNDTRIPLE */
378 /* Special byte values for <byte>. Some are only used in the tree for
379 * postponed prefixes, some only in the other trees. This is a bit messy... */
380 #define BY_NOFLAGS 0 /* end of word without flags or region; for
381 * postponed prefix: no <pflags> */
382 #define BY_INDEX 1 /* child is shared, index follows */
383 #define BY_FLAGS 2 /* end of word, <flags> byte follows; for
384 * postponed prefix: <pflags> follows */
385 #define BY_FLAGS2 3 /* end of word, <flags> and <flags2> bytes
386 * follow; never used in prefix tree */
387 #define BY_SPECIAL BY_FLAGS2 /* highest special byte value */
389 /* Info from "REP", "REPSAL" and "SAL" entries in ".aff" file used in si_rep,
390 * si_repsal, sl_rep, and si_sal. Not for sl_sal!
391 * One replacement: from "ft_from" to "ft_to". */
392 typedef struct fromto_S
398 /* Info from "SAL" entries in ".aff" file used in sl_sal.
399 * The info is split for quick processing by spell_soundfold().
400 * Note that "sm_oneof" and "sm_rules" point into sm_lead. */
401 typedef struct salitem_S
403 char_u
*sm_lead
; /* leading letters */
404 int sm_leadlen
; /* length of "sm_lead" */
405 char_u
*sm_oneof
; /* letters from () or NULL */
406 char_u
*sm_rules
; /* rules like ^, $, priority */
407 char_u
*sm_to
; /* replacement. */
409 int *sm_lead_w
; /* wide character copy of "sm_lead" */
410 int *sm_oneof_w
; /* wide character copy of "sm_oneof" */
411 int *sm_to_w
; /* wide character copy of "sm_to" */
416 typedef int salfirst_T
;
418 typedef short salfirst_T
;
421 /* Values for SP_*ERROR are negative, positive values are used by
422 * read_cnt_string(). */
423 #define SP_TRUNCERROR -1 /* spell file truncated error */
424 #define SP_FORMERROR -2 /* format error in spell file */
425 #define SP_OTHERERROR -3 /* other error while reading spell file */
428 * Structure used to store words and other info for one language, loaded from
430 * The main access is through the tree in "sl_fbyts/sl_fidxs", storing the
431 * case-folded words. "sl_kbyts/sl_kidxs" is for keep-case words.
433 * The "byts" array stores the possible bytes in each tree node, preceded by
434 * the number of possible bytes, sorted on byte value:
435 * <len> <byte1> <byte2> ...
436 * The "idxs" array stores the index of the child node corresponding to the
438 * Exception: when the byte is zero, the word may end here and "idxs" holds
439 * the flags, region mask and affixID for the word. There may be several
440 * zeros in sequence for alternative flag/region/affixID combinations.
442 typedef struct slang_S slang_T
;
445 slang_T
*sl_next
; /* next language */
446 char_u
*sl_name
; /* language name "en", "en.rare", "nl", etc. */
447 char_u
*sl_fname
; /* name of .spl file */
448 int sl_add
; /* TRUE if it's a .add file. */
450 char_u
*sl_fbyts
; /* case-folded word bytes */
451 idx_T
*sl_fidxs
; /* case-folded word indexes */
452 char_u
*sl_kbyts
; /* keep-case word bytes */
453 idx_T
*sl_kidxs
; /* keep-case word indexes */
454 char_u
*sl_pbyts
; /* prefix tree word bytes */
455 idx_T
*sl_pidxs
; /* prefix tree word indexes */
457 char_u
*sl_info
; /* infotext string or NULL */
459 char_u sl_regions
[17]; /* table with up to 8 region names plus NUL */
461 char_u
*sl_midword
; /* MIDWORD string or NULL */
463 hashtab_T sl_wordcount
; /* hashtable with word count, wordcount_T */
465 int sl_compmax
; /* COMPOUNDWORDMAX (default: MAXWLEN) */
466 int sl_compminlen
; /* COMPOUNDMIN (default: 0) */
467 int sl_compsylmax
; /* COMPOUNDSYLMAX (default: MAXWLEN) */
468 int sl_compoptions
; /* COMP_* flags */
469 garray_T sl_comppat
; /* CHECKCOMPOUNDPATTERN items */
470 regprog_T
*sl_compprog
; /* COMPOUNDRULE turned into a regexp progrm
471 * (NULL when no compounding) */
472 char_u
*sl_compstartflags
; /* flags for first compound word */
473 char_u
*sl_compallflags
; /* all flags for compound words */
474 char_u sl_nobreak
; /* When TRUE: no spaces between words */
475 char_u
*sl_syllable
; /* SYLLABLE repeatable chars or NULL */
476 garray_T sl_syl_items
; /* syllable items */
478 int sl_prefixcnt
; /* number of items in "sl_prefprog" */
479 regprog_T
**sl_prefprog
; /* table with regprogs for prefixes */
481 garray_T sl_rep
; /* list of fromto_T entries from REP lines */
482 short sl_rep_first
[256]; /* indexes where byte first appears, -1 if
484 garray_T sl_sal
; /* list of salitem_T entries from SAL lines */
485 salfirst_T sl_sal_first
[256]; /* indexes where byte first appears, -1 if
487 int sl_followup
; /* SAL followup */
488 int sl_collapse
; /* SAL collapse_result */
489 int sl_rem_accents
; /* SAL remove_accents */
490 int sl_sofo
; /* SOFOFROM and SOFOTO instead of SAL items:
491 * "sl_sal_first" maps chars, when has_mbyte
492 * "sl_sal" is a list of wide char lists. */
493 garray_T sl_repsal
; /* list of fromto_T entries from REPSAL lines */
494 short sl_repsal_first
[256]; /* sl_rep_first for REPSAL lines */
495 int sl_nosplitsugs
; /* don't suggest splitting a word */
497 /* Info from the .sug file. Loaded on demand. */
498 time_t sl_sugtime
; /* timestamp for .sug file */
499 char_u
*sl_sbyts
; /* soundfolded word bytes */
500 idx_T
*sl_sidxs
; /* soundfolded word indexes */
501 buf_T
*sl_sugbuf
; /* buffer with word number table */
502 int sl_sugloaded
; /* TRUE when .sug file was loaded or failed to
505 int sl_has_map
; /* TRUE if there is a MAP line */
507 hashtab_T sl_map_hash
; /* MAP for multi-byte chars */
508 int sl_map_array
[256]; /* MAP for first 256 chars */
510 char_u sl_map_array
[256]; /* MAP for first 256 chars */
512 hashtab_T sl_sounddone
; /* table with soundfolded words that have
513 handled, see add_sound_suggest() */
516 /* First language that is loaded, start of the linked list of loaded
518 static slang_T
*first_lang
= NULL
;
520 /* Flags used in .spl file for soundsalike flags. */
521 #define SAL_F0LLOWUP 1
522 #define SAL_COLLAPSE 2
523 #define SAL_REM_ACCENTS 4
526 * Structure used in "b_langp", filled from 'spelllang'.
528 typedef struct langp_S
530 slang_T
*lp_slang
; /* info for this language */
531 slang_T
*lp_sallang
; /* language used for sound folding or NULL */
532 slang_T
*lp_replang
; /* language used for REP items or NULL */
533 int lp_region
; /* bitmask for region or REGION_ALL */
536 #define LANGP_ENTRY(ga, i) (((langp_T *)(ga).ga_data) + (i))
538 #define REGION_ALL 0xff /* word valid in all regions */
540 #define VIMSPELLMAGIC "VIMspell" /* string at start of Vim spell file */
541 #define VIMSPELLMAGICL 8
542 #define VIMSPELLVERSION 50
544 #define VIMSUGMAGIC "VIMsug" /* string at start of Vim .sug file */
545 #define VIMSUGMAGICL 6
546 #define VIMSUGVERSION 1
548 /* Section IDs. Only renumber them when VIMSPELLVERSION changes! */
549 #define SN_REGION 0 /* <regionname> section */
550 #define SN_CHARFLAGS 1 /* charflags section */
551 #define SN_MIDWORD 2 /* <midword> section */
552 #define SN_PREFCOND 3 /* <prefcond> section */
553 #define SN_REP 4 /* REP items section */
554 #define SN_SAL 5 /* SAL items section */
555 #define SN_SOFO 6 /* soundfolding section */
556 #define SN_MAP 7 /* MAP items section */
557 #define SN_COMPOUND 8 /* compound words section */
558 #define SN_SYLLABLE 9 /* syllable section */
559 #define SN_NOBREAK 10 /* NOBREAK section */
560 #define SN_SUGFILE 11 /* timestamp for .sug file */
561 #define SN_REPSAL 12 /* REPSAL items section */
562 #define SN_WORDS 13 /* common words */
563 #define SN_NOSPLITSUGS 14 /* don't split word for suggestions */
564 #define SN_INFO 15 /* info section */
565 #define SN_END 255 /* end of sections */
567 #define SNF_REQUIRED 1 /* <sectionflags>: required section */
569 /* Result values. Lower number is accepted over higher one. */
576 /* file used for "zG" and "zW" */
577 static char_u
*int_wordlist
= NULL
;
579 typedef struct wordcount_S
581 short_u wc_count
; /* nr of times word was seen */
582 char_u wc_word
[1]; /* word, actually longer */
585 static wordcount_T dumwc
;
586 #define WC_KEY_OFF (unsigned)(dumwc.wc_word - (char_u *)&dumwc)
587 #define HI2WC(hi) ((wordcount_T *)((hi)->hi_key - WC_KEY_OFF))
588 #define MAXWORDCOUNT 0xffff
591 * Information used when looking for suggestions.
593 typedef struct suginfo_S
595 garray_T su_ga
; /* suggestions, contains "suggest_T" */
596 int su_maxcount
; /* max. number of suggestions displayed */
597 int su_maxscore
; /* maximum score for adding to su_ga */
598 int su_sfmaxscore
; /* idem, for when doing soundfold words */
599 garray_T su_sga
; /* like su_ga, sound-folded scoring */
600 char_u
*su_badptr
; /* start of bad word in line */
601 int su_badlen
; /* length of detected bad word in line */
602 int su_badflags
; /* caps flags for bad word */
603 char_u su_badword
[MAXWLEN
]; /* bad word truncated at su_badlen */
604 char_u su_fbadword
[MAXWLEN
]; /* su_badword case-folded */
605 char_u su_sal_badword
[MAXWLEN
]; /* su_badword soundfolded */
606 hashtab_T su_banned
; /* table with banned words */
607 slang_T
*su_sallang
; /* default language for sound folding */
610 /* One word suggestion. Used in "si_ga". */
611 typedef struct suggest_S
613 char_u
*st_word
; /* suggested word, allocated string */
614 int st_wordlen
; /* STRLEN(st_word) */
615 int st_orglen
; /* length of replaced text */
616 int st_score
; /* lower is better */
617 int st_altscore
; /* used when st_score compares equal */
618 int st_salscore
; /* st_score is for soundalike */
619 int st_had_bonus
; /* bonus already included in score */
620 slang_T
*st_slang
; /* language used for sound folding */
623 #define SUG(ga, i) (((suggest_T *)(ga).ga_data)[i])
625 /* TRUE if a word appears in the list of banned words. */
626 #define WAS_BANNED(su, word) (!HASHITEM_EMPTY(hash_find(&su->su_banned, word)))
628 /* Number of suggestions kept when cleaning up. we need to keep more than
629 * what is displayed, because when rescore_suggestions() is called the score
630 * may change and wrong suggestions may be removed later. */
631 #define SUG_CLEAN_COUNT(su) ((su)->su_maxcount < 130 ? 150 : (su)->su_maxcount + 20)
633 /* Threshold for sorting and cleaning up suggestions. Don't want to keep lots
634 * of suggestions that are not going to be displayed. */
635 #define SUG_MAX_COUNT(su) (SUG_CLEAN_COUNT(su) + 50)
637 /* score for various changes */
638 #define SCORE_SPLIT 149 /* split bad word */
639 #define SCORE_SPLIT_NO 249 /* split bad word with NOSPLITSUGS */
640 #define SCORE_ICASE 52 /* slightly different case */
641 #define SCORE_REGION 200 /* word is for different region */
642 #define SCORE_RARE 180 /* rare word */
643 #define SCORE_SWAP 75 /* swap two characters */
644 #define SCORE_SWAP3 110 /* swap two characters in three */
645 #define SCORE_REP 65 /* REP replacement */
646 #define SCORE_SUBST 93 /* substitute a character */
647 #define SCORE_SIMILAR 33 /* substitute a similar character */
648 #define SCORE_SUBCOMP 33 /* substitute a composing character */
649 #define SCORE_DEL 94 /* delete a character */
650 #define SCORE_DELDUP 66 /* delete a duplicated character */
651 #define SCORE_DELCOMP 28 /* delete a composing character */
652 #define SCORE_INS 96 /* insert a character */
653 #define SCORE_INSDUP 67 /* insert a duplicate character */
654 #define SCORE_INSCOMP 30 /* insert a composing character */
655 #define SCORE_NONWORD 103 /* change non-word to word char */
657 #define SCORE_FILE 30 /* suggestion from a file */
658 #define SCORE_MAXINIT 350 /* Initial maximum score: higher == slower.
659 * 350 allows for about three changes. */
661 #define SCORE_COMMON1 30 /* subtracted for words seen before */
662 #define SCORE_COMMON2 40 /* subtracted for words often seen */
663 #define SCORE_COMMON3 50 /* subtracted for words very often seen */
664 #define SCORE_THRES2 10 /* word count threshold for COMMON2 */
665 #define SCORE_THRES3 100 /* word count threshold for COMMON3 */
667 /* When trying changed soundfold words it becomes slow when trying more than
668 * two changes. With less then two changes it's slightly faster but we miss a
669 * few good suggestions. In rare cases we need to try three of four changes.
671 #define SCORE_SFMAX1 200 /* maximum score for first try */
672 #define SCORE_SFMAX2 300 /* maximum score for second try */
673 #define SCORE_SFMAX3 400 /* maximum score for third try */
675 #define SCORE_BIG SCORE_INS * 3 /* big difference */
676 #define SCORE_MAXMAX 999999 /* accept any score */
677 #define SCORE_LIMITMAX 350 /* for spell_edit_score_limit() */
679 /* for spell_edit_score_limit() we need to know the minimum value of
680 * SCORE_ICASE, SCORE_SWAP, SCORE_DEL, SCORE_SIMILAR and SCORE_INS */
681 #define SCORE_EDIT_MIN SCORE_SIMILAR
684 * Structure to store info for word matching.
686 typedef struct matchinf_S
688 langp_T
*mi_lp
; /* info for language and region */
690 /* pointers to original text to be checked */
691 char_u
*mi_word
; /* start of word being checked */
692 char_u
*mi_end
; /* end of matching word so far */
693 char_u
*mi_fend
; /* next char to be added to mi_fword */
694 char_u
*mi_cend
; /* char after what was used for
697 /* case-folded text */
698 char_u mi_fword
[MAXWLEN
+ 1]; /* mi_word case-folded */
699 int mi_fwordlen
; /* nr of valid bytes in mi_fword */
701 /* for when checking word after a prefix */
702 int mi_prefarridx
; /* index in sl_pidxs with list of
704 int mi_prefcnt
; /* number of entries at mi_prefarridx */
705 int mi_prefixlen
; /* byte length of prefix */
707 int mi_cprefixlen
; /* byte length of prefix in original
710 # define mi_cprefixlen mi_prefixlen /* it's the same value */
713 /* for when checking a compound word */
714 int mi_compoff
; /* start of following word offset */
715 char_u mi_compflags
[MAXWLEN
]; /* flags for compound words used */
716 int mi_complen
; /* nr of compound words used */
717 int mi_compextra
; /* nr of COMPOUNDROOT words */
720 int mi_result
; /* result so far: SP_BAD, SP_OK, etc. */
721 int mi_capflags
; /* WF_ONECAP WF_ALLCAP WF_KEEPCAP */
722 buf_T
*mi_buf
; /* buffer being checked */
725 int mi_result2
; /* "mi_resul" without following word */
726 char_u
*mi_end2
; /* "mi_end" without following word */
730 * The tables used for recognizing word characters according to spelling.
731 * These are only used for the first 256 characters of 'encoding'.
733 typedef struct spelltab_S
735 char_u st_isw
[256]; /* flags: is word char */
736 char_u st_isu
[256]; /* flags: is uppercase char */
737 char_u st_fold
[256]; /* chars: folded case */
738 char_u st_upper
[256]; /* chars: upper case */
741 static spelltab_T spelltab
;
742 static int did_set_spelltab
;
745 #define CF_UPPER 0x02
747 static void clear_spell_chartab
__ARGS((spelltab_T
*sp
));
748 static int set_spell_finish
__ARGS((spelltab_T
*new_st
));
749 static int spell_iswordp
__ARGS((char_u
*p
, buf_T
*buf
));
750 static int spell_iswordp_nmw
__ARGS((char_u
*p
));
752 static int spell_mb_isword_class
__ARGS((int cl
));
753 static int spell_iswordp_w
__ARGS((int *p
, buf_T
*buf
));
755 static int write_spell_prefcond
__ARGS((FILE *fd
, garray_T
*gap
));
758 * For finding suggestions: At each node in the tree these states are tried:
762 STATE_START
= 0, /* At start of node check for NUL bytes (goodword
763 * ends); if badword ends there is a match, otherwise
764 * try splitting word. */
765 STATE_NOPREFIX
, /* try without prefix */
766 STATE_SPLITUNDO
, /* Undo splitting. */
767 STATE_ENDNUL
, /* Past NUL bytes at start of the node. */
768 STATE_PLAIN
, /* Use each byte of the node. */
769 STATE_DEL
, /* Delete a byte from the bad word. */
770 STATE_INS_PREP
, /* Prepare for inserting bytes. */
771 STATE_INS
, /* Insert a byte in the bad word. */
772 STATE_SWAP
, /* Swap two bytes. */
773 STATE_UNSWAP
, /* Undo swap two characters. */
774 STATE_SWAP3
, /* Swap two characters over three. */
775 STATE_UNSWAP3
, /* Undo Swap two characters over three. */
776 STATE_UNROT3L
, /* Undo rotate three characters left */
777 STATE_UNROT3R
, /* Undo rotate three characters right */
778 STATE_REP_INI
, /* Prepare for using REP items. */
779 STATE_REP
, /* Use matching REP items from the .aff file. */
780 STATE_REP_UNDO
, /* Undo a REP item replacement. */
781 STATE_FINAL
/* End of this node. */
785 * Struct to keep the state at each level in suggest_try_change().
787 typedef struct trystate_S
789 state_T ts_state
; /* state at this level, STATE_ */
790 int ts_score
; /* score */
791 idx_T ts_arridx
; /* index in tree array, start of node */
792 short ts_curi
; /* index in list of child nodes */
793 char_u ts_fidx
; /* index in fword[], case-folded bad word */
794 char_u ts_fidxtry
; /* ts_fidx at which bytes may be changed */
795 char_u ts_twordlen
; /* valid length of tword[] */
796 char_u ts_prefixdepth
; /* stack depth for end of prefix or
797 * PFD_PREFIXTREE or PFD_NOPREFIX */
798 char_u ts_flags
; /* TSF_ flags */
800 char_u ts_tcharlen
; /* number of bytes in tword character */
801 char_u ts_tcharidx
; /* current byte index in tword character */
802 char_u ts_isdiff
; /* DIFF_ values */
803 char_u ts_fcharstart
; /* index in fword where badword char started */
805 char_u ts_prewordlen
; /* length of word in "preword[]" */
806 char_u ts_splitoff
; /* index in "tword" after last split */
807 char_u ts_splitfidx
; /* "ts_fidx" at word split */
808 char_u ts_complen
; /* nr of compound words used */
809 char_u ts_compsplit
; /* index for "compflags" where word was spit */
810 char_u ts_save_badflags
; /* su_badflags saved here */
811 char_u ts_delidx
; /* index in fword for char that was deleted,
812 valid when "ts_flags" has TSF_DIDDEL */
815 /* values for ts_isdiff */
816 #define DIFF_NONE 0 /* no different byte (yet) */
817 #define DIFF_YES 1 /* different byte found */
818 #define DIFF_INSERT 2 /* inserting character */
820 /* values for ts_flags */
821 #define TSF_PREFIXOK 1 /* already checked that prefix is OK */
822 #define TSF_DIDSPLIT 2 /* tried split at this point */
823 #define TSF_DIDDEL 4 /* did a delete, "ts_delidx" has index */
825 /* special values ts_prefixdepth */
826 #define PFD_NOPREFIX 0xff /* not using prefixes */
827 #define PFD_PREFIXTREE 0xfe /* walking through the prefix tree */
828 #define PFD_NOTSPECIAL 0xfd /* highest value that's not special */
830 /* mode values for find_word */
831 #define FIND_FOLDWORD 0 /* find word case-folded */
832 #define FIND_KEEPWORD 1 /* find keep-case word */
833 #define FIND_PREFIX 2 /* find word after prefix */
834 #define FIND_COMPOUND 3 /* find case-folded compound word */
835 #define FIND_KEEPCOMPOUND 4 /* find keep-case compound word */
837 static slang_T
*slang_alloc
__ARGS((char_u
*lang
));
838 static void slang_free
__ARGS((slang_T
*lp
));
839 static void slang_clear
__ARGS((slang_T
*lp
));
840 static void slang_clear_sug
__ARGS((slang_T
*lp
));
841 static void find_word
__ARGS((matchinf_T
*mip
, int mode
));
842 static int can_compound
__ARGS((slang_T
*slang
, char_u
*word
, char_u
*flags
));
843 static int valid_word_prefix
__ARGS((int totprefcnt
, int arridx
, int flags
, char_u
*word
, slang_T
*slang
, int cond_req
));
844 static void find_prefix
__ARGS((matchinf_T
*mip
, int mode
));
845 static int fold_more
__ARGS((matchinf_T
*mip
));
846 static int spell_valid_case
__ARGS((int wordflags
, int treeflags
));
847 static int no_spell_checking
__ARGS((win_T
*wp
));
848 static void spell_load_lang
__ARGS((char_u
*lang
));
849 static char_u
*spell_enc
__ARGS((void));
850 static void int_wordlist_spl
__ARGS((char_u
*fname
));
851 static void spell_load_cb
__ARGS((char_u
*fname
, void *cookie
));
852 static slang_T
*spell_load_file
__ARGS((char_u
*fname
, char_u
*lang
, slang_T
*old_lp
, int silent
));
853 static int get2c
__ARGS((FILE *fd
));
854 static int get3c
__ARGS((FILE *fd
));
855 static int get4c
__ARGS((FILE *fd
));
856 static time_t get8c
__ARGS((FILE *fd
));
857 static char_u
*read_cnt_string
__ARGS((FILE *fd
, int cnt_bytes
, int *lenp
));
858 static char_u
*read_string
__ARGS((FILE *fd
, int cnt
));
859 static int read_region_section
__ARGS((FILE *fd
, slang_T
*slang
, int len
));
860 static int read_charflags_section
__ARGS((FILE *fd
));
861 static int read_prefcond_section
__ARGS((FILE *fd
, slang_T
*lp
));
862 static int read_rep_section
__ARGS((FILE *fd
, garray_T
*gap
, short *first
));
863 static int read_sal_section
__ARGS((FILE *fd
, slang_T
*slang
));
864 static int read_words_section
__ARGS((FILE *fd
, slang_T
*lp
, int len
));
865 static void count_common_word
__ARGS((slang_T
*lp
, char_u
*word
, int len
, int count
));
866 static int score_wordcount_adj
__ARGS((slang_T
*slang
, int score
, char_u
*word
, int split
));
867 static int read_sofo_section
__ARGS((FILE *fd
, slang_T
*slang
));
868 static int read_compound
__ARGS((FILE *fd
, slang_T
*slang
, int len
));
869 static int byte_in_str
__ARGS((char_u
*str
, int byte
));
870 static int init_syl_tab
__ARGS((slang_T
*slang
));
871 static int count_syllables
__ARGS((slang_T
*slang
, char_u
*word
));
872 static int set_sofo
__ARGS((slang_T
*lp
, char_u
*from
, char_u
*to
));
873 static void set_sal_first
__ARGS((slang_T
*lp
));
875 static int *mb_str2wide
__ARGS((char_u
*s
));
877 static int spell_read_tree
__ARGS((FILE *fd
, char_u
**bytsp
, idx_T
**idxsp
, int prefixtree
, int prefixcnt
));
878 static idx_T read_tree_node
__ARGS((FILE *fd
, char_u
*byts
, idx_T
*idxs
, int maxidx
, int startidx
, int prefixtree
, int maxprefcondnr
));
879 static void clear_midword
__ARGS((buf_T
*buf
));
880 static void use_midword
__ARGS((slang_T
*lp
, buf_T
*buf
));
881 static int find_region
__ARGS((char_u
*rp
, char_u
*region
));
882 static int captype
__ARGS((char_u
*word
, char_u
*end
));
883 static int badword_captype
__ARGS((char_u
*word
, char_u
*end
));
884 static void spell_reload_one
__ARGS((char_u
*fname
, int added_word
));
885 static void set_spell_charflags
__ARGS((char_u
*flags
, int cnt
, char_u
*upp
));
886 static int set_spell_chartab
__ARGS((char_u
*fol
, char_u
*low
, char_u
*upp
));
887 static int spell_casefold
__ARGS((char_u
*p
, int len
, char_u
*buf
, int buflen
));
888 static int check_need_cap
__ARGS((linenr_T lnum
, colnr_T col
));
889 static void spell_find_suggest
__ARGS((char_u
*badptr
, int badlen
, suginfo_T
*su
, int maxcount
, int banbadword
, int need_cap
, int interactive
));
891 static void spell_suggest_expr
__ARGS((suginfo_T
*su
, char_u
*expr
));
893 static void spell_suggest_file
__ARGS((suginfo_T
*su
, char_u
*fname
));
894 static void spell_suggest_intern
__ARGS((suginfo_T
*su
, int interactive
));
895 static void suggest_load_files
__ARGS((void));
896 static void tree_count_words
__ARGS((char_u
*byts
, idx_T
*idxs
));
897 static void spell_find_cleanup
__ARGS((suginfo_T
*su
));
898 static void onecap_copy
__ARGS((char_u
*word
, char_u
*wcopy
, int upper
));
899 static void allcap_copy
__ARGS((char_u
*word
, char_u
*wcopy
));
900 static void suggest_try_special
__ARGS((suginfo_T
*su
));
901 static void suggest_try_change
__ARGS((suginfo_T
*su
));
902 static void suggest_trie_walk
__ARGS((suginfo_T
*su
, langp_T
*lp
, char_u
*fword
, int soundfold
));
903 static void go_deeper
__ARGS((trystate_T
*stack
, int depth
, int score_add
));
905 static int nofold_len
__ARGS((char_u
*fword
, int flen
, char_u
*word
));
907 static void find_keepcap_word
__ARGS((slang_T
*slang
, char_u
*fword
, char_u
*kword
));
908 static void score_comp_sal
__ARGS((suginfo_T
*su
));
909 static void score_combine
__ARGS((suginfo_T
*su
));
910 static int stp_sal_score
__ARGS((suggest_T
*stp
, suginfo_T
*su
, slang_T
*slang
, char_u
*badsound
));
911 static void suggest_try_soundalike_prep
__ARGS((void));
912 static void suggest_try_soundalike
__ARGS((suginfo_T
*su
));
913 static void suggest_try_soundalike_finish
__ARGS((void));
914 static void add_sound_suggest
__ARGS((suginfo_T
*su
, char_u
*goodword
, int score
, langp_T
*lp
));
915 static int soundfold_find
__ARGS((slang_T
*slang
, char_u
*word
));
916 static void make_case_word
__ARGS((char_u
*fword
, char_u
*cword
, int flags
));
917 static void set_map_str
__ARGS((slang_T
*lp
, char_u
*map
));
918 static int similar_chars
__ARGS((slang_T
*slang
, int c1
, int c2
));
919 static void add_suggestion
__ARGS((suginfo_T
*su
, garray_T
*gap
, char_u
*goodword
, int badlen
, int score
, int altscore
, int had_bonus
, slang_T
*slang
, int maxsf
));
920 static void check_suggestions
__ARGS((suginfo_T
*su
, garray_T
*gap
));
921 static void add_banned
__ARGS((suginfo_T
*su
, char_u
*word
));
922 static void rescore_suggestions
__ARGS((suginfo_T
*su
));
923 static void rescore_one
__ARGS((suginfo_T
*su
, suggest_T
*stp
));
924 static int cleanup_suggestions
__ARGS((garray_T
*gap
, int maxscore
, int keep
));
925 static void spell_soundfold
__ARGS((slang_T
*slang
, char_u
*inword
, int folded
, char_u
*res
));
926 static void spell_soundfold_sofo
__ARGS((slang_T
*slang
, char_u
*inword
, char_u
*res
));
927 static void spell_soundfold_sal
__ARGS((slang_T
*slang
, char_u
*inword
, char_u
*res
));
929 static void spell_soundfold_wsal
__ARGS((slang_T
*slang
, char_u
*inword
, char_u
*res
));
931 static int soundalike_score
__ARGS((char_u
*goodsound
, char_u
*badsound
));
932 static int spell_edit_score
__ARGS((slang_T
*slang
, char_u
*badword
, char_u
*goodword
));
933 static int spell_edit_score_limit
__ARGS((slang_T
*slang
, char_u
*badword
, char_u
*goodword
, int limit
));
935 static int spell_edit_score_limit_w
__ARGS((slang_T
*slang
, char_u
*badword
, char_u
*goodword
, int limit
));
937 static void dump_word
__ARGS((slang_T
*slang
, char_u
*word
, char_u
*pat
, int *dir
, int round
, int flags
, linenr_T lnum
));
938 static linenr_T dump_prefixes
__ARGS((slang_T
*slang
, char_u
*word
, char_u
*pat
, int *dir
, int round
, int flags
, linenr_T startlnum
));
939 static buf_T
*open_spellbuf
__ARGS((void));
940 static void close_spellbuf
__ARGS((buf_T
*buf
));
943 * Use our own character-case definitions, because the current locale may
944 * differ from what the .spl file uses.
945 * These must not be called with negative number!
948 /* Non-multi-byte implementation. */
949 # define SPELL_TOFOLD(c) ((c) < 256 ? spelltab.st_fold[c] : (c))
950 # define SPELL_TOUPPER(c) ((c) < 256 ? spelltab.st_upper[c] : (c))
951 # define SPELL_ISUPPER(c) ((c) < 256 ? spelltab.st_isu[c] : FALSE)
953 # if defined(HAVE_WCHAR_H)
954 # include <wchar.h> /* for towupper() and towlower() */
956 /* Multi-byte implementation. For Unicode we can call utf_*(), but don't do
957 * that for ASCII, because we don't want to use 'casemap' here. Otherwise use
958 * the "w" library function for characters above 255 if available. */
959 # ifdef HAVE_TOWLOWER
960 # define SPELL_TOFOLD(c) (enc_utf8 && (c) >= 128 ? utf_fold(c) \
961 : (c) < 256 ? spelltab.st_fold[c] : towlower(c))
963 # define SPELL_TOFOLD(c) (enc_utf8 && (c) >= 128 ? utf_fold(c) \
964 : (c) < 256 ? spelltab.st_fold[c] : (c))
967 # ifdef HAVE_TOWUPPER
968 # define SPELL_TOUPPER(c) (enc_utf8 && (c) >= 128 ? utf_toupper(c) \
969 : (c) < 256 ? spelltab.st_upper[c] : towupper(c))
971 # define SPELL_TOUPPER(c) (enc_utf8 && (c) >= 128 ? utf_toupper(c) \
972 : (c) < 256 ? spelltab.st_upper[c] : (c))
975 # ifdef HAVE_ISWUPPER
976 # define SPELL_ISUPPER(c) (enc_utf8 && (c) >= 128 ? utf_isupper(c) \
977 : (c) < 256 ? spelltab.st_isu[c] : iswupper(c))
979 # define SPELL_ISUPPER(c) (enc_utf8 && (c) >= 128 ? utf_isupper(c) \
980 : (c) < 256 ? spelltab.st_isu[c] : (FALSE))
985 static char *e_format
= N_("E759: Format error in spell file");
986 static char *e_spell_trunc
= N_("E758: Truncated spell file");
987 static char *e_afftrailing
= N_("Trailing text in %s line %d: %s");
988 static char *e_affname
= N_("Affix name too long in %s line %d: %s");
989 static char *e_affform
= N_("E761: Format error in affix file FOL, LOW or UPP");
990 static char *e_affrange
= N_("E762: Character in FOL, LOW or UPP is out of range");
991 static char *msg_compressing
= N_("Compressing word tree...");
993 /* Remember what "z?" replaced. */
994 static char_u
*repl_from
= NULL
;
995 static char_u
*repl_to
= NULL
;
998 * Main spell-checking function.
999 * "ptr" points to a character that could be the start of a word.
1000 * "*attrp" is set to the highlight index for a badly spelled word. For a
1001 * non-word or when it's OK it remains unchanged.
1002 * This must only be called when 'spelllang' is not empty.
1004 * "capcol" is used to check for a Capitalised word after the end of a
1005 * sentence. If it's zero then perform the check. Return the column where to
1006 * check next, or -1 when no sentence end was found. If it's NULL then don't
1009 * Returns the length of the word in bytes, also when it's OK, so that the
1010 * caller can skip over the word.
1013 spell_check(wp
, ptr
, attrp
, capcol
, docount
)
1014 win_T
*wp
; /* current window */
1017 int *capcol
; /* column to check for Capital */
1018 int docount
; /* count good words */
1020 matchinf_T mi
; /* Most things are put in "mi" so that it can
1021 be passed to functions quickly. */
1022 int nrlen
= 0; /* found a number first */
1024 int wrongcaplen
= 0;
1026 int count_word
= docount
;
1028 /* A word never starts at a space or a control character. Return quickly
1029 * then, skipping over the character. */
1033 /* Return here when loading language files failed. */
1034 if (wp
->w_buffer
->b_langp
.ga_len
== 0)
1037 vim_memset(&mi
, 0, sizeof(matchinf_T
));
1039 /* A number is always OK. Also skip hexadecimal numbers 0xFF99 and
1040 * 0X99FF. But always do check spelling to find "3GPP" and "11
1042 if (*ptr
>= '0' && *ptr
<= '9')
1044 if (*ptr
== '0' && (ptr
[1] == 'x' || ptr
[1] == 'X'))
1045 mi
.mi_end
= skiphex(ptr
+ 2);
1047 mi
.mi_end
= skipdigits(ptr
);
1048 nrlen
= (int)(mi
.mi_end
- ptr
);
1051 /* Find the normal end of the word (until the next non-word character). */
1054 if (spell_iswordp(mi
.mi_fend
, wp
->w_buffer
))
1058 mb_ptr_adv(mi
.mi_fend
);
1059 } while (*mi
.mi_fend
!= NUL
&& spell_iswordp(mi
.mi_fend
, wp
->w_buffer
));
1061 if (capcol
!= NULL
&& *capcol
== 0 && wp
->w_buffer
->b_cap_prog
!= NULL
)
1063 /* Check word starting with capital letter. */
1065 if (!SPELL_ISUPPER(c
))
1066 wrongcaplen
= (int)(mi
.mi_fend
- ptr
);
1072 /* We always use the characters up to the next non-word character,
1073 * also for bad words. */
1074 mi
.mi_end
= mi
.mi_fend
;
1076 /* Check caps type later. */
1077 mi
.mi_buf
= wp
->w_buffer
;
1079 /* case-fold the word with one non-word character, so that we can check
1080 * for the word end. */
1081 if (*mi
.mi_fend
!= NUL
)
1082 mb_ptr_adv(mi
.mi_fend
);
1084 (void)spell_casefold(ptr
, (int)(mi
.mi_fend
- ptr
), mi
.mi_fword
,
1086 mi
.mi_fwordlen
= (int)STRLEN(mi
.mi_fword
);
1088 /* The word is bad unless we recognize it. */
1089 mi
.mi_result
= SP_BAD
;
1090 mi
.mi_result2
= SP_BAD
;
1093 * Loop over the languages specified in 'spelllang'.
1094 * We check them all, because a word may be matched longer in another
1097 for (lpi
= 0; lpi
< wp
->w_buffer
->b_langp
.ga_len
; ++lpi
)
1099 mi
.mi_lp
= LANGP_ENTRY(wp
->w_buffer
->b_langp
, lpi
);
1101 /* If reloading fails the language is still in the list but everything
1102 * has been cleared. */
1103 if (mi
.mi_lp
->lp_slang
->sl_fidxs
== NULL
)
1106 /* Check for a matching word in case-folded words. */
1107 find_word(&mi
, FIND_FOLDWORD
);
1109 /* Check for a matching word in keep-case words. */
1110 find_word(&mi
, FIND_KEEPWORD
);
1112 /* Check for matching prefixes. */
1113 find_prefix(&mi
, FIND_FOLDWORD
);
1115 /* For a NOBREAK language, may want to use a word without a following
1116 * word as a backup. */
1117 if (mi
.mi_lp
->lp_slang
->sl_nobreak
&& mi
.mi_result
== SP_BAD
1118 && mi
.mi_result2
!= SP_BAD
)
1120 mi
.mi_result
= mi
.mi_result2
;
1121 mi
.mi_end
= mi
.mi_end2
;
1124 /* Count the word in the first language where it's found to be OK. */
1125 if (count_word
&& mi
.mi_result
== SP_OK
)
1127 count_common_word(mi
.mi_lp
->lp_slang
, ptr
,
1128 (int)(mi
.mi_end
- ptr
), 1);
1133 if (mi
.mi_result
!= SP_OK
)
1135 /* If we found a number skip over it. Allows for "42nd". Do flag
1136 * rare and local words, e.g., "3GPP". */
1139 if (mi
.mi_result
== SP_BAD
|| mi
.mi_result
== SP_BANNED
)
1143 /* When we are at a non-word character there is no error, just
1144 * skip over the character (try looking for a word after it). */
1145 else if (!spell_iswordp_nmw(ptr
))
1147 if (capcol
!= NULL
&& wp
->w_buffer
->b_cap_prog
!= NULL
)
1149 regmatch_T regmatch
;
1151 /* Check for end of sentence. */
1152 regmatch
.regprog
= wp
->w_buffer
->b_cap_prog
;
1153 regmatch
.rm_ic
= FALSE
;
1154 if (vim_regexec(®match
, ptr
, 0))
1155 *capcol
= (int)(regmatch
.endp
[0] - ptr
);
1160 return (*mb_ptr2len
)(ptr
);
1164 else if (mi
.mi_end
== ptr
)
1165 /* Always include at least one character. Required for when there
1166 * is a mixup in "midword". */
1167 mb_ptr_adv(mi
.mi_end
);
1168 else if (mi
.mi_result
== SP_BAD
1169 && LANGP_ENTRY(wp
->w_buffer
->b_langp
, 0)->lp_slang
->sl_nobreak
)
1172 int save_result
= mi
.mi_result
;
1174 /* First language in 'spelllang' is NOBREAK. Find first position
1175 * at which any word would be valid. */
1176 mi
.mi_lp
= LANGP_ENTRY(wp
->w_buffer
->b_langp
, 0);
1177 if (mi
.mi_lp
->lp_slang
->sl_fidxs
!= NULL
)
1187 mi
.mi_compoff
= (int)(fp
- mi
.mi_fword
);
1188 find_word(&mi
, FIND_COMPOUND
);
1189 if (mi
.mi_result
!= SP_BAD
)
1195 mi
.mi_result
= save_result
;
1199 if (mi
.mi_result
== SP_BAD
|| mi
.mi_result
== SP_BANNED
)
1201 else if (mi
.mi_result
== SP_RARE
)
1207 if (wrongcaplen
> 0 && (mi
.mi_result
== SP_OK
|| mi
.mi_result
== SP_RARE
))
1209 /* Report SpellCap only when the word isn't badly spelled. */
1214 return (int)(mi
.mi_end
- ptr
);
1218 * Check if the word at "mip->mi_word" is in the tree.
1219 * When "mode" is FIND_FOLDWORD check in fold-case word tree.
1220 * When "mode" is FIND_KEEPWORD check in keep-case word tree.
1221 * When "mode" is FIND_PREFIX check for word after prefix in fold-case word
1224 * For a match mip->mi_result is updated.
1227 find_word(mip
, mode
)
1232 int endlen
[MAXWLEN
]; /* length at possible word endings */
1233 idx_T endidx
[MAXWLEN
]; /* possible word endings */
1246 slang_T
*slang
= mip
->mi_lp
->lp_slang
;
1254 if (mode
== FIND_KEEPWORD
|| mode
== FIND_KEEPCOMPOUND
)
1256 /* Check for word with matching case in keep-case tree. */
1258 flen
= 9999; /* no case folding, always enough bytes */
1259 byts
= slang
->sl_kbyts
;
1260 idxs
= slang
->sl_kidxs
;
1262 if (mode
== FIND_KEEPCOMPOUND
)
1263 /* Skip over the previously found word(s). */
1264 wlen
+= mip
->mi_compoff
;
1268 /* Check for case-folded in case-folded tree. */
1269 ptr
= mip
->mi_fword
;
1270 flen
= mip
->mi_fwordlen
; /* available case-folded bytes */
1271 byts
= slang
->sl_fbyts
;
1272 idxs
= slang
->sl_fidxs
;
1274 if (mode
== FIND_PREFIX
)
1276 /* Skip over the prefix. */
1277 wlen
= mip
->mi_prefixlen
;
1278 flen
-= mip
->mi_prefixlen
;
1280 else if (mode
== FIND_COMPOUND
)
1282 /* Skip over the previously found word(s). */
1283 wlen
= mip
->mi_compoff
;
1284 flen
-= mip
->mi_compoff
;
1290 return; /* array is empty */
1293 * Repeat advancing in the tree until:
1294 * - there is a byte that doesn't match,
1295 * - we reach the end of the tree,
1296 * - or we reach the end of the line.
1300 if (flen
<= 0 && *mip
->mi_fend
!= NUL
)
1301 flen
= fold_more(mip
);
1303 len
= byts
[arridx
++];
1305 /* If the first possible byte is a zero the word could end here.
1306 * Remember this index, we first check for the longest word. */
1307 if (byts
[arridx
] == 0)
1309 if (endidxcnt
== MAXWLEN
)
1311 /* Must be a corrupted spell file. */
1315 endlen
[endidxcnt
] = wlen
;
1316 endidx
[endidxcnt
++] = arridx
++;
1319 /* Skip over the zeros, there can be several flag/region
1321 while (len
> 0 && byts
[arridx
] == 0)
1327 break; /* no children, word must end here */
1330 /* Stop looking at end of the line. */
1331 if (ptr
[wlen
] == NUL
)
1334 /* Perform a binary search in the list of accepted bytes. */
1336 if (c
== TAB
) /* <Tab> is handled like <Space> */
1339 hi
= arridx
+ len
- 1;
1345 else if (byts
[m
] < c
)
1354 /* Stop if there is no matching byte. */
1355 if (hi
< lo
|| byts
[lo
] != c
)
1358 /* Continue at the child (if there is one). */
1363 /* One space in the good word may stand for several spaces in the
1369 if (flen
<= 0 && *mip
->mi_fend
!= NUL
)
1370 flen
= fold_more(mip
);
1371 if (ptr
[wlen
] != ' ' && ptr
[wlen
] != TAB
)
1380 * Verify that one of the possible endings is valid. Try the longest
1383 while (endidxcnt
> 0)
1386 arridx
= endidx
[endidxcnt
];
1387 wlen
= endlen
[endidxcnt
];
1390 if ((*mb_head_off
)(ptr
, ptr
+ wlen
) > 0)
1391 continue; /* not at first byte of character */
1393 if (spell_iswordp(ptr
+ wlen
, mip
->mi_buf
))
1395 if (slang
->sl_compprog
== NULL
&& !slang
->sl_nobreak
)
1396 continue; /* next char is a word character */
1401 /* The prefix flag is before compound flags. Once a valid prefix flag
1402 * has been found we try compound flags. */
1403 prefix_found
= FALSE
;
1406 if (mode
!= FIND_KEEPWORD
&& has_mbyte
)
1408 /* Compute byte length in original word, length may change
1409 * when folding case. This can be slow, take a shortcut when the
1410 * case-folded word is equal to the keep-case word. */
1412 if (STRNCMP(ptr
, p
, wlen
) != 0)
1414 for (s
= ptr
; s
< ptr
+ wlen
; mb_ptr_adv(s
))
1416 wlen
= (int)(p
- mip
->mi_word
);
1421 /* Check flags and region. For FIND_PREFIX check the condition and
1423 * Repeat this if there are more flags/region alternatives until there
1426 for (len
= byts
[arridx
- 1]; len
> 0 && byts
[arridx
] == 0;
1429 flags
= idxs
[arridx
];
1431 /* For the fold-case tree check that the case of the checked word
1432 * matches with what the word in the tree requires.
1433 * For keep-case tree the case is always right. For prefixes we
1434 * don't bother to check. */
1435 if (mode
== FIND_FOLDWORD
)
1437 if (mip
->mi_cend
!= mip
->mi_word
+ wlen
)
1439 /* mi_capflags was set for a different word length, need
1440 * to do it again. */
1441 mip
->mi_cend
= mip
->mi_word
+ wlen
;
1442 mip
->mi_capflags
= captype(mip
->mi_word
, mip
->mi_cend
);
1445 if (mip
->mi_capflags
== WF_KEEPCAP
1446 || !spell_valid_case(mip
->mi_capflags
, flags
))
1450 /* When mode is FIND_PREFIX the word must support the prefix:
1451 * check the prefix ID and the condition. Do that for the list at
1452 * mip->mi_prefarridx that find_prefix() filled. */
1453 else if (mode
== FIND_PREFIX
&& !prefix_found
)
1455 c
= valid_word_prefix(mip
->mi_prefcnt
, mip
->mi_prefarridx
,
1457 mip
->mi_word
+ mip
->mi_cprefixlen
, slang
,
1462 /* Use the WF_RARE flag for a rare prefix. */
1465 prefix_found
= TRUE
;
1468 if (slang
->sl_nobreak
)
1470 if ((mode
== FIND_COMPOUND
|| mode
== FIND_KEEPCOMPOUND
)
1471 && (flags
& WF_BANNED
) == 0)
1473 /* NOBREAK: found a valid following word. That's all we
1474 * need to know, so return. */
1475 mip
->mi_result
= SP_OK
;
1480 else if ((mode
== FIND_COMPOUND
|| mode
== FIND_KEEPCOMPOUND
1483 /* If there is no compound flag or the word is shorter than
1484 * COMPOUNDMIN reject it quickly.
1485 * Makes you wonder why someone puts a compound flag on a word
1486 * that's too short... Myspell compatibility requires this
1488 if (((unsigned)flags
>> 24) == 0
1489 || wlen
- mip
->mi_compoff
< slang
->sl_compminlen
)
1492 /* For multi-byte chars check character length against
1495 && slang
->sl_compminlen
> 0
1496 && mb_charlen_len(mip
->mi_word
+ mip
->mi_compoff
,
1497 wlen
- mip
->mi_compoff
) < slang
->sl_compminlen
)
1501 /* Limit the number of compound words to COMPOUNDWORDMAX if no
1502 * maximum for syllables is specified. */
1503 if (!word_ends
&& mip
->mi_complen
+ mip
->mi_compextra
+ 2
1505 && slang
->sl_compsylmax
== MAXWLEN
)
1508 /* Don't allow compounding on a side where an affix was added,
1509 * unless COMPOUNDPERMITFLAG was used. */
1510 if (mip
->mi_complen
> 0 && (flags
& WF_NOCOMPBEF
))
1512 if (!word_ends
&& (flags
& WF_NOCOMPAFT
))
1515 /* Quickly check if compounding is possible with this flag. */
1516 if (!byte_in_str(mip
->mi_complen
== 0
1517 ? slang
->sl_compstartflags
1518 : slang
->sl_compallflags
,
1519 ((unsigned)flags
>> 24)))
1522 if (mode
== FIND_COMPOUND
)
1526 /* Need to check the caps type of the appended compound
1529 if (has_mbyte
&& STRNCMP(ptr
, mip
->mi_word
,
1530 mip
->mi_compoff
) != 0)
1532 /* case folding may have changed the length */
1534 for (s
= ptr
; s
< ptr
+ mip
->mi_compoff
; mb_ptr_adv(s
))
1539 p
= mip
->mi_word
+ mip
->mi_compoff
;
1540 capflags
= captype(p
, mip
->mi_word
+ wlen
);
1541 if (capflags
== WF_KEEPCAP
|| (capflags
== WF_ALLCAP
1542 && (flags
& WF_FIXCAP
) != 0))
1545 if (capflags
!= WF_ALLCAP
)
1547 /* When the character before the word is a word
1548 * character we do not accept a Onecap word. We do
1549 * accept a no-caps word, even when the dictionary
1550 * word specifies ONECAP. */
1551 mb_ptr_back(mip
->mi_word
, p
);
1552 if (spell_iswordp_nmw(p
)
1553 ? capflags
== WF_ONECAP
1554 : (flags
& WF_ONECAP
) != 0
1555 && capflags
!= WF_ONECAP
)
1560 /* If the word ends the sequence of compound flags of the
1561 * words must match with one of the COMPOUNDRULE items and
1562 * the number of syllables must not be too large. */
1563 mip
->mi_compflags
[mip
->mi_complen
] = ((unsigned)flags
>> 24);
1564 mip
->mi_compflags
[mip
->mi_complen
+ 1] = NUL
;
1567 char_u fword
[MAXWLEN
];
1569 if (slang
->sl_compsylmax
< MAXWLEN
)
1571 /* "fword" is only needed for checking syllables. */
1572 if (ptr
== mip
->mi_word
)
1573 (void)spell_casefold(ptr
, wlen
, fword
, MAXWLEN
);
1575 vim_strncpy(fword
, ptr
, endlen
[endidxcnt
]);
1577 if (!can_compound(slang
, fword
, mip
->mi_compflags
))
1582 /* Check NEEDCOMPOUND: can't use word without compounding. */
1583 else if (flags
& WF_NEEDCOMP
)
1586 nobreak_result
= SP_OK
;
1590 int save_result
= mip
->mi_result
;
1591 char_u
*save_end
= mip
->mi_end
;
1592 langp_T
*save_lp
= mip
->mi_lp
;
1595 /* Check that a valid word follows. If there is one and we
1596 * are compounding, it will set "mi_result", thus we are
1597 * always finished here. For NOBREAK we only check that a
1598 * valid word follows.
1600 if (slang
->sl_nobreak
)
1601 mip
->mi_result
= SP_BAD
;
1603 /* Find following word in case-folded tree. */
1604 mip
->mi_compoff
= endlen
[endidxcnt
];
1606 if (has_mbyte
&& mode
== FIND_KEEPWORD
)
1608 /* Compute byte length in case-folded word from "wlen":
1609 * byte length in keep-case word. Length may change when
1610 * folding case. This can be slow, take a shortcut when
1611 * the case-folded word is equal to the keep-case word. */
1613 if (STRNCMP(ptr
, p
, wlen
) != 0)
1615 for (s
= ptr
; s
< ptr
+ wlen
; mb_ptr_adv(s
))
1617 mip
->mi_compoff
= (int)(p
- mip
->mi_fword
);
1621 c
= mip
->mi_compoff
;
1623 if (flags
& WF_COMPROOT
)
1624 ++mip
->mi_compextra
;
1626 /* For NOBREAK we need to try all NOBREAK languages, at least
1627 * to find the ".add" file(s). */
1628 for (lpi
= 0; lpi
< mip
->mi_buf
->b_langp
.ga_len
; ++lpi
)
1630 if (slang
->sl_nobreak
)
1632 mip
->mi_lp
= LANGP_ENTRY(mip
->mi_buf
->b_langp
, lpi
);
1633 if (mip
->mi_lp
->lp_slang
->sl_fidxs
== NULL
1634 || !mip
->mi_lp
->lp_slang
->sl_nobreak
)
1638 find_word(mip
, FIND_COMPOUND
);
1640 /* When NOBREAK any word that matches is OK. Otherwise we
1641 * need to find the longest match, thus try with keep-case
1642 * and prefix too. */
1643 if (!slang
->sl_nobreak
|| mip
->mi_result
== SP_BAD
)
1645 /* Find following word in keep-case tree. */
1646 mip
->mi_compoff
= wlen
;
1647 find_word(mip
, FIND_KEEPCOMPOUND
);
1649 #if 0 /* Disabled, a prefix must not appear halfway a compound word,
1650 unless the COMPOUNDPERMITFLAG is used and then it can't be a
1651 postponed prefix. */
1652 if (!slang
->sl_nobreak
|| mip
->mi_result
== SP_BAD
)
1654 /* Check for following word with prefix. */
1655 mip
->mi_compoff
= c
;
1656 find_prefix(mip
, FIND_COMPOUND
);
1661 if (!slang
->sl_nobreak
)
1665 if (flags
& WF_COMPROOT
)
1666 --mip
->mi_compextra
;
1667 mip
->mi_lp
= save_lp
;
1669 if (slang
->sl_nobreak
)
1671 nobreak_result
= mip
->mi_result
;
1672 mip
->mi_result
= save_result
;
1673 mip
->mi_end
= save_end
;
1677 if (mip
->mi_result
== SP_OK
)
1683 if (flags
& WF_BANNED
)
1685 else if (flags
& WF_REGION
)
1688 if ((mip
->mi_lp
->lp_region
& (flags
>> 16)) != 0)
1693 else if (flags
& WF_RARE
)
1698 /* Always use the longest match and the best result. For NOBREAK
1699 * we separately keep the longest match without a following good
1700 * word as a fall-back. */
1701 if (nobreak_result
== SP_BAD
)
1703 if (mip
->mi_result2
> res
)
1705 mip
->mi_result2
= res
;
1706 mip
->mi_end2
= mip
->mi_word
+ wlen
;
1708 else if (mip
->mi_result2
== res
1709 && mip
->mi_end2
< mip
->mi_word
+ wlen
)
1710 mip
->mi_end2
= mip
->mi_word
+ wlen
;
1712 else if (mip
->mi_result
> res
)
1714 mip
->mi_result
= res
;
1715 mip
->mi_end
= mip
->mi_word
+ wlen
;
1717 else if (mip
->mi_result
== res
&& mip
->mi_end
< mip
->mi_word
+ wlen
)
1718 mip
->mi_end
= mip
->mi_word
+ wlen
;
1720 if (mip
->mi_result
== SP_OK
)
1724 if (mip
->mi_result
== SP_OK
)
1730 * Return TRUE if "flags" is a valid sequence of compound flags and "word"
1731 * does not have too many syllables.
1734 can_compound(slang
, word
, flags
)
1739 regmatch_T regmatch
;
1741 char_u uflags
[MAXWLEN
* 2];
1746 if (slang
->sl_compprog
== NULL
)
1751 /* Need to convert the single byte flags to utf8 characters. */
1753 for (i
= 0; flags
[i
] != NUL
; ++i
)
1754 p
+= mb_char2bytes(flags
[i
], p
);
1761 regmatch
.regprog
= slang
->sl_compprog
;
1762 regmatch
.rm_ic
= FALSE
;
1763 if (!vim_regexec(®match
, p
, 0))
1766 /* Count the number of syllables. This may be slow, do it last. If there
1767 * are too many syllables AND the number of compound words is above
1768 * COMPOUNDWORDMAX then compounding is not allowed. */
1769 if (slang
->sl_compsylmax
< MAXWLEN
1770 && count_syllables(slang
, word
) > slang
->sl_compsylmax
)
1771 return (int)STRLEN(flags
) < slang
->sl_compmax
;
1776 * Return non-zero if the prefix indicated by "arridx" matches with the prefix
1777 * ID in "flags" for the word "word".
1778 * The WF_RAREPFX flag is included in the return value for a rare prefix.
1781 valid_word_prefix(totprefcnt
, arridx
, flags
, word
, slang
, cond_req
)
1782 int totprefcnt
; /* nr of prefix IDs */
1783 int arridx
; /* idx in sl_pidxs[] */
1787 int cond_req
; /* only use prefixes with a condition */
1792 regmatch_T regmatch
;
1795 prefid
= (unsigned)flags
>> 24;
1796 for (prefcnt
= totprefcnt
- 1; prefcnt
>= 0; --prefcnt
)
1798 pidx
= slang
->sl_pidxs
[arridx
+ prefcnt
];
1800 /* Check the prefix ID. */
1801 if (prefid
!= (pidx
& 0xff))
1804 /* Check if the prefix doesn't combine and the word already has a
1806 if ((flags
& WF_HAS_AFF
) && (pidx
& WF_PFX_NC
))
1809 /* Check the condition, if there is one. The condition index is
1810 * stored in the two bytes above the prefix ID byte. */
1811 rp
= slang
->sl_prefprog
[((unsigned)pidx
>> 8) & 0xffff];
1814 regmatch
.regprog
= rp
;
1815 regmatch
.rm_ic
= FALSE
;
1816 if (!vim_regexec(®match
, word
, 0))
1822 /* It's a match! Return the WF_ flags. */
1829 * Check if the word at "mip->mi_word" has a matching prefix.
1830 * If it does, then check the following word.
1832 * If "mode" is "FIND_COMPOUND" then do the same after another word, find a
1833 * prefix in a compound word.
1835 * For a match mip->mi_result is updated.
1838 find_prefix(mip
, mode
)
1849 slang_T
*slang
= mip
->mi_lp
->lp_slang
;
1853 byts
= slang
->sl_pbyts
;
1855 return; /* array is empty */
1857 /* We use the case-folded word here, since prefixes are always
1859 ptr
= mip
->mi_fword
;
1860 flen
= mip
->mi_fwordlen
; /* available case-folded bytes */
1861 if (mode
== FIND_COMPOUND
)
1863 /* Skip over the previously found word(s). */
1864 ptr
+= mip
->mi_compoff
;
1865 flen
-= mip
->mi_compoff
;
1867 idxs
= slang
->sl_pidxs
;
1870 * Repeat advancing in the tree until:
1871 * - there is a byte that doesn't match,
1872 * - we reach the end of the tree,
1873 * - or we reach the end of the line.
1877 if (flen
== 0 && *mip
->mi_fend
!= NUL
)
1878 flen
= fold_more(mip
);
1880 len
= byts
[arridx
++];
1882 /* If the first possible byte is a zero the prefix could end here.
1883 * Check if the following word matches and supports the prefix. */
1884 if (byts
[arridx
] == 0)
1886 /* There can be several prefixes with different conditions. We
1887 * try them all, since we don't know which one will give the
1888 * longest match. The word is the same each time, pass the list
1889 * of possible prefixes to find_word(). */
1890 mip
->mi_prefarridx
= arridx
;
1891 mip
->mi_prefcnt
= len
;
1892 while (len
> 0 && byts
[arridx
] == 0)
1897 mip
->mi_prefcnt
-= len
;
1899 /* Find the word that comes after the prefix. */
1900 mip
->mi_prefixlen
= wlen
;
1901 if (mode
== FIND_COMPOUND
)
1902 /* Skip over the previously found word(s). */
1903 mip
->mi_prefixlen
+= mip
->mi_compoff
;
1908 /* Case-folded length may differ from original length. */
1909 mip
->mi_cprefixlen
= nofold_len(mip
->mi_fword
,
1910 mip
->mi_prefixlen
, mip
->mi_word
);
1913 mip
->mi_cprefixlen
= mip
->mi_prefixlen
;
1915 find_word(mip
, FIND_PREFIX
);
1919 break; /* no children, word must end here */
1922 /* Stop looking at end of the line. */
1923 if (ptr
[wlen
] == NUL
)
1926 /* Perform a binary search in the list of accepted bytes. */
1929 hi
= arridx
+ len
- 1;
1935 else if (byts
[m
] < c
)
1944 /* Stop if there is no matching byte. */
1945 if (hi
< lo
|| byts
[lo
] != c
)
1948 /* Continue at the child (if there is one). */
1956 * Need to fold at least one more character. Do until next non-word character
1957 * for efficiency. Include the non-word character too.
1958 * Return the length of the folded chars in bytes.
1970 mb_ptr_adv(mip
->mi_fend
);
1971 } while (*mip
->mi_fend
!= NUL
&& spell_iswordp(mip
->mi_fend
, mip
->mi_buf
));
1973 /* Include the non-word character so that we can check for the word end. */
1974 if (*mip
->mi_fend
!= NUL
)
1975 mb_ptr_adv(mip
->mi_fend
);
1977 (void)spell_casefold(p
, (int)(mip
->mi_fend
- p
),
1978 mip
->mi_fword
+ mip
->mi_fwordlen
,
1979 MAXWLEN
- mip
->mi_fwordlen
);
1980 flen
= (int)STRLEN(mip
->mi_fword
+ mip
->mi_fwordlen
);
1981 mip
->mi_fwordlen
+= flen
;
1986 * Check case flags for a word. Return TRUE if the word has the requested
1990 spell_valid_case(wordflags
, treeflags
)
1991 int wordflags
; /* flags for the checked word. */
1992 int treeflags
; /* flags for the word in the spell tree */
1994 return ((wordflags
== WF_ALLCAP
&& (treeflags
& WF_FIXCAP
) == 0)
1995 || ((treeflags
& (WF_ALLCAP
| WF_KEEPCAP
)) == 0
1996 && ((treeflags
& WF_ONECAP
) == 0
1997 || (wordflags
& WF_ONECAP
) != 0)));
2001 * Return TRUE if spell checking is not enabled.
2004 no_spell_checking(wp
)
2007 if (!wp
->w_p_spell
|| *wp
->w_buffer
->b_p_spl
== NUL
2008 || wp
->w_buffer
->b_langp
.ga_len
== 0)
2010 EMSG(_("E756: Spell checking is not enabled"));
2017 * Move to next spell error.
2018 * "curline" is FALSE for "[s", "]s", "[S" and "]S".
2019 * "curline" is TRUE to find word under/after cursor in the same line.
2020 * For Insert mode completion "dir" is BACKWARD and "curline" is TRUE: move
2021 * to after badly spelled word before the cursor.
2022 * Return 0 if not found, length of the badly spelled word otherwise.
2025 spell_move_to(wp
, dir
, allwords
, curline
, attrp
)
2027 int dir
; /* FORWARD or BACKWARD */
2028 int allwords
; /* TRUE for "[s"/"]s", FALSE for "[S"/"]S" */
2030 hlf_T
*attrp
; /* return: attributes of bad word or NULL
2031 (only when "dir" is FORWARD) */
2042 int has_syntax
= syntax_present(wp
->w_buffer
);
2050 int found_one
= FALSE
;
2051 int wrapped
= FALSE
;
2053 if (no_spell_checking(wp
))
2057 * Start looking for bad word at the start of the line, because we can't
2058 * start halfway a word, we don't know where it starts or ends.
2060 * When searching backwards, we continue in the line to find the last
2061 * bad word (in the cursor line: before the cursor).
2063 * We concatenate the start of the next line, so that wrapped words work
2064 * (e.g. "et<line-break>cetera"). Doesn't work when searching backwards
2067 lnum
= wp
->w_cursor
.lnum
;
2068 clearpos(&found_pos
);
2072 line
= ml_get_buf(wp
->w_buffer
, lnum
, FALSE
);
2074 len
= (int)STRLEN(line
);
2075 if (buflen
< len
+ MAXWLEN
+ 2)
2078 buflen
= len
+ MAXWLEN
+ 2;
2079 buf
= alloc(buflen
);
2084 /* In first line check first word for Capital. */
2088 /* For checking first word with a capital skip white space. */
2090 capcol
= (int)(skipwhite(line
) - line
);
2091 else if (curline
&& wp
== curwin
)
2093 /* For spellbadword(): check if first word needs a capital. */
2094 col
= (int)(skipwhite(line
) - line
);
2095 if (check_need_cap(lnum
, col
))
2098 /* Need to get the line again, may have looked at the previous
2100 line
= ml_get_buf(wp
->w_buffer
, lnum
, FALSE
);
2103 /* Copy the line into "buf" and append the start of the next line if
2106 if (lnum
< wp
->w_buffer
->b_ml
.ml_line_count
)
2107 spell_cat_line(buf
+ STRLEN(buf
),
2108 ml_get_buf(wp
->w_buffer
, lnum
+ 1, FALSE
), MAXWLEN
);
2114 /* When searching backward don't search after the cursor. Unless
2115 * we wrapped around the end of the buffer. */
2117 && lnum
== wp
->w_cursor
.lnum
2119 && (colnr_T
)(p
- buf
) >= wp
->w_cursor
.col
)
2124 len
= spell_check(wp
, p
, &attr
, &capcol
, FALSE
);
2126 if (attr
!= HLF_COUNT
)
2128 /* We found a bad word. Check the attribute. */
2129 if (allwords
|| attr
== HLF_SPB
)
2131 /* When searching forward only accept a bad word after
2134 || lnum
!= wp
->w_cursor
.lnum
2135 || (lnum
== wp
->w_cursor
.lnum
2137 || (colnr_T
)(curline
? p
- buf
+ len
2139 > wp
->w_cursor
.col
)))
2144 col
= (int)(p
- buf
);
2145 (void)syn_get_id(wp
, lnum
, (colnr_T
)col
,
2146 FALSE
, &can_spell
, FALSE
);
2157 found_pos
.lnum
= lnum
;
2158 found_pos
.col
= (int)(p
- buf
);
2159 #ifdef FEAT_VIRTUALEDIT
2160 found_pos
.coladd
= 0;
2164 /* No need to search further. */
2165 wp
->w_cursor
= found_pos
;
2172 /* Insert mode completion: put cursor after
2174 found_pos
.col
+= len
;
2183 /* advance to character after the word */
2188 if (dir
== BACKWARD
&& found_pos
.lnum
!= 0)
2190 /* Use the last match in the line (before the cursor). */
2191 wp
->w_cursor
= found_pos
;
2197 break; /* only check cursor line */
2199 /* Advance to next line. */
2200 if (dir
== BACKWARD
)
2202 /* If we are back at the starting line and searched it again there
2203 * is no match, give up. */
2204 if (lnum
== wp
->w_cursor
.lnum
&& wrapped
)
2210 break; /* at first line and 'nowrapscan' */
2213 /* Wrap around to the end of the buffer. May search the
2214 * starting line again and accept the last match. */
2215 lnum
= wp
->w_buffer
->b_ml
.ml_line_count
;
2217 if (!shortmess(SHM_SEARCH
))
2218 give_warning((char_u
*)_(top_bot_msg
), TRUE
);
2224 if (lnum
< wp
->w_buffer
->b_ml
.ml_line_count
)
2227 break; /* at first line and 'nowrapscan' */
2230 /* Wrap around to the start of the buffer. May search the
2231 * starting line again and accept the first match. */
2234 if (!shortmess(SHM_SEARCH
))
2235 give_warning((char_u
*)_(bot_top_msg
), TRUE
);
2238 /* If we are back at the starting line and there is no match then
2240 if (lnum
== wp
->w_cursor
.lnum
&& !found_one
)
2243 /* Skip the characters at the start of the next line that were
2244 * included in a match crossing line boundaries. */
2245 if (attr
== HLF_COUNT
)
2246 skip
= (int)(p
- endp
);
2250 /* Capcol skips over the inserted space. */
2253 /* But after empty line check first word in next line */
2254 if (*skipwhite(line
) == NUL
)
2266 * For spell checking: concatenate the start of the following line "line" into
2267 * "buf", blanking-out special characters. Copy less then "maxlen" bytes.
2268 * Keep the blanks at the start of the next line, this is used in win_line()
2269 * to skip those bytes if the word was OK.
2272 spell_cat_line(buf
, line
, maxlen
)
2280 p
= skipwhite(line
);
2281 while (vim_strchr((char_u
*)"*#/\"\t", *p
) != NULL
)
2282 p
= skipwhite(p
+ 1);
2286 /* Only worth concatenating if there is something else than spaces to
2288 n
= (int)(p
- line
) + 1;
2291 vim_memset(buf
, ' ', n
);
2292 vim_strncpy(buf
+ n
, p
, maxlen
- 1 - n
);
2298 * Structure used for the cookie argument of do_in_runtimepath().
2300 typedef struct spelload_S
2302 char_u sl_lang
[MAXWLEN
+ 1]; /* language name */
2303 slang_T
*sl_slang
; /* resulting slang_T struct */
2304 int sl_nobreak
; /* NOBREAK language found */
2308 * Load word list(s) for "lang" from Vim spell file(s).
2309 * "lang" must be the language without the region: e.g., "en".
2312 spell_load_lang(lang
)
2315 char_u fname_enc
[85];
2322 /* Copy the language name to pass it to spell_load_cb() as a cookie.
2323 * It's truncated when an error is detected. */
2324 STRCPY(sl
.sl_lang
, lang
);
2326 sl
.sl_nobreak
= FALSE
;
2329 /* We may retry when no spell file is found for the language, an
2330 * autocommand may load it then. */
2331 for (round
= 1; round
<= 2; ++round
)
2335 * Find the first spell file for "lang" in 'runtimepath' and load it.
2337 vim_snprintf((char *)fname_enc
, sizeof(fname_enc
) - 5,
2338 "spell/%s.%s.spl", lang
, spell_enc());
2339 r
= do_in_runtimepath(fname_enc
, FALSE
, spell_load_cb
, &sl
);
2341 if (r
== FAIL
&& *sl
.sl_lang
!= NUL
)
2343 /* Try loading the ASCII version. */
2344 vim_snprintf((char *)fname_enc
, sizeof(fname_enc
) - 5,
2345 "spell/%s.ascii.spl", lang
);
2346 r
= do_in_runtimepath(fname_enc
, FALSE
, spell_load_cb
, &sl
);
2349 if (r
== FAIL
&& *sl
.sl_lang
!= NUL
&& round
== 1
2350 && apply_autocmds(EVENT_SPELLFILEMISSING
, lang
,
2351 curbuf
->b_fname
, FALSE
, curbuf
))
2363 smsg((char_u
*)_("Warning: Cannot find word list \"%s.%s.spl\" or \"%s.ascii.spl\""),
2364 lang
, spell_enc(), lang
);
2366 else if (sl
.sl_slang
!= NULL
)
2368 /* At least one file was loaded, now load ALL the additions. */
2369 STRCPY(fname_enc
+ STRLEN(fname_enc
) - 3, "add.spl");
2370 do_in_runtimepath(fname_enc
, TRUE
, spell_load_cb
, &sl
);
2375 * Return the encoding used for spell checking: Use 'encoding', except that we
2376 * use "latin1" for "latin9". And limit to 60 characters (just in case).
2383 if (STRLEN(p_enc
) < 60 && STRCMP(p_enc
, "iso-8859-15") != 0)
2386 return (char_u
*)"latin1";
2390 * Get the name of the .spl file for the internal wordlist into
2391 * "fname[MAXPATHL]".
2394 int_wordlist_spl(fname
)
2397 vim_snprintf((char *)fname
, MAXPATHL
, "%s.%s.spl",
2398 int_wordlist
, spell_enc());
2402 * Allocate a new slang_T for language "lang". "lang" can be NULL.
2403 * Caller must fill "sl_next".
2411 lp
= (slang_T
*)alloc_clear(sizeof(slang_T
));
2415 lp
->sl_name
= vim_strsave(lang
);
2416 ga_init2(&lp
->sl_rep
, sizeof(fromto_T
), 10);
2417 ga_init2(&lp
->sl_repsal
, sizeof(fromto_T
), 10);
2418 lp
->sl_compmax
= MAXWLEN
;
2419 lp
->sl_compsylmax
= MAXWLEN
;
2420 hash_init(&lp
->sl_wordcount
);
2427 * Free the contents of an slang_T and the structure itself.
2433 vim_free(lp
->sl_name
);
2434 vim_free(lp
->sl_fname
);
2440 * Clear an slang_T so that the file can be reloaded.
2452 vim_free(lp
->sl_fbyts
);
2453 lp
->sl_fbyts
= NULL
;
2454 vim_free(lp
->sl_kbyts
);
2455 lp
->sl_kbyts
= NULL
;
2456 vim_free(lp
->sl_pbyts
);
2457 lp
->sl_pbyts
= NULL
;
2459 vim_free(lp
->sl_fidxs
);
2460 lp
->sl_fidxs
= NULL
;
2461 vim_free(lp
->sl_kidxs
);
2462 lp
->sl_kidxs
= NULL
;
2463 vim_free(lp
->sl_pidxs
);
2464 lp
->sl_pidxs
= NULL
;
2466 for (round
= 1; round
<= 2; ++round
)
2468 gap
= round
== 1 ? &lp
->sl_rep
: &lp
->sl_repsal
;
2469 while (gap
->ga_len
> 0)
2471 ftp
= &((fromto_T
*)gap
->ga_data
)[--gap
->ga_len
];
2472 vim_free(ftp
->ft_from
);
2473 vim_free(ftp
->ft_to
);
2481 /* "ga_len" is set to 1 without adding an item for latin1 */
2482 if (gap
->ga_data
!= NULL
)
2483 /* SOFOFROM and SOFOTO items: free lists of wide characters. */
2484 for (i
= 0; i
< gap
->ga_len
; ++i
)
2485 vim_free(((int **)gap
->ga_data
)[i
]);
2488 /* SAL items: free salitem_T items */
2489 while (gap
->ga_len
> 0)
2491 smp
= &((salitem_T
*)gap
->ga_data
)[--gap
->ga_len
];
2492 vim_free(smp
->sm_lead
);
2493 /* Don't free sm_oneof and sm_rules, they point into sm_lead. */
2494 vim_free(smp
->sm_to
);
2496 vim_free(smp
->sm_lead_w
);
2497 vim_free(smp
->sm_oneof_w
);
2498 vim_free(smp
->sm_to_w
);
2503 for (i
= 0; i
< lp
->sl_prefixcnt
; ++i
)
2504 vim_free(lp
->sl_prefprog
[i
]);
2505 lp
->sl_prefixcnt
= 0;
2506 vim_free(lp
->sl_prefprog
);
2507 lp
->sl_prefprog
= NULL
;
2509 vim_free(lp
->sl_info
);
2512 vim_free(lp
->sl_midword
);
2513 lp
->sl_midword
= NULL
;
2515 vim_free(lp
->sl_compprog
);
2516 vim_free(lp
->sl_compstartflags
);
2517 vim_free(lp
->sl_compallflags
);
2518 lp
->sl_compprog
= NULL
;
2519 lp
->sl_compstartflags
= NULL
;
2520 lp
->sl_compallflags
= NULL
;
2522 vim_free(lp
->sl_syllable
);
2523 lp
->sl_syllable
= NULL
;
2524 ga_clear(&lp
->sl_syl_items
);
2526 ga_clear_strings(&lp
->sl_comppat
);
2528 hash_clear_all(&lp
->sl_wordcount
, WC_KEY_OFF
);
2529 hash_init(&lp
->sl_wordcount
);
2532 hash_clear_all(&lp
->sl_map_hash
, 0);
2535 /* Clear info from .sug file. */
2536 slang_clear_sug(lp
);
2538 lp
->sl_compmax
= MAXWLEN
;
2539 lp
->sl_compminlen
= 0;
2540 lp
->sl_compsylmax
= MAXWLEN
;
2541 lp
->sl_regions
[0] = NUL
;
2545 * Clear the info from the .sug file in "lp".
2551 vim_free(lp
->sl_sbyts
);
2552 lp
->sl_sbyts
= NULL
;
2553 vim_free(lp
->sl_sidxs
);
2554 lp
->sl_sidxs
= NULL
;
2555 close_spellbuf(lp
->sl_sugbuf
);
2556 lp
->sl_sugbuf
= NULL
;
2557 lp
->sl_sugloaded
= FALSE
;
2562 * Load one spell file and store the info into a slang_T.
2563 * Invoked through do_in_runtimepath().
2566 spell_load_cb(fname
, cookie
)
2570 spelload_T
*slp
= (spelload_T
*)cookie
;
2573 slang
= spell_load_file(fname
, slp
->sl_lang
, NULL
, FALSE
);
2576 /* When a previously loaded file has NOBREAK also use it for the
2578 if (slp
->sl_nobreak
&& slang
->sl_add
)
2579 slang
->sl_nobreak
= TRUE
;
2580 else if (slang
->sl_nobreak
)
2581 slp
->sl_nobreak
= TRUE
;
2583 slp
->sl_slang
= slang
;
2588 * Load one spell file and store the info into a slang_T.
2590 * This is invoked in three ways:
2591 * - From spell_load_cb() to load a spell file for the first time. "lang" is
2592 * the language name, "old_lp" is NULL. Will allocate an slang_T.
2593 * - To reload a spell file that was changed. "lang" is NULL and "old_lp"
2594 * points to the existing slang_T.
2595 * - Just after writing a .spl file; it's read back to produce the .sug file.
2596 * "old_lp" is NULL and "lang" is NULL. Will allocate an slang_T.
2598 * Returns the slang_T the spell file was loaded into. NULL for error.
2601 spell_load_file(fname
, lang
, old_lp
, silent
)
2605 int silent
; /* no error if file doesn't exist */
2608 char_u buf
[VIMSPELLMAGICL
];
2613 char_u
*save_sourcing_name
= sourcing_name
;
2614 linenr_T save_sourcing_lnum
= sourcing_lnum
;
2619 fd
= mch_fopen((char *)fname
, "r");
2623 EMSG2(_(e_notopen
), fname
);
2624 else if (p_verbose
> 2)
2627 smsg((char_u
*)e_notopen
, fname
);
2635 smsg((char_u
*)_("Reading spell file \"%s\""), fname
);
2641 lp
= slang_alloc(lang
);
2645 /* Remember the file name, used to reload the file when it's updated. */
2646 lp
->sl_fname
= vim_strsave(fname
);
2647 if (lp
->sl_fname
== NULL
)
2650 /* Check for .add.spl. */
2651 lp
->sl_add
= strstr((char *)gettail(fname
), ".add.") != NULL
;
2656 /* Set sourcing_name, so that error messages mention the file name. */
2657 sourcing_name
= fname
;
2661 * <HEADER>: <fileID>
2663 for (i
= 0; i
< VIMSPELLMAGICL
; ++i
)
2664 buf
[i
] = getc(fd
); /* <fileID> */
2665 if (STRNCMP(buf
, VIMSPELLMAGIC
, VIMSPELLMAGICL
) != 0)
2667 EMSG(_("E757: This does not look like a spell file"));
2670 c
= getc(fd
); /* <versionnr> */
2671 if (c
< VIMSPELLVERSION
)
2673 EMSG(_("E771: Old spell file, needs to be updated"));
2676 else if (c
> VIMSPELLVERSION
)
2678 EMSG(_("E772: Spell file is for newer version of Vim"));
2684 * <SECTIONS>: <section> ... <sectionend>
2685 * <section>: <sectionID> <sectionflags> <sectionlen> (section contents)
2689 n
= getc(fd
); /* <sectionID> or <sectionend> */
2692 c
= getc(fd
); /* <sectionflags> */
2693 len
= get4c(fd
); /* <sectionlen> */
2701 lp
->sl_info
= read_string(fd
, len
); /* <infotext> */
2702 if (lp
->sl_info
== NULL
)
2707 res
= read_region_section(fd
, lp
, len
);
2711 res
= read_charflags_section(fd
);
2715 lp
->sl_midword
= read_string(fd
, len
); /* <midword> */
2716 if (lp
->sl_midword
== NULL
)
2721 res
= read_prefcond_section(fd
, lp
);
2725 res
= read_rep_section(fd
, &lp
->sl_rep
, lp
->sl_rep_first
);
2729 res
= read_rep_section(fd
, &lp
->sl_repsal
, lp
->sl_repsal_first
);
2733 res
= read_sal_section(fd
, lp
);
2737 res
= read_sofo_section(fd
, lp
);
2741 p
= read_string(fd
, len
); /* <mapstr> */
2749 res
= read_words_section(fd
, lp
, len
);
2753 lp
->sl_sugtime
= get8c(fd
); /* <timestamp> */
2756 case SN_NOSPLITSUGS
:
2757 lp
->sl_nosplitsugs
= TRUE
; /* <timestamp> */
2761 res
= read_compound(fd
, lp
, len
);
2765 lp
->sl_nobreak
= TRUE
;
2769 lp
->sl_syllable
= read_string(fd
, len
); /* <syllable> */
2770 if (lp
->sl_syllable
== NULL
)
2772 if (init_syl_tab(lp
) == FAIL
)
2777 /* Unsupported section. When it's required give an error
2778 * message. When it's not required skip the contents. */
2779 if (c
& SNF_REQUIRED
)
2781 EMSG(_("E770: Unsupported section in spell file"));
2790 if (res
== SP_FORMERROR
)
2795 if (res
== SP_TRUNCERROR
)
2798 EMSG(_(e_spell_trunc
));
2801 if (res
== SP_OTHERERROR
)
2806 res
= spell_read_tree(fd
, &lp
->sl_fbyts
, &lp
->sl_fidxs
, FALSE
, 0);
2811 res
= spell_read_tree(fd
, &lp
->sl_kbyts
, &lp
->sl_kidxs
, FALSE
, 0);
2816 res
= spell_read_tree(fd
, &lp
->sl_pbyts
, &lp
->sl_pidxs
, TRUE
,
2821 /* For a new file link it in the list of spell files. */
2822 if (old_lp
== NULL
&& lang
!= NULL
)
2824 lp
->sl_next
= first_lang
;
2832 /* truncating the name signals the error to spell_load_lang() */
2834 if (lp
!= NULL
&& old_lp
== NULL
)
2841 sourcing_name
= save_sourcing_name
;
2842 sourcing_lnum
= save_sourcing_lnum
;
2848 * Read 2 bytes from "fd" and turn them into an int, MSB first.
2857 n
= (n
<< 8) + getc(fd
);
2862 * Read 3 bytes from "fd" and turn them into an int, MSB first.
2871 n
= (n
<< 8) + getc(fd
);
2872 n
= (n
<< 8) + getc(fd
);
2877 * Read 4 bytes from "fd" and turn them into an int, MSB first.
2886 n
= (n
<< 8) + getc(fd
);
2887 n
= (n
<< 8) + getc(fd
);
2888 n
= (n
<< 8) + getc(fd
);
2893 * Read 8 bytes from "fd" and turn them into a time_t, MSB first.
2902 for (i
= 0; i
< 8; ++i
)
2903 n
= (n
<< 8) + getc(fd
);
2908 * Read a length field from "fd" in "cnt_bytes" bytes.
2909 * Allocate memory, read the string into it and add a NUL at the end.
2910 * Returns NULL when the count is zero.
2911 * Sets "*cntp" to SP_*ERROR when there is an error, length of the result
2915 read_cnt_string(fd
, cnt_bytes
, cntp
)
2924 /* read the length bytes, MSB first */
2925 for (i
= 0; i
< cnt_bytes
; ++i
)
2926 cnt
= (cnt
<< 8) + getc(fd
);
2929 *cntp
= SP_TRUNCERROR
;
2934 return NULL
; /* nothing to read, return NULL */
2936 str
= read_string(fd
, cnt
);
2938 *cntp
= SP_OTHERERROR
;
2943 * Read a string of length "cnt" from "fd" into allocated memory.
2944 * Returns NULL when out of memory or unable to read that many bytes.
2947 read_string(fd
, cnt
)
2955 /* allocate memory */
2956 str
= alloc((unsigned)cnt
+ 1);
2959 /* Read the string. Quit when running into the EOF. */
2960 for (i
= 0; i
< cnt
; ++i
)
2976 * Read SN_REGION: <regionname> ...
2977 * Return SP_*ERROR flags.
2980 read_region_section(fd
, lp
, len
)
2988 return SP_FORMERROR
;
2989 for (i
= 0; i
< len
; ++i
)
2990 lp
->sl_regions
[i
] = getc(fd
); /* <regionname> */
2991 lp
->sl_regions
[len
] = NUL
;
2996 * Read SN_CHARFLAGS section: <charflagslen> <charflags>
2997 * <folcharslen> <folchars>
2998 * Return SP_*ERROR flags.
3001 read_charflags_section(fd
)
3006 int flagslen
, follen
;
3008 /* <charflagslen> <charflags> */
3009 flags
= read_cnt_string(fd
, 1, &flagslen
);
3013 /* <folcharslen> <folchars> */
3014 fol
= read_cnt_string(fd
, 2, &follen
);
3021 /* Set the word-char flags and fill SPELL_ISUPPER() table. */
3022 if (flags
!= NULL
&& fol
!= NULL
)
3023 set_spell_charflags(flags
, flagslen
, fol
);
3028 /* When <charflagslen> is zero then <fcharlen> must also be zero. */
3029 if ((flags
== NULL
) != (fol
== NULL
))
3030 return SP_FORMERROR
;
3035 * Read SN_PREFCOND section.
3036 * Return SP_*ERROR flags.
3039 read_prefcond_section(fd
, lp
)
3047 char_u buf
[MAXWLEN
+ 1];
3049 /* <prefcondcnt> <prefcond> ... */
3050 cnt
= get2c(fd
); /* <prefcondcnt> */
3052 return SP_FORMERROR
;
3054 lp
->sl_prefprog
= (regprog_T
**)alloc_clear(
3055 (unsigned)sizeof(regprog_T
*) * cnt
);
3056 if (lp
->sl_prefprog
== NULL
)
3057 return SP_OTHERERROR
;
3058 lp
->sl_prefixcnt
= cnt
;
3060 for (i
= 0; i
< cnt
; ++i
)
3062 /* <prefcond> : <condlen> <condstr> */
3063 n
= getc(fd
); /* <condlen> */
3064 if (n
< 0 || n
>= MAXWLEN
)
3065 return SP_FORMERROR
;
3067 /* When <condlen> is zero we have an empty condition. Otherwise
3068 * compile the regexp program used to check for the condition. */
3071 buf
[0] = '^'; /* always match at one position only */
3074 *p
++ = getc(fd
); /* <condstr> */
3076 lp
->sl_prefprog
[i
] = vim_regcomp(buf
, RE_MAGIC
+ RE_STRING
);
3083 * Read REP or REPSAL items section from "fd": <repcount> <rep> ...
3084 * Return SP_*ERROR flags.
3087 read_rep_section(fd
, gap
, first
)
3096 cnt
= get2c(fd
); /* <repcount> */
3098 return SP_TRUNCERROR
;
3100 if (ga_grow(gap
, cnt
) == FAIL
)
3101 return SP_OTHERERROR
;
3103 /* <rep> : <repfromlen> <repfrom> <reptolen> <repto> */
3104 for (; gap
->ga_len
< cnt
; ++gap
->ga_len
)
3106 ftp
= &((fromto_T
*)gap
->ga_data
)[gap
->ga_len
];
3107 ftp
->ft_from
= read_cnt_string(fd
, 1, &i
);
3111 return SP_FORMERROR
;
3112 ftp
->ft_to
= read_cnt_string(fd
, 1, &i
);
3115 vim_free(ftp
->ft_from
);
3118 return SP_FORMERROR
;
3122 /* Fill the first-index table. */
3123 for (i
= 0; i
< 256; ++i
)
3125 for (i
= 0; i
< gap
->ga_len
; ++i
)
3127 ftp
= &((fromto_T
*)gap
->ga_data
)[i
];
3128 if (first
[*ftp
->ft_from
] == -1)
3129 first
[*ftp
->ft_from
] = i
;
3135 * Read SN_SAL section: <salflags> <salcount> <sal> ...
3136 * Return SP_*ERROR flags.
3139 read_sal_section(fd
, slang
)
3151 slang
->sl_sofo
= FALSE
;
3153 i
= getc(fd
); /* <salflags> */
3154 if (i
& SAL_F0LLOWUP
)
3155 slang
->sl_followup
= TRUE
;
3156 if (i
& SAL_COLLAPSE
)
3157 slang
->sl_collapse
= TRUE
;
3158 if (i
& SAL_REM_ACCENTS
)
3159 slang
->sl_rem_accents
= TRUE
;
3161 cnt
= get2c(fd
); /* <salcount> */
3163 return SP_TRUNCERROR
;
3165 gap
= &slang
->sl_sal
;
3166 ga_init2(gap
, sizeof(salitem_T
), 10);
3167 if (ga_grow(gap
, cnt
+ 1) == FAIL
)
3168 return SP_OTHERERROR
;
3170 /* <sal> : <salfromlen> <salfrom> <saltolen> <salto> */
3171 for (; gap
->ga_len
< cnt
; ++gap
->ga_len
)
3173 smp
= &((salitem_T
*)gap
->ga_data
)[gap
->ga_len
];
3174 ccnt
= getc(fd
); /* <salfromlen> */
3176 return SP_TRUNCERROR
;
3177 if ((p
= alloc(ccnt
+ 2)) == NULL
)
3178 return SP_OTHERERROR
;
3181 /* Read up to the first special char into sm_lead. */
3182 for (i
= 0; i
< ccnt
; ++i
)
3184 c
= getc(fd
); /* <salfrom> */
3185 if (vim_strchr((char_u
*)"0123456789(-<^$", c
) != NULL
)
3189 smp
->sm_leadlen
= (int)(p
- smp
->sm_lead
);
3192 /* Put (abc) chars in sm_oneof, if any. */
3196 for (++i
; i
< ccnt
; ++i
)
3198 c
= getc(fd
); /* <salfrom> */
3208 smp
->sm_oneof
= NULL
;
3210 /* Any following chars go in sm_rules. */
3213 /* store the char we got while checking for end of sm_lead */
3215 for (++i
; i
< ccnt
; ++i
)
3216 *p
++ = getc(fd
); /* <salfrom> */
3219 /* <saltolen> <salto> */
3220 smp
->sm_to
= read_cnt_string(fd
, 1, &ccnt
);
3223 vim_free(smp
->sm_lead
);
3230 /* convert the multi-byte strings to wide char strings */
3231 smp
->sm_lead_w
= mb_str2wide(smp
->sm_lead
);
3232 smp
->sm_leadlen
= mb_charlen(smp
->sm_lead
);
3233 if (smp
->sm_oneof
== NULL
)
3234 smp
->sm_oneof_w
= NULL
;
3236 smp
->sm_oneof_w
= mb_str2wide(smp
->sm_oneof
);
3237 if (smp
->sm_to
== NULL
)
3238 smp
->sm_to_w
= NULL
;
3240 smp
->sm_to_w
= mb_str2wide(smp
->sm_to
);
3241 if (smp
->sm_lead_w
== NULL
3242 || (smp
->sm_oneof_w
== NULL
&& smp
->sm_oneof
!= NULL
)
3243 || (smp
->sm_to_w
== NULL
&& smp
->sm_to
!= NULL
))
3245 vim_free(smp
->sm_lead
);
3246 vim_free(smp
->sm_to
);
3247 vim_free(smp
->sm_lead_w
);
3248 vim_free(smp
->sm_oneof_w
);
3249 vim_free(smp
->sm_to_w
);
3250 return SP_OTHERERROR
;
3256 if (gap
->ga_len
> 0)
3258 /* Add one extra entry to mark the end with an empty sm_lead. Avoids
3259 * that we need to check the index every time. */
3260 smp
= &((salitem_T
*)gap
->ga_data
)[gap
->ga_len
];
3261 if ((p
= alloc(1)) == NULL
)
3262 return SP_OTHERERROR
;
3265 smp
->sm_leadlen
= 0;
3266 smp
->sm_oneof
= NULL
;
3272 smp
->sm_lead_w
= mb_str2wide(smp
->sm_lead
);
3273 smp
->sm_leadlen
= 0;
3274 smp
->sm_oneof_w
= NULL
;
3275 smp
->sm_to_w
= NULL
;
3281 /* Fill the first-index table. */
3282 set_sal_first(slang
);
3288 * Read SN_WORDS: <word> ...
3289 * Return SP_*ERROR flags.
3292 read_words_section(fd
, lp
, len
)
3300 char_u word
[MAXWLEN
];
3304 /* Read one word at a time. */
3309 return SP_TRUNCERROR
;
3313 if (i
== MAXWLEN
- 1)
3314 return SP_FORMERROR
;
3317 /* Init the count to 10. */
3318 count_common_word(lp
, word
, -1, 10);
3325 * Add a word to the hashtable of common words.
3326 * If it's already there then the counter is increased.
3329 count_common_word(lp
, word
, len
, count
)
3332 int len
; /* word length, -1 for upto NUL */
3333 int count
; /* 1 to count once, 10 to init */
3338 char_u buf
[MAXWLEN
];
3345 vim_strncpy(buf
, word
, len
);
3349 hash
= hash_hash(p
);
3350 hi
= hash_lookup(&lp
->sl_wordcount
, p
, hash
);
3351 if (HASHITEM_EMPTY(hi
))
3353 wc
= (wordcount_T
*)alloc((unsigned)(sizeof(wordcount_T
) + STRLEN(p
)));
3356 STRCPY(wc
->wc_word
, p
);
3357 wc
->wc_count
= count
;
3358 hash_add_item(&lp
->sl_wordcount
, hi
, wc
->wc_word
, hash
);
3363 if ((wc
->wc_count
+= count
) < (unsigned)count
) /* check for overflow */
3364 wc
->wc_count
= MAXWORDCOUNT
;
3369 * Adjust the score of common words.
3372 score_wordcount_adj(slang
, score
, word
, split
)
3376 int split
; /* word was split, less bonus */
3383 hi
= hash_find(&slang
->sl_wordcount
, word
);
3384 if (!HASHITEM_EMPTY(hi
))
3387 if (wc
->wc_count
< SCORE_THRES2
)
3388 bonus
= SCORE_COMMON1
;
3389 else if (wc
->wc_count
< SCORE_THRES3
)
3390 bonus
= SCORE_COMMON2
;
3392 bonus
= SCORE_COMMON3
;
3394 newscore
= score
- bonus
/ 2;
3396 newscore
= score
- bonus
;
3405 * SN_SOFO: <sofofromlen> <sofofrom> <sofotolen> <sofoto>
3406 * Return SP_*ERROR flags.
3409 read_sofo_section(fd
, slang
)
3417 slang
->sl_sofo
= TRUE
;
3419 /* <sofofromlen> <sofofrom> */
3420 from
= read_cnt_string(fd
, 2, &cnt
);
3424 /* <sofotolen> <sofoto> */
3425 to
= read_cnt_string(fd
, 2, &cnt
);
3432 /* Store the info in slang->sl_sal and/or slang->sl_sal_first. */
3433 if (from
!= NULL
&& to
!= NULL
)
3434 res
= set_sofo(slang
, from
, to
);
3435 else if (from
!= NULL
|| to
!= NULL
)
3436 res
= SP_FORMERROR
; /* only one of two strings is an error */
3446 * Read the compound section from the .spl file:
3447 * <compmax> <compminlen> <compsylmax> <compoptions> <compflags>
3448 * Returns SP_*ERROR flags.
3451 read_compound(fd
, slang
, len
)
3467 return SP_FORMERROR
; /* need at least two bytes */
3470 c
= getc(fd
); /* <compmax> */
3473 slang
->sl_compmax
= c
;
3476 c
= getc(fd
); /* <compminlen> */
3479 slang
->sl_compminlen
= c
;
3482 c
= getc(fd
); /* <compsylmax> */
3485 slang
->sl_compsylmax
= c
;
3487 c
= getc(fd
); /* <compoptions> */
3489 ungetc(c
, fd
); /* be backwards compatible with Vim 7.0b */
3493 c
= getc(fd
); /* only use the lower byte for now */
3495 slang
->sl_compoptions
= c
;
3497 gap
= &slang
->sl_comppat
;
3498 c
= get2c(fd
); /* <comppatcount> */
3500 ga_init2(gap
, sizeof(char_u
*), c
);
3501 if (ga_grow(gap
, c
) == OK
)
3504 ((char_u
**)(gap
->ga_data
))[gap
->ga_len
++] =
3505 read_cnt_string(fd
, 1, &cnt
);
3506 /* <comppatlen> <comppattext> */
3513 return SP_FORMERROR
;
3515 /* Turn the COMPOUNDRULE items into a regexp pattern:
3516 * "a[bc]/a*b+" -> "^\(a[bc]\|a*b\+\)$".
3517 * Inserting backslashes may double the length, "^\(\)$<Nul>" is 7 bytes.
3518 * Conversion to utf-8 may double the size. */
3524 pat
= alloc((unsigned)c
);
3526 return SP_OTHERERROR
;
3528 /* We also need a list of all flags that can appear at the start and one
3530 cp
= alloc(todo
+ 1);
3534 return SP_OTHERERROR
;
3536 slang
->sl_compstartflags
= cp
;
3539 ap
= alloc(todo
+ 1);
3543 return SP_OTHERERROR
;
3545 slang
->sl_compallflags
= ap
;
3556 c
= getc(fd
); /* <compflags> */
3560 return SP_TRUNCERROR
;
3563 /* Add all flags to "sl_compallflags". */
3564 if (vim_strchr((char_u
*)"+*[]/", c
) == NULL
3565 && !byte_in_str(slang
->sl_compallflags
, c
))
3573 /* At start of item: copy flags to "sl_compstartflags". For a
3574 * [abc] item set "atstart" to 2 and copy up to the ']'. */
3581 if (!byte_in_str(slang
->sl_compstartflags
, c
))
3590 if (c
== '/') /* slash separates two items */
3596 else /* normal char, "[abc]" and '*' are copied as-is */
3598 if (c
== '+' || c
== '~')
3599 *pp
++ = '\\'; /* "a+" becomes "a\+" */
3602 pp
+= mb_char2bytes(c
, pp
);
3614 slang
->sl_compprog
= vim_regcomp(pat
, RE_MAGIC
+ RE_STRING
+ RE_STRICT
);
3616 if (slang
->sl_compprog
== NULL
)
3617 return SP_FORMERROR
;
3623 * Return TRUE if byte "n" appears in "str".
3624 * Like strchr() but independent of locale.
3633 for (p
= str
; *p
!= NUL
; ++p
)
3639 #define SY_MAXLEN 30
3640 typedef struct syl_item_S
3642 char_u sy_chars
[SY_MAXLEN
]; /* the sequence of chars */
3647 * Truncate "slang->sl_syllable" at the first slash and put the following items
3648 * in "slang->sl_syl_items".
3659 ga_init2(&slang
->sl_syl_items
, sizeof(syl_item_T
), 4);
3660 p
= vim_strchr(slang
->sl_syllable
, '/');
3664 if (*p
== NUL
) /* trailing slash */
3667 p
= vim_strchr(p
, '/');
3673 return SP_FORMERROR
;
3674 if (ga_grow(&slang
->sl_syl_items
, 1) == FAIL
)
3675 return SP_OTHERERROR
;
3676 syl
= ((syl_item_T
*)slang
->sl_syl_items
.ga_data
)
3677 + slang
->sl_syl_items
.ga_len
++;
3678 vim_strncpy(syl
->sy_chars
, s
, l
);
3685 * Count the number of syllables in "word".
3686 * When "word" contains spaces the syllables after the last space are counted.
3687 * Returns zero if syllables are not defines.
3690 count_syllables(slang
, word
)
3702 if (slang
->sl_syllable
== NULL
)
3705 for (p
= word
; *p
!= NUL
; p
+= len
)
3707 /* When running into a space reset counter. */
3715 /* Find longest match of syllable items. */
3717 for (i
= 0; i
< slang
->sl_syl_items
.ga_len
; ++i
)
3719 syl
= ((syl_item_T
*)slang
->sl_syl_items
.ga_data
) + i
;
3720 if (syl
->sy_len
> len
3721 && STRNCMP(p
, syl
->sy_chars
, syl
->sy_len
) == 0)
3724 if (len
!= 0) /* found a match, count syllable */
3731 /* No recognized syllable item, at least a syllable char then? */
3734 len
= (*mb_ptr2len
)(p
);
3739 if (vim_strchr(slang
->sl_syllable
, c
) == NULL
)
3740 skip
= FALSE
; /* No, search for next syllable */
3743 ++cnt
; /* Yes, count it */
3744 skip
= TRUE
; /* don't count following syllable chars */
3752 * Set the SOFOFROM and SOFOTO items in language "lp".
3753 * Returns SP_*ERROR flags when there is something wrong.
3756 set_sofo(lp
, from
, to
)
3772 /* Use "sl_sal" as an array with 256 pointers to a list of wide
3773 * characters. The index is the low byte of the character.
3774 * The list contains from-to pairs with a terminating NUL.
3775 * sl_sal_first[] is used for latin1 "from" characters. */
3777 ga_init2(gap
, sizeof(int *), 1);
3778 if (ga_grow(gap
, 256) == FAIL
)
3779 return SP_OTHERERROR
;
3780 vim_memset(gap
->ga_data
, 0, sizeof(int *) * 256);
3783 /* First count the number of items for each list. Temporarily use
3784 * sl_sal_first[] for this. */
3785 for (p
= from
, s
= to
; *p
!= NUL
&& *s
!= NUL
; )
3787 c
= mb_cptr2char_adv(&p
);
3790 ++lp
->sl_sal_first
[c
& 0xff];
3792 if (*p
!= NUL
|| *s
!= NUL
) /* lengths differ */
3793 return SP_FORMERROR
;
3795 /* Allocate the lists. */
3796 for (i
= 0; i
< 256; ++i
)
3797 if (lp
->sl_sal_first
[i
] > 0)
3799 p
= alloc(sizeof(int) * (lp
->sl_sal_first
[i
] * 2 + 1));
3801 return SP_OTHERERROR
;
3802 ((int **)gap
->ga_data
)[i
] = (int *)p
;
3806 /* Put the characters up to 255 in sl_sal_first[] the rest in a sl_sal
3808 vim_memset(lp
->sl_sal_first
, 0, sizeof(salfirst_T
) * 256);
3809 for (p
= from
, s
= to
; *p
!= NUL
&& *s
!= NUL
; )
3811 c
= mb_cptr2char_adv(&p
);
3812 i
= mb_cptr2char_adv(&s
);
3815 /* Append the from-to chars at the end of the list with
3817 inp
= ((int **)gap
->ga_data
)[c
& 0xff];
3820 *inp
++ = c
; /* from char */
3821 *inp
++ = i
; /* to char */
3822 *inp
++ = NUL
; /* NUL at the end */
3825 /* mapping byte to char is done in sl_sal_first[] */
3826 lp
->sl_sal_first
[c
] = i
;
3832 /* mapping bytes to bytes is done in sl_sal_first[] */
3833 if (STRLEN(from
) != STRLEN(to
))
3834 return SP_FORMERROR
;
3836 for (i
= 0; to
[i
] != NUL
; ++i
)
3837 lp
->sl_sal_first
[from
[i
]] = to
[i
];
3838 lp
->sl_sal
.ga_len
= 1; /* indicates we have soundfolding */
3845 * Fill the first-index table for "lp".
3855 garray_T
*gap
= &lp
->sl_sal
;
3857 sfirst
= lp
->sl_sal_first
;
3858 for (i
= 0; i
< 256; ++i
)
3860 smp
= (salitem_T
*)gap
->ga_data
;
3861 for (i
= 0; i
< gap
->ga_len
; ++i
)
3865 /* Use the lowest byte of the first character. For latin1 it's
3866 * the character, for other encodings it should differ for most
3868 c
= *smp
[i
].sm_lead_w
& 0xff;
3871 c
= *smp
[i
].sm_lead
;
3872 if (sfirst
[c
] == -1)
3880 /* Make sure all entries with this byte are following each
3881 * other. Move the ones that are in the wrong position. Do
3882 * keep the same ordering! */
3883 while (i
+ 1 < gap
->ga_len
3884 && (*smp
[i
+ 1].sm_lead_w
& 0xff) == c
)
3885 /* Skip over entry with same index byte. */
3888 for (n
= 1; i
+ n
< gap
->ga_len
; ++n
)
3889 if ((*smp
[i
+ n
].sm_lead_w
& 0xff) == c
)
3893 /* Move entry with same index byte after the entries
3894 * we already found. */
3898 mch_memmove(smp
+ i
+ 1, smp
+ i
,
3899 sizeof(salitem_T
) * n
);
3910 * Turn a multi-byte string into a wide character string.
3911 * Return it in allocated memory (NULL for out-of-memory)
3921 res
= (int *)alloc(sizeof(int) * (mb_charlen(s
) + 1));
3924 for (p
= s
; *p
!= NUL
; )
3925 res
[i
++] = mb_ptr2char_adv(&p
);
3933 * Read a tree from the .spl or .sug file.
3934 * Allocates the memory and stores pointers in "bytsp" and "idxsp".
3935 * This is skipped when the tree has zero length.
3936 * Returns zero when OK, SP_ value for an error.
3939 spell_read_tree(fd
, bytsp
, idxsp
, prefixtree
, prefixcnt
)
3943 int prefixtree
; /* TRUE for the prefix tree */
3944 int prefixcnt
; /* when "prefixtree" is TRUE: prefix count */
3951 /* The tree size was computed when writing the file, so that we can
3952 * allocate it as one long block. <nodecount> */
3955 return SP_TRUNCERROR
;
3958 /* Allocate the byte array. */
3959 bp
= lalloc((long_u
)len
, TRUE
);
3961 return SP_OTHERERROR
;
3964 /* Allocate the index array. */
3965 ip
= (idx_T
*)lalloc_clear((long_u
)(len
* sizeof(int)), TRUE
);
3967 return SP_OTHERERROR
;
3970 /* Recursively read the tree and store it in the array. */
3971 idx
= read_tree_node(fd
, bp
, ip
, len
, 0, prefixtree
, prefixcnt
);
3979 * Read one row of siblings from the spell file and store it in the byte array
3980 * "byts" and index array "idxs". Recursively read the children.
3982 * NOTE: The code here must match put_node()!
3984 * Returns the index (>= 0) following the siblings.
3985 * Returns SP_TRUNCERROR if the file is shorter than expected.
3986 * Returns SP_FORMERROR if there is a format error.
3989 read_tree_node(fd
, byts
, idxs
, maxidx
, startidx
, prefixtree
, maxprefcondnr
)
3993 int maxidx
; /* size of arrays */
3994 idx_T startidx
; /* current index in "byts" and "idxs" */
3995 int prefixtree
; /* TRUE for reading PREFIXTREE */
3996 int maxprefcondnr
; /* maximum for <prefcondnr> */
4001 idx_T idx
= startidx
;
4004 #define SHARED_MASK 0x8000000
4006 len
= getc(fd
); /* <siblingcount> */
4008 return SP_TRUNCERROR
;
4010 if (startidx
+ len
>= maxidx
)
4011 return SP_FORMERROR
;
4014 /* Read the byte values, flag/region bytes and shared indexes. */
4015 for (i
= 1; i
<= len
; ++i
)
4017 c
= getc(fd
); /* <byte> */
4019 return SP_TRUNCERROR
;
4020 if (c
<= BY_SPECIAL
)
4022 if (c
== BY_NOFLAGS
&& !prefixtree
)
4024 /* No flags, all regions. */
4028 else if (c
!= BY_INDEX
)
4032 /* Read the optional pflags byte, the prefix ID and the
4033 * condition nr. In idxs[] store the prefix ID in the low
4034 * byte, the condition index shifted up 8 bits, the flags
4035 * shifted up 24 bits. */
4037 c
= getc(fd
) << 24; /* <pflags> */
4041 c
|= getc(fd
); /* <affixID> */
4043 n
= get2c(fd
); /* <prefcondnr> */
4044 if (n
>= maxprefcondnr
)
4045 return SP_FORMERROR
;
4048 else /* c must be BY_FLAGS or BY_FLAGS2 */
4050 /* Read flags and optional region and prefix ID. In
4051 * idxs[] the flags go in the low two bytes, region above
4052 * that and prefix ID above the region. */
4054 c
= getc(fd
); /* <flags> */
4055 if (c2
== BY_FLAGS2
)
4056 c
= (getc(fd
) << 8) + c
; /* <flags2> */
4058 c
= (getc(fd
) << 16) + c
; /* <region> */
4060 c
= (getc(fd
) << 24) + c
; /* <affixID> */
4066 else /* c == BY_INDEX */
4070 if (n
< 0 || n
>= maxidx
)
4071 return SP_FORMERROR
;
4072 idxs
[idx
] = n
+ SHARED_MASK
;
4073 c
= getc(fd
); /* <xbyte> */
4079 /* Recursively read the children for non-shared siblings.
4080 * Skip the end-of-word ones (zero byte value) and the shared ones (and
4081 * remove SHARED_MASK) */
4082 for (i
= 1; i
<= len
; ++i
)
4083 if (byts
[startidx
+ i
] != 0)
4085 if (idxs
[startidx
+ i
] & SHARED_MASK
)
4086 idxs
[startidx
+ i
] &= ~SHARED_MASK
;
4089 idxs
[startidx
+ i
] = idx
;
4090 idx
= read_tree_node(fd
, byts
, idxs
, maxidx
, idx
,
4091 prefixtree
, maxprefcondnr
);
4101 * Parse 'spelllang' and set buf->b_langp accordingly.
4102 * Returns NULL if it's OK, an error message otherwise.
4105 did_set_spelllang(buf
)
4111 char_u region_cp
[3];
4116 char_u lang
[MAXWLEN
+ 1];
4117 char_u spf_name
[MAXPATHL
];
4122 char_u
*use_region
= NULL
;
4123 int dont_use_region
= FALSE
;
4124 int nobreak
= FALSE
;
4127 static int recursive
= FALSE
;
4128 char_u
*ret_msg
= NULL
;
4131 /* We don't want to do this recursively. May happen when a language is
4132 * not available and the SpellFileMissing autocommand opens a new buffer
4133 * in which 'spell' is set. */
4138 ga_init2(&ga
, sizeof(langp_T
), 2);
4141 /* Make a copy of 'spellang', the SpellFileMissing autocommands may change
4142 * it under our fingers. */
4143 spl_copy
= vim_strsave(buf
->b_p_spl
);
4144 if (spl_copy
== NULL
)
4147 /* loop over comma separated language names. */
4148 for (splp
= spl_copy
; *splp
!= NUL
; )
4150 /* Get one language name. */
4151 copy_option_part(&splp
, lang
, MAXWLEN
, ",");
4154 len
= (int)STRLEN(lang
);
4156 /* If the name ends in ".spl" use it as the name of the spell file.
4157 * If there is a region name let "region" point to it and remove it
4159 if (len
> 4 && fnamecmp(lang
+ len
- 4, ".spl") == 0)
4163 /* Locate a region and remove it from the file name. */
4164 p
= vim_strchr(gettail(lang
), '_');
4165 if (p
!= NULL
&& ASCII_ISALPHA(p
[1]) && ASCII_ISALPHA(p
[2])
4166 && !ASCII_ISALPHA(p
[3]))
4168 vim_strncpy(region_cp
, p
+ 1, 2);
4169 mch_memmove(p
, p
+ 3, len
- (p
- lang
) - 2);
4174 dont_use_region
= TRUE
;
4176 /* Check if we loaded this language before. */
4177 for (slang
= first_lang
; slang
!= NULL
; slang
= slang
->sl_next
)
4178 if (fullpathcmp(lang
, slang
->sl_fname
, FALSE
) == FPC_SAME
)
4184 if (len
> 3 && lang
[len
- 3] == '_')
4186 region
= lang
+ len
- 2;
4191 dont_use_region
= TRUE
;
4193 /* Check if we loaded this language before. */
4194 for (slang
= first_lang
; slang
!= NULL
; slang
= slang
->sl_next
)
4195 if (STRICMP(lang
, slang
->sl_name
) == 0)
4201 /* If the region differs from what was used before then don't
4202 * use it for 'spellfile'. */
4203 if (use_region
!= NULL
&& STRCMP(region
, use_region
) != 0)
4204 dont_use_region
= TRUE
;
4205 use_region
= region
;
4208 /* If not found try loading the language now. */
4212 (void)spell_load_file(lang
, lang
, NULL
, FALSE
);
4215 spell_load_lang(lang
);
4217 /* SpellFileMissing autocommands may do anything, including
4218 * destroying the buffer we are using... */
4219 if (!buf_valid(buf
))
4221 ret_msg
= (char_u
*)"E797: SpellFileMissing autocommand deleted buffer";
4229 * Loop over the languages, there can be several files for "lang".
4231 for (slang
= first_lang
; slang
!= NULL
; slang
= slang
->sl_next
)
4232 if (filename
? fullpathcmp(lang
, slang
->sl_fname
, FALSE
) == FPC_SAME
4233 : STRICMP(lang
, slang
->sl_name
) == 0)
4235 region_mask
= REGION_ALL
;
4236 if (!filename
&& region
!= NULL
)
4238 /* find region in sl_regions */
4239 c
= find_region(slang
->sl_regions
, region
);
4240 if (c
== REGION_ALL
)
4244 if (*slang
->sl_regions
!= NUL
)
4245 /* This addition file is for other regions. */
4249 /* This is probably an error. Give a warning and
4250 * accept the words anyway. */
4252 _("Warning: region %s not supported"),
4256 region_mask
= 1 << c
;
4259 if (region_mask
!= 0)
4261 if (ga_grow(&ga
, 1) == FAIL
)
4264 ret_msg
= e_outofmem
;
4267 LANGP_ENTRY(ga
, ga
.ga_len
)->lp_slang
= slang
;
4268 LANGP_ENTRY(ga
, ga
.ga_len
)->lp_region
= region_mask
;
4270 use_midword(slang
, buf
);
4271 if (slang
->sl_nobreak
)
4277 /* round 0: load int_wordlist, if possible.
4278 * round 1: load first name in 'spellfile'.
4279 * round 2: load second name in 'spellfile.
4282 for (round
= 0; round
== 0 || *spf
!= NUL
; ++round
)
4286 /* Internal wordlist, if there is one. */
4287 if (int_wordlist
== NULL
)
4289 int_wordlist_spl(spf_name
);
4293 /* One entry in 'spellfile'. */
4294 copy_option_part(&spf
, spf_name
, MAXPATHL
- 5, ",");
4295 STRCAT(spf_name
, ".spl");
4297 /* If it was already found above then skip it. */
4298 for (c
= 0; c
< ga
.ga_len
; ++c
)
4300 p
= LANGP_ENTRY(ga
, c
)->lp_slang
->sl_fname
;
4301 if (p
!= NULL
&& fullpathcmp(spf_name
, p
, FALSE
) == FPC_SAME
)
4308 /* Check if it was loaded already. */
4309 for (slang
= first_lang
; slang
!= NULL
; slang
= slang
->sl_next
)
4310 if (fullpathcmp(spf_name
, slang
->sl_fname
, FALSE
) == FPC_SAME
)
4314 /* Not loaded, try loading it now. The language name includes the
4315 * region name, the region is ignored otherwise. for int_wordlist
4316 * use an arbitrary name. */
4318 STRCPY(lang
, "internal wordlist");
4321 vim_strncpy(lang
, gettail(spf_name
), MAXWLEN
);
4322 p
= vim_strchr(lang
, '.');
4324 *p
= NUL
; /* truncate at ".encoding.add" */
4326 slang
= spell_load_file(spf_name
, lang
, NULL
, TRUE
);
4328 /* If one of the languages has NOBREAK we assume the addition
4329 * files also have this. */
4330 if (slang
!= NULL
&& nobreak
)
4331 slang
->sl_nobreak
= TRUE
;
4333 if (slang
!= NULL
&& ga_grow(&ga
, 1) == OK
)
4335 region_mask
= REGION_ALL
;
4336 if (use_region
!= NULL
&& !dont_use_region
)
4338 /* find region in sl_regions */
4339 c
= find_region(slang
->sl_regions
, use_region
);
4340 if (c
!= REGION_ALL
)
4341 region_mask
= 1 << c
;
4342 else if (*slang
->sl_regions
!= NUL
)
4343 /* This spell file is for other regions. */
4347 if (region_mask
!= 0)
4349 LANGP_ENTRY(ga
, ga
.ga_len
)->lp_slang
= slang
;
4350 LANGP_ENTRY(ga
, ga
.ga_len
)->lp_sallang
= NULL
;
4351 LANGP_ENTRY(ga
, ga
.ga_len
)->lp_replang
= NULL
;
4352 LANGP_ENTRY(ga
, ga
.ga_len
)->lp_region
= region_mask
;
4354 use_midword(slang
, buf
);
4359 /* Everything is fine, store the new b_langp value. */
4360 ga_clear(&buf
->b_langp
);
4363 /* For each language figure out what language to use for sound folding and
4364 * REP items. If the language doesn't support it itself use another one
4365 * with the same name. E.g. for "en-math" use "en". */
4366 for (i
= 0; i
< ga
.ga_len
; ++i
)
4368 lp
= LANGP_ENTRY(ga
, i
);
4371 if (lp
->lp_slang
->sl_sal
.ga_len
> 0)
4372 /* language does sound folding itself */
4373 lp
->lp_sallang
= lp
->lp_slang
;
4375 /* find first similar language that does sound folding */
4376 for (j
= 0; j
< ga
.ga_len
; ++j
)
4378 lp2
= LANGP_ENTRY(ga
, j
);
4379 if (lp2
->lp_slang
->sl_sal
.ga_len
> 0
4380 && STRNCMP(lp
->lp_slang
->sl_name
,
4381 lp2
->lp_slang
->sl_name
, 2) == 0)
4383 lp
->lp_sallang
= lp2
->lp_slang
;
4389 if (lp
->lp_slang
->sl_rep
.ga_len
> 0)
4390 /* language has REP items itself */
4391 lp
->lp_replang
= lp
->lp_slang
;
4393 /* find first similar language that has REP items */
4394 for (j
= 0; j
< ga
.ga_len
; ++j
)
4396 lp2
= LANGP_ENTRY(ga
, j
);
4397 if (lp2
->lp_slang
->sl_rep
.ga_len
> 0
4398 && STRNCMP(lp
->lp_slang
->sl_name
,
4399 lp2
->lp_slang
->sl_name
, 2) == 0)
4401 lp
->lp_replang
= lp2
->lp_slang
;
4414 * Clear the midword characters for buffer "buf".
4420 vim_memset(buf
->b_spell_ismw
, 0, 256);
4422 vim_free(buf
->b_spell_ismw_mb
);
4423 buf
->b_spell_ismw_mb
= NULL
;
4428 * Use the "sl_midword" field of language "lp" for buffer "buf".
4429 * They add up to any currently used midword characters.
4432 use_midword(lp
, buf
)
4438 if (lp
->sl_midword
== NULL
) /* there aren't any */
4441 for (p
= lp
->sl_midword
; *p
!= NUL
; )
4449 l
= (*mb_ptr2len
)(p
);
4450 if (c
< 256 && l
<= 2)
4451 buf
->b_spell_ismw
[c
] = TRUE
;
4452 else if (buf
->b_spell_ismw_mb
== NULL
)
4453 /* First multi-byte char in "b_spell_ismw_mb". */
4454 buf
->b_spell_ismw_mb
= vim_strnsave(p
, l
);
4457 /* Append multi-byte chars to "b_spell_ismw_mb". */
4458 n
= (int)STRLEN(buf
->b_spell_ismw_mb
);
4459 bp
= vim_strnsave(buf
->b_spell_ismw_mb
, n
+ l
);
4462 vim_free(buf
->b_spell_ismw_mb
);
4463 buf
->b_spell_ismw_mb
= bp
;
4464 vim_strncpy(bp
+ n
, p
, l
);
4471 buf
->b_spell_ismw
[*p
++] = TRUE
;
4475 * Find the region "region[2]" in "rp" (points to "sl_regions").
4476 * Each region is simply stored as the two characters of it's name.
4477 * Returns the index if found (first is 0), REGION_ALL if not found.
4480 find_region(rp
, region
)
4486 for (i
= 0; ; i
+= 2)
4490 if (rp
[i
] == region
[0] && rp
[i
+ 1] == region
[1])
4497 * Return case type of word:
4501 * WoRd wOrd WF_KEEPCAP
4506 char_u
*end
; /* When NULL use up to NUL byte. */
4512 int past_second
= FALSE
; /* past second word char */
4514 /* find first letter */
4515 for (p
= word
; !spell_iswordp_nmw(p
); mb_ptr_adv(p
))
4516 if (end
== NULL
? *p
== NUL
: p
>= end
)
4517 return 0; /* only non-word characters, illegal word */
4520 c
= mb_ptr2char_adv(&p
);
4524 firstcap
= allcap
= SPELL_ISUPPER(c
);
4527 * Need to check all letters to find a word with mixed upper/lower.
4528 * But a word with an upper char only at start is a ONECAP.
4530 for ( ; end
== NULL
? *p
!= NUL
: p
< end
; mb_ptr_adv(p
))
4531 if (spell_iswordp_nmw(p
))
4534 if (!SPELL_ISUPPER(c
))
4536 /* UUl -> KEEPCAP */
4537 if (past_second
&& allcap
)
4542 /* UlU -> KEEPCAP */
4555 * Like captype() but for a KEEPCAP word add ONECAP if the word starts with a
4556 * capital. So that make_case_word() can turn WOrd into Word.
4557 * Add ALLCAP for "WOrD".
4560 badword_captype(word
, end
)
4564 int flags
= captype(word
, end
);
4570 if (flags
& WF_KEEPCAP
)
4572 /* Count the number of UPPER and lower case letters. */
4575 for (p
= word
; p
< end
; mb_ptr_adv(p
))
4578 if (SPELL_ISUPPER(c
))
4588 /* If there are more UPPER than lower case letters suggest an
4589 * ALLCAP word. Otherwise, if the first letter is UPPER then
4590 * suggest ONECAP. Exception: "ALl" most likely should be "All",
4591 * require three upper case letters. */
4597 if (u
>= 2 && l
>= 2) /* maCARONI maCAroni */
4603 # if defined(FEAT_MBYTE) || defined(EXITFREE) || defined(PROTO)
4605 * Free all languages.
4612 char_u fname
[MAXPATHL
];
4614 /* Go through all buffers and handle 'spelllang'. */
4615 for (buf
= firstbuf
; buf
!= NULL
; buf
= buf
->b_next
)
4616 ga_clear(&buf
->b_langp
);
4618 while (first_lang
!= NULL
)
4621 first_lang
= slang
->sl_next
;
4625 if (int_wordlist
!= NULL
)
4627 /* Delete the internal wordlist and its .spl file */
4628 mch_remove(int_wordlist
);
4629 int_wordlist_spl(fname
);
4631 vim_free(int_wordlist
);
4632 int_wordlist
= NULL
;
4635 init_spell_chartab();
4639 vim_free(repl_from
);
4644 # if defined(FEAT_MBYTE) || defined(PROTO)
4646 * Clear all spelling tables and reload them.
4647 * Used after 'encoding' is set and when ":mkspell" was used.
4655 /* Initialize the table for spell_iswordp(). */
4656 init_spell_chartab();
4658 /* Unload all allocated memory. */
4661 /* Go through all buffers and handle 'spelllang'. */
4662 for (buf
= firstbuf
; buf
!= NULL
; buf
= buf
->b_next
)
4664 /* Only load the wordlists when 'spelllang' is set and there is a
4665 * window for this buffer in which 'spell' is set. */
4666 if (*buf
->b_p_spl
!= NUL
)
4669 if (wp
->w_buffer
== buf
&& wp
->w_p_spell
)
4671 (void)did_set_spelllang(buf
);
4672 # ifdef FEAT_WINDOWS
4682 * Reload the spell file "fname" if it's loaded.
4685 spell_reload_one(fname
, added_word
)
4687 int added_word
; /* invoked through "zg" */
4692 for (slang
= first_lang
; slang
!= NULL
; slang
= slang
->sl_next
)
4694 if (fullpathcmp(fname
, slang
->sl_fname
, FALSE
) == FPC_SAME
)
4697 if (spell_load_file(fname
, NULL
, slang
, FALSE
) == NULL
)
4698 /* reloading failed, clear the language */
4700 redraw_all_later(SOME_VALID
);
4705 /* When "zg" was used and the file wasn't loaded yet, should redo
4706 * 'spelllang' to load it now. */
4707 if (added_word
&& !didit
)
4708 did_set_spelllang(curbuf
);
4713 * Functions for ":mkspell".
4716 #define MAXLINELEN 500 /* Maximum length in bytes of a line in a .aff
4719 * Main structure to store the contents of a ".aff" file.
4721 typedef struct afffile_S
4723 char_u
*af_enc
; /* "SET", normalized, alloc'ed string or NULL */
4724 int af_flagtype
; /* AFT_CHAR, AFT_LONG, AFT_NUM or AFT_CAPLONG */
4725 unsigned af_rare
; /* RARE ID for rare word */
4726 unsigned af_keepcase
; /* KEEPCASE ID for keep-case word */
4727 unsigned af_bad
; /* BAD ID for banned word */
4728 unsigned af_needaffix
; /* NEEDAFFIX ID */
4729 unsigned af_circumfix
; /* CIRCUMFIX ID */
4730 unsigned af_needcomp
; /* NEEDCOMPOUND ID */
4731 unsigned af_comproot
; /* COMPOUNDROOT ID */
4732 unsigned af_compforbid
; /* COMPOUNDFORBIDFLAG ID */
4733 unsigned af_comppermit
; /* COMPOUNDPERMITFLAG ID */
4734 unsigned af_nosuggest
; /* NOSUGGEST ID */
4735 int af_pfxpostpone
; /* postpone prefixes without chop string and
4737 hashtab_T af_pref
; /* hashtable for prefixes, affheader_T */
4738 hashtab_T af_suff
; /* hashtable for suffixes, affheader_T */
4739 hashtab_T af_comp
; /* hashtable for compound flags, compitem_T */
4742 #define AFT_CHAR 0 /* flags are one character */
4743 #define AFT_LONG 1 /* flags are two characters */
4744 #define AFT_CAPLONG 2 /* flags are one or two characters */
4745 #define AFT_NUM 3 /* flags are numbers, comma separated */
4747 typedef struct affentry_S affentry_T
;
4748 /* Affix entry from ".aff" file. Used for prefixes and suffixes. */
4751 affentry_T
*ae_next
; /* next affix with same name/number */
4752 char_u
*ae_chop
; /* text to chop off basic word (can be NULL) */
4753 char_u
*ae_add
; /* text to add to basic word (can be NULL) */
4754 char_u
*ae_flags
; /* flags on the affix (can be NULL) */
4755 char_u
*ae_cond
; /* condition (NULL for ".") */
4756 regprog_T
*ae_prog
; /* regexp program for ae_cond or NULL */
4757 char ae_compforbid
; /* COMPOUNDFORBIDFLAG found */
4758 char ae_comppermit
; /* COMPOUNDPERMITFLAG found */
4762 # define AH_KEY_LEN 17 /* 2 x 8 bytes + NUL */
4764 # define AH_KEY_LEN 7 /* 6 digits + NUL */
4767 /* Affix header from ".aff" file. Used for af_pref and af_suff. */
4768 typedef struct affheader_S
4770 char_u ah_key
[AH_KEY_LEN
]; /* key for hashtab == name of affix */
4771 unsigned ah_flag
; /* affix name as number, uses "af_flagtype" */
4772 int ah_newID
; /* prefix ID after renumbering; 0 if not used */
4773 int ah_combine
; /* suffix may combine with prefix */
4774 int ah_follows
; /* another affix block should be following */
4775 affentry_T
*ah_first
; /* first affix entry */
4778 #define HI2AH(hi) ((affheader_T *)(hi)->hi_key)
4780 /* Flag used in compound items. */
4781 typedef struct compitem_S
4783 char_u ci_key
[AH_KEY_LEN
]; /* key for hashtab == name of compound */
4784 unsigned ci_flag
; /* affix name as number, uses "af_flagtype" */
4785 int ci_newID
; /* affix ID after renumbering. */
4788 #define HI2CI(hi) ((compitem_T *)(hi)->hi_key)
4791 * Structure that is used to store the items in the word tree. This avoids
4792 * the need to keep track of each allocated thing, everything is freed all at
4793 * once after ":mkspell" is done.
4795 #define SBLOCKSIZE 16000 /* size of sb_data */
4796 typedef struct sblock_S sblock_T
;
4799 sblock_T
*sb_next
; /* next block in list */
4800 int sb_used
; /* nr of bytes already in use */
4801 char_u sb_data
[1]; /* data, actually longer */
4805 * A node in the tree.
4807 typedef struct wordnode_S wordnode_T
;
4810 union /* shared to save space */
4812 char_u hashkey
[6]; /* the hash key, only used while compressing */
4813 int index
; /* index in written nodes (valid after first
4816 union /* shared to save space */
4818 wordnode_T
*next
; /* next node with same hash key */
4819 wordnode_T
*wnode
; /* parent node that will write this node */
4821 wordnode_T
*wn_child
; /* child (next byte in word) */
4822 wordnode_T
*wn_sibling
; /* next sibling (alternate byte in word,
4824 int wn_refs
; /* Nr. of references to this node. Only
4825 relevant for first node in a list of
4826 siblings, in following siblings it is
4828 char_u wn_byte
; /* Byte for this node. NUL for word end */
4830 /* Info for when "wn_byte" is NUL.
4831 * In PREFIXTREE "wn_region" is used for the prefcondnr.
4832 * In the soundfolded word tree "wn_flags" has the MSW of the wordnr and
4833 * "wn_region" the LSW of the wordnr. */
4834 char_u wn_affixID
; /* supported/required prefix ID or 0 */
4835 short_u wn_flags
; /* WF_ flags */
4836 short wn_region
; /* region mask */
4838 #ifdef SPELL_PRINTTREE
4839 int wn_nr
; /* sequence nr for printing */
4843 #define WN_MASK 0xffff /* mask relevant bits of "wn_flags" */
4845 #define HI2WN(hi) (wordnode_T *)((hi)->hi_key)
4848 * Info used while reading the spell files.
4850 typedef struct spellinfo_S
4852 wordnode_T
*si_foldroot
; /* tree with case-folded words */
4853 long si_foldwcount
; /* nr of words in si_foldroot */
4855 wordnode_T
*si_keeproot
; /* tree with keep-case words */
4856 long si_keepwcount
; /* nr of words in si_keeproot */
4858 wordnode_T
*si_prefroot
; /* tree with postponed prefixes */
4860 long si_sugtree
; /* creating the soundfolding trie */
4862 sblock_T
*si_blocks
; /* memory blocks used */
4863 long si_blocks_cnt
; /* memory blocks allocated */
4864 long si_compress_cnt
; /* words to add before lowering
4865 compression limit */
4866 wordnode_T
*si_first_free
; /* List of nodes that have been freed during
4867 compression, linked by "wn_child" field. */
4868 long si_free_count
; /* number of nodes in si_first_free */
4869 #ifdef SPELL_PRINTTREE
4870 int si_wordnode_nr
; /* sequence nr for nodes */
4872 buf_T
*si_spellbuf
; /* buffer used to store soundfold word table */
4874 int si_ascii
; /* handling only ASCII words */
4875 int si_add
; /* addition file */
4876 int si_clear_chartab
; /* when TRUE clear char tables */
4877 int si_region
; /* region mask */
4878 vimconv_T si_conv
; /* for conversion to 'encoding' */
4879 int si_memtot
; /* runtime memory used */
4880 int si_verbose
; /* verbose messages */
4881 int si_msg_count
; /* number of words added since last message */
4882 char_u
*si_info
; /* info text chars or NULL */
4883 int si_region_count
; /* number of regions supported (1 when there
4885 char_u si_region_name
[16]; /* region names; used only if
4886 * si_region_count > 1) */
4888 garray_T si_rep
; /* list of fromto_T entries from REP lines */
4889 garray_T si_repsal
; /* list of fromto_T entries from REPSAL lines */
4890 garray_T si_sal
; /* list of fromto_T entries from SAL lines */
4891 char_u
*si_sofofr
; /* SOFOFROM text */
4892 char_u
*si_sofoto
; /* SOFOTO text */
4893 int si_nosugfile
; /* NOSUGFILE item found */
4894 int si_nosplitsugs
; /* NOSPLITSUGS item found */
4895 int si_followup
; /* soundsalike: ? */
4896 int si_collapse
; /* soundsalike: ? */
4897 hashtab_T si_commonwords
; /* hashtable for common words */
4898 time_t si_sugtime
; /* timestamp for .sug file */
4899 int si_rem_accents
; /* soundsalike: remove accents */
4900 garray_T si_map
; /* MAP info concatenated */
4901 char_u
*si_midword
; /* MIDWORD chars or NULL */
4902 int si_compmax
; /* max nr of words for compounding */
4903 int si_compminlen
; /* minimal length for compounding */
4904 int si_compsylmax
; /* max nr of syllables for compounding */
4905 int si_compoptions
; /* COMP_ flags */
4906 garray_T si_comppat
; /* CHECKCOMPOUNDPATTERN items, each stored as
4908 char_u
*si_compflags
; /* flags used for compounding */
4909 char_u si_nobreak
; /* NOBREAK */
4910 char_u
*si_syllable
; /* syllable string */
4911 garray_T si_prefcond
; /* table with conditions for postponed
4912 * prefixes, each stored as a string */
4913 int si_newprefID
; /* current value for ah_newID */
4914 int si_newcompID
; /* current value for compound ID */
4917 static afffile_T
*spell_read_aff
__ARGS((spellinfo_T
*spin
, char_u
*fname
));
4918 static void aff_process_flags
__ARGS((afffile_T
*affile
, affentry_T
*entry
));
4919 static int spell_info_item
__ARGS((char_u
*s
));
4920 static unsigned affitem2flag
__ARGS((int flagtype
, char_u
*item
, char_u
*fname
, int lnum
));
4921 static unsigned get_affitem
__ARGS((int flagtype
, char_u
**pp
));
4922 static void process_compflags
__ARGS((spellinfo_T
*spin
, afffile_T
*aff
, char_u
*compflags
));
4923 static void check_renumber
__ARGS((spellinfo_T
*spin
));
4924 static int flag_in_afflist
__ARGS((int flagtype
, char_u
*afflist
, unsigned flag
));
4925 static void aff_check_number
__ARGS((int spinval
, int affval
, char *name
));
4926 static void aff_check_string
__ARGS((char_u
*spinval
, char_u
*affval
, char *name
));
4927 static int str_equal
__ARGS((char_u
*s1
, char_u
*s2
));
4928 static void add_fromto
__ARGS((spellinfo_T
*spin
, garray_T
*gap
, char_u
*from
, char_u
*to
));
4929 static int sal_to_bool
__ARGS((char_u
*s
));
4930 static int has_non_ascii
__ARGS((char_u
*s
));
4931 static void spell_free_aff
__ARGS((afffile_T
*aff
));
4932 static int spell_read_dic
__ARGS((spellinfo_T
*spin
, char_u
*fname
, afffile_T
*affile
));
4933 static int get_affix_flags
__ARGS((afffile_T
*affile
, char_u
*afflist
));
4934 static int get_pfxlist
__ARGS((afffile_T
*affile
, char_u
*afflist
, char_u
*store_afflist
));
4935 static void get_compflags
__ARGS((afffile_T
*affile
, char_u
*afflist
, char_u
*store_afflist
));
4936 static int store_aff_word
__ARGS((spellinfo_T
*spin
, char_u
*word
, char_u
*afflist
, afffile_T
*affile
, hashtab_T
*ht
, hashtab_T
*xht
, int condit
, int flags
, char_u
*pfxlist
, int pfxlen
));
4937 static int spell_read_wordfile
__ARGS((spellinfo_T
*spin
, char_u
*fname
));
4938 static void *getroom
__ARGS((spellinfo_T
*spin
, size_t len
, int align
));
4939 static char_u
*getroom_save
__ARGS((spellinfo_T
*spin
, char_u
*s
));
4940 static void free_blocks
__ARGS((sblock_T
*bl
));
4941 static wordnode_T
*wordtree_alloc
__ARGS((spellinfo_T
*spin
));
4942 static int store_word
__ARGS((spellinfo_T
*spin
, char_u
*word
, int flags
, int region
, char_u
*pfxlist
, int need_affix
));
4943 static int tree_add_word
__ARGS((spellinfo_T
*spin
, char_u
*word
, wordnode_T
*tree
, int flags
, int region
, int affixID
));
4944 static wordnode_T
*get_wordnode
__ARGS((spellinfo_T
*spin
));
4945 static int deref_wordnode
__ARGS((spellinfo_T
*spin
, wordnode_T
*node
));
4946 static void free_wordnode
__ARGS((spellinfo_T
*spin
, wordnode_T
*n
));
4947 static void wordtree_compress
__ARGS((spellinfo_T
*spin
, wordnode_T
*root
));
4948 static int node_compress
__ARGS((spellinfo_T
*spin
, wordnode_T
*node
, hashtab_T
*ht
, int *tot
));
4949 static int node_equal
__ARGS((wordnode_T
*n1
, wordnode_T
*n2
));
4950 static void put_sugtime
__ARGS((spellinfo_T
*spin
, FILE *fd
));
4951 static int write_vim_spell
__ARGS((spellinfo_T
*spin
, char_u
*fname
));
4952 static void clear_node
__ARGS((wordnode_T
*node
));
4953 static int put_node
__ARGS((FILE *fd
, wordnode_T
*node
, int index
, int regionmask
, int prefixtree
));
4954 static void spell_make_sugfile
__ARGS((spellinfo_T
*spin
, char_u
*wfname
));
4955 static int sug_filltree
__ARGS((spellinfo_T
*spin
, slang_T
*slang
));
4956 static int sug_maketable
__ARGS((spellinfo_T
*spin
));
4957 static int sug_filltable
__ARGS((spellinfo_T
*spin
, wordnode_T
*node
, int startwordnr
, garray_T
*gap
));
4958 static int offset2bytes
__ARGS((int nr
, char_u
*buf
));
4959 static int bytes2offset
__ARGS((char_u
**pp
));
4960 static void sug_write
__ARGS((spellinfo_T
*spin
, char_u
*fname
));
4961 static void mkspell
__ARGS((int fcount
, char_u
**fnames
, int ascii
, int overwrite
, int added_word
));
4962 static void spell_message
__ARGS((spellinfo_T
*spin
, char_u
*str
));
4963 static void init_spellfile
__ARGS((void));
4965 /* In the postponed prefixes tree wn_flags is used to store the WFP_ flags,
4966 * but it must be negative to indicate the prefix tree to tree_add_word().
4967 * Use a negative number with the lower 8 bits zero. */
4968 #define PFX_FLAGS -256
4970 /* flags for "condit" argument of store_aff_word() */
4971 #define CONDIT_COMB 1 /* affix must combine */
4972 #define CONDIT_CFIX 2 /* affix must have CIRCUMFIX flag */
4973 #define CONDIT_SUF 4 /* add a suffix for matching flags */
4974 #define CONDIT_AFF 8 /* word already has an affix */
4977 * Tunable parameters for when the tree is compressed. See 'mkspellmem'.
4979 static long compress_start
= 30000; /* memory / SBLOCKSIZE */
4980 static long compress_inc
= 100; /* memory / SBLOCKSIZE */
4981 static long compress_added
= 500000; /* word count */
4983 #ifdef SPELL_PRINTTREE
4985 * For debugging the tree code: print the current tree in a (more or less)
4986 * readable format, so that we can see what happens when adding a word and/or
4987 * compressing the tree.
4988 * Based on code from Olaf Seibert.
4990 #define PRINTLINESIZE 1000
4991 #define PRINTWIDTH 6
4993 #define PRINTSOME(l, depth, fmt, a1, a2) vim_snprintf(l + depth * PRINTWIDTH, \
4994 PRINTLINESIZE - PRINTWIDTH * depth, fmt, a1, a2)
4996 static char line1
[PRINTLINESIZE
];
4997 static char line2
[PRINTLINESIZE
];
4998 static char line3
[PRINTLINESIZE
];
5001 spell_clear_flags(wordnode_T
*node
)
5005 for (np
= node
; np
!= NULL
; np
= np
->wn_sibling
)
5007 np
->wn_u1
.index
= FALSE
;
5008 spell_clear_flags(np
->wn_child
);
5013 spell_print_node(wordnode_T
*node
, int depth
)
5015 if (node
->wn_u1
.index
)
5017 /* Done this node before, print the reference. */
5018 PRINTSOME(line1
, depth
, "(%d)", node
->wn_nr
, 0);
5019 PRINTSOME(line2
, depth
, " ", 0, 0);
5020 PRINTSOME(line3
, depth
, " ", 0, 0);
5027 node
->wn_u1
.index
= TRUE
;
5029 if (node
->wn_byte
!= NUL
)
5031 if (node
->wn_child
!= NULL
)
5032 PRINTSOME(line1
, depth
, " %c -> ", node
->wn_byte
, 0);
5034 /* Cannot happen? */
5035 PRINTSOME(line1
, depth
, " %c ???", node
->wn_byte
, 0);
5038 PRINTSOME(line1
, depth
, " $ ", 0, 0);
5040 PRINTSOME(line2
, depth
, "%d/%d ", node
->wn_nr
, node
->wn_refs
);
5042 if (node
->wn_sibling
!= NULL
)
5043 PRINTSOME(line3
, depth
, " | ", 0, 0);
5045 PRINTSOME(line3
, depth
, " ", 0, 0);
5047 if (node
->wn_byte
== NUL
)
5054 /* do the children */
5055 if (node
->wn_byte
!= NUL
&& node
->wn_child
!= NULL
)
5056 spell_print_node(node
->wn_child
, depth
+ 1);
5058 /* do the siblings */
5059 if (node
->wn_sibling
!= NULL
)
5061 /* get rid of all parent details except | */
5062 STRCPY(line1
, line3
);
5063 STRCPY(line2
, line3
);
5064 spell_print_node(node
->wn_sibling
, depth
);
5070 spell_print_tree(wordnode_T
*root
)
5074 /* Clear the "wn_u1.index" fields, used to remember what has been
5076 spell_clear_flags(root
);
5078 /* Recursively print the tree. */
5079 spell_print_node(root
, 0);
5082 #endif /* SPELL_PRINTTREE */
5085 * Read the affix file "fname".
5086 * Returns an afffile_T, NULL for complete failure.
5089 spell_read_aff(spin
, fname
)
5095 char_u rline
[MAXLINELEN
];
5098 #define MAXITEMCNT 30
5099 char_u
*(items
[MAXITEMCNT
]);
5103 affheader_T
*cur_aff
= NULL
;
5104 int did_postpone_prefix
= FALSE
;
5114 int found_map
= FALSE
;
5117 int compminlen
= 0; /* COMPOUNDMIN value */
5118 int compsylmax
= 0; /* COMPOUNDSYLMAX value */
5119 int compoptions
= 0; /* COMP_ flags */
5120 int compmax
= 0; /* COMPOUNDWORDMAX value */
5121 char_u
*compflags
= NULL
; /* COMPOUNDFLAG and COMPOUNDRULE
5123 char_u
*midword
= NULL
; /* MIDWORD value */
5124 char_u
*syllable
= NULL
; /* SYLLABLE value */
5125 char_u
*sofofrom
= NULL
; /* SOFOFROM value */
5126 char_u
*sofoto
= NULL
; /* SOFOTO value */
5131 fd
= mch_fopen((char *)fname
, "r");
5134 EMSG2(_(e_notopen
), fname
);
5138 vim_snprintf((char *)IObuff
, IOSIZE
, _("Reading affix file %s ..."), fname
);
5139 spell_message(spin
, IObuff
);
5141 /* Only do REP lines when not done in another .aff file already. */
5142 do_rep
= spin
->si_rep
.ga_len
== 0;
5144 /* Only do REPSAL lines when not done in another .aff file already. */
5145 do_repsal
= spin
->si_repsal
.ga_len
== 0;
5147 /* Only do SAL lines when not done in another .aff file already. */
5148 do_sal
= spin
->si_sal
.ga_len
== 0;
5150 /* Only do MAP lines when not done in another .aff file already. */
5151 do_mapline
= spin
->si_map
.ga_len
== 0;
5154 * Allocate and init the afffile_T structure.
5156 aff
= (afffile_T
*)getroom(spin
, sizeof(afffile_T
), TRUE
);
5162 hash_init(&aff
->af_pref
);
5163 hash_init(&aff
->af_suff
);
5164 hash_init(&aff
->af_comp
);
5167 * Read all the lines in the file one by one.
5169 while (!vim_fgets(rline
, MAXLINELEN
, fd
) && !got_int
)
5174 /* Skip comment lines. */
5178 /* Convert from "SET" to 'encoding' when needed. */
5181 if (spin
->si_conv
.vc_type
!= CONV_NONE
)
5183 pc
= string_convert(&spin
->si_conv
, rline
, NULL
);
5186 smsg((char_u
*)_("Conversion failure for word in %s line %d: %s"),
5187 fname
, lnum
, rline
);
5199 /* Split the line up in white separated items. Put a NUL after each
5204 while (*p
!= NUL
&& *p
<= ' ') /* skip white space and CR/NL */
5208 if (itemcnt
== MAXITEMCNT
) /* too many items */
5210 items
[itemcnt
++] = p
;
5211 /* A few items have arbitrary text argument, don't split them. */
5212 if (itemcnt
== 2 && spell_info_item(items
[0]))
5213 while (*p
>= ' ' || *p
== TAB
) /* skip until CR/NL */
5216 while (*p
> ' ') /* skip until white space or CR/NL */
5223 /* Handle non-empty lines. */
5226 if (STRCMP(items
[0], "SET") == 0 && itemcnt
== 2
5227 && aff
->af_enc
== NULL
)
5230 /* Setup for conversion from "ENC" to 'encoding'. */
5231 aff
->af_enc
= enc_canonize(items
[1]);
5232 if (aff
->af_enc
!= NULL
&& !spin
->si_ascii
5233 && convert_setup(&spin
->si_conv
, aff
->af_enc
,
5235 smsg((char_u
*)_("Conversion in %s not supported: from %s to %s"),
5236 fname
, aff
->af_enc
, p_enc
);
5237 spin
->si_conv
.vc_fail
= TRUE
;
5239 smsg((char_u
*)_("Conversion in %s not supported"), fname
);
5242 else if (STRCMP(items
[0], "FLAG") == 0 && itemcnt
== 2
5243 && aff
->af_flagtype
== AFT_CHAR
)
5245 if (STRCMP(items
[1], "long") == 0)
5246 aff
->af_flagtype
= AFT_LONG
;
5247 else if (STRCMP(items
[1], "num") == 0)
5248 aff
->af_flagtype
= AFT_NUM
;
5249 else if (STRCMP(items
[1], "caplong") == 0)
5250 aff
->af_flagtype
= AFT_CAPLONG
;
5252 smsg((char_u
*)_("Invalid value for FLAG in %s line %d: %s"),
5253 fname
, lnum
, items
[1]);
5254 if (aff
->af_rare
!= 0
5255 || aff
->af_keepcase
!= 0
5257 || aff
->af_needaffix
!= 0
5258 || aff
->af_circumfix
!= 0
5259 || aff
->af_needcomp
!= 0
5260 || aff
->af_comproot
!= 0
5261 || aff
->af_nosuggest
!= 0
5262 || compflags
!= NULL
5263 || aff
->af_suff
.ht_used
> 0
5264 || aff
->af_pref
.ht_used
> 0)
5265 smsg((char_u
*)_("FLAG after using flags in %s line %d: %s"),
5266 fname
, lnum
, items
[1]);
5268 else if (spell_info_item(items
[0]))
5270 p
= (char_u
*)getroom(spin
,
5271 (spin
->si_info
== NULL
? 0 : STRLEN(spin
->si_info
))
5273 + STRLEN(items
[1]) + 3, FALSE
);
5276 if (spin
->si_info
!= NULL
)
5278 STRCPY(p
, spin
->si_info
);
5281 STRCAT(p
, items
[0]);
5283 STRCAT(p
, items
[1]);
5287 else if (STRCMP(items
[0], "MIDWORD") == 0 && itemcnt
== 2
5290 midword
= getroom_save(spin
, items
[1]);
5292 else if (STRCMP(items
[0], "TRY") == 0 && itemcnt
== 2)
5294 /* ignored, we look in the tree for what chars may appear */
5296 /* TODO: remove "RAR" later */
5297 else if ((STRCMP(items
[0], "RAR") == 0
5298 || STRCMP(items
[0], "RARE") == 0) && itemcnt
== 2
5299 && aff
->af_rare
== 0)
5301 aff
->af_rare
= affitem2flag(aff
->af_flagtype
, items
[1],
5304 /* TODO: remove "KEP" later */
5305 else if ((STRCMP(items
[0], "KEP") == 0
5306 || STRCMP(items
[0], "KEEPCASE") == 0) && itemcnt
== 2
5307 && aff
->af_keepcase
== 0)
5309 aff
->af_keepcase
= affitem2flag(aff
->af_flagtype
, items
[1],
5312 else if (STRCMP(items
[0], "BAD") == 0 && itemcnt
== 2
5313 && aff
->af_bad
== 0)
5315 aff
->af_bad
= affitem2flag(aff
->af_flagtype
, items
[1],
5318 else if (STRCMP(items
[0], "NEEDAFFIX") == 0 && itemcnt
== 2
5319 && aff
->af_needaffix
== 0)
5321 aff
->af_needaffix
= affitem2flag(aff
->af_flagtype
, items
[1],
5324 else if (STRCMP(items
[0], "CIRCUMFIX") == 0 && itemcnt
== 2
5325 && aff
->af_circumfix
== 0)
5327 aff
->af_circumfix
= affitem2flag(aff
->af_flagtype
, items
[1],
5330 else if (STRCMP(items
[0], "NOSUGGEST") == 0 && itemcnt
== 2
5331 && aff
->af_nosuggest
== 0)
5333 aff
->af_nosuggest
= affitem2flag(aff
->af_flagtype
, items
[1],
5336 else if (STRCMP(items
[0], "NEEDCOMPOUND") == 0 && itemcnt
== 2
5337 && aff
->af_needcomp
== 0)
5339 aff
->af_needcomp
= affitem2flag(aff
->af_flagtype
, items
[1],
5342 else if (STRCMP(items
[0], "COMPOUNDROOT") == 0 && itemcnt
== 2
5343 && aff
->af_comproot
== 0)
5345 aff
->af_comproot
= affitem2flag(aff
->af_flagtype
, items
[1],
5348 else if (STRCMP(items
[0], "COMPOUNDFORBIDFLAG") == 0
5349 && itemcnt
== 2 && aff
->af_compforbid
== 0)
5351 aff
->af_compforbid
= affitem2flag(aff
->af_flagtype
, items
[1],
5353 if (aff
->af_pref
.ht_used
> 0)
5354 smsg((char_u
*)_("Defining COMPOUNDFORBIDFLAG after PFX item may give wrong results in %s line %d"),
5357 else if (STRCMP(items
[0], "COMPOUNDPERMITFLAG") == 0
5358 && itemcnt
== 2 && aff
->af_comppermit
== 0)
5360 aff
->af_comppermit
= affitem2flag(aff
->af_flagtype
, items
[1],
5362 if (aff
->af_pref
.ht_used
> 0)
5363 smsg((char_u
*)_("Defining COMPOUNDPERMITFLAG after PFX item may give wrong results in %s line %d"),
5366 else if (STRCMP(items
[0], "COMPOUNDFLAG") == 0 && itemcnt
== 2
5367 && compflags
== NULL
)
5369 /* Turn flag "c" into COMPOUNDRULE compatible string "c+",
5370 * "Na" into "Na+", "1234" into "1234+". */
5371 p
= getroom(spin
, STRLEN(items
[1]) + 2, FALSE
);
5374 STRCPY(p
, items
[1]);
5379 else if (STRCMP(items
[0], "COMPOUNDRULE") == 0 && itemcnt
== 2)
5381 /* Concatenate this string to previously defined ones, using a
5382 * slash to separate them. */
5383 l
= (int)STRLEN(items
[1]) + 1;
5384 if (compflags
!= NULL
)
5385 l
+= (int)STRLEN(compflags
) + 1;
5386 p
= getroom(spin
, l
, FALSE
);
5389 if (compflags
!= NULL
)
5391 STRCPY(p
, compflags
);
5394 STRCAT(p
, items
[1]);
5398 else if (STRCMP(items
[0], "COMPOUNDWORDMAX") == 0 && itemcnt
== 2
5401 compmax
= atoi((char *)items
[1]);
5403 smsg((char_u
*)_("Wrong COMPOUNDWORDMAX value in %s line %d: %s"),
5404 fname
, lnum
, items
[1]);
5406 else if (STRCMP(items
[0], "COMPOUNDMIN") == 0 && itemcnt
== 2
5409 compminlen
= atoi((char *)items
[1]);
5410 if (compminlen
== 0)
5411 smsg((char_u
*)_("Wrong COMPOUNDMIN value in %s line %d: %s"),
5412 fname
, lnum
, items
[1]);
5414 else if (STRCMP(items
[0], "COMPOUNDSYLMAX") == 0 && itemcnt
== 2
5417 compsylmax
= atoi((char *)items
[1]);
5418 if (compsylmax
== 0)
5419 smsg((char_u
*)_("Wrong COMPOUNDSYLMAX value in %s line %d: %s"),
5420 fname
, lnum
, items
[1]);
5422 else if (STRCMP(items
[0], "CHECKCOMPOUNDDUP") == 0 && itemcnt
== 1)
5424 compoptions
|= COMP_CHECKDUP
;
5426 else if (STRCMP(items
[0], "CHECKCOMPOUNDREP") == 0 && itemcnt
== 1)
5428 compoptions
|= COMP_CHECKREP
;
5430 else if (STRCMP(items
[0], "CHECKCOMPOUNDCASE") == 0 && itemcnt
== 1)
5432 compoptions
|= COMP_CHECKCASE
;
5434 else if (STRCMP(items
[0], "CHECKCOMPOUNDTRIPLE") == 0
5437 compoptions
|= COMP_CHECKTRIPLE
;
5439 else if (STRCMP(items
[0], "CHECKCOMPOUNDPATTERN") == 0
5442 if (atoi((char *)items
[1]) == 0)
5443 smsg((char_u
*)_("Wrong CHECKCOMPOUNDPATTERN value in %s line %d: %s"),
5444 fname
, lnum
, items
[1]);
5446 else if (STRCMP(items
[0], "CHECKCOMPOUNDPATTERN") == 0
5449 garray_T
*gap
= &spin
->si_comppat
;
5452 /* Only add the couple if it isn't already there. */
5453 for (i
= 0; i
< gap
->ga_len
- 1; i
+= 2)
5454 if (STRCMP(((char_u
**)(gap
->ga_data
))[i
], items
[1]) == 0
5455 && STRCMP(((char_u
**)(gap
->ga_data
))[i
+ 1],
5458 if (i
>= gap
->ga_len
&& ga_grow(gap
, 2) == OK
)
5460 ((char_u
**)(gap
->ga_data
))[gap
->ga_len
++]
5461 = getroom_save(spin
, items
[1]);
5462 ((char_u
**)(gap
->ga_data
))[gap
->ga_len
++]
5463 = getroom_save(spin
, items
[2]);
5466 else if (STRCMP(items
[0], "SYLLABLE") == 0 && itemcnt
== 2
5467 && syllable
== NULL
)
5469 syllable
= getroom_save(spin
, items
[1]);
5471 else if (STRCMP(items
[0], "NOBREAK") == 0 && itemcnt
== 1)
5473 spin
->si_nobreak
= TRUE
;
5475 else if (STRCMP(items
[0], "NOSPLITSUGS") == 0 && itemcnt
== 1)
5477 spin
->si_nosplitsugs
= TRUE
;
5479 else if (STRCMP(items
[0], "NOSUGFILE") == 0 && itemcnt
== 1)
5481 spin
->si_nosugfile
= TRUE
;
5483 else if (STRCMP(items
[0], "PFXPOSTPONE") == 0 && itemcnt
== 1)
5485 aff
->af_pfxpostpone
= TRUE
;
5487 else if ((STRCMP(items
[0], "PFX") == 0
5488 || STRCMP(items
[0], "SFX") == 0)
5493 char_u key
[AH_KEY_LEN
];
5495 if (*items
[0] == 'P')
5500 /* Myspell allows the same affix name to be used multiple
5501 * times. The affix files that do this have an undocumented
5502 * "S" flag on all but the last block, thus we check for that
5503 * and store it in ah_follows. */
5504 vim_strncpy(key
, items
[1], AH_KEY_LEN
- 1);
5505 hi
= hash_find(tp
, key
);
5506 if (!HASHITEM_EMPTY(hi
))
5508 cur_aff
= HI2AH(hi
);
5509 if (cur_aff
->ah_combine
!= (*items
[2] == 'Y'))
5510 smsg((char_u
*)_("Different combining flag in continued affix block in %s line %d: %s"),
5511 fname
, lnum
, items
[1]);
5512 if (!cur_aff
->ah_follows
)
5513 smsg((char_u
*)_("Duplicate affix in %s line %d: %s"),
5514 fname
, lnum
, items
[1]);
5518 /* New affix letter. */
5519 cur_aff
= (affheader_T
*)getroom(spin
,
5520 sizeof(affheader_T
), TRUE
);
5521 if (cur_aff
== NULL
)
5523 cur_aff
->ah_flag
= affitem2flag(aff
->af_flagtype
, items
[1],
5525 if (cur_aff
->ah_flag
== 0 || STRLEN(items
[1]) >= AH_KEY_LEN
)
5527 if (cur_aff
->ah_flag
== aff
->af_bad
5528 || cur_aff
->ah_flag
== aff
->af_rare
5529 || cur_aff
->ah_flag
== aff
->af_keepcase
5530 || cur_aff
->ah_flag
== aff
->af_needaffix
5531 || cur_aff
->ah_flag
== aff
->af_circumfix
5532 || cur_aff
->ah_flag
== aff
->af_nosuggest
5533 || cur_aff
->ah_flag
== aff
->af_needcomp
5534 || cur_aff
->ah_flag
== aff
->af_comproot
)
5535 smsg((char_u
*)_("Affix also used for BAD/RARE/KEEPCASE/NEEDAFFIX/NEEDCOMPOUND/NOSUGGEST in %s line %d: %s"),
5536 fname
, lnum
, items
[1]);
5537 STRCPY(cur_aff
->ah_key
, items
[1]);
5538 hash_add(tp
, cur_aff
->ah_key
);
5540 cur_aff
->ah_combine
= (*items
[2] == 'Y');
5543 /* Check for the "S" flag, which apparently means that another
5544 * block with the same affix name is following. */
5545 if (itemcnt
> lasti
&& STRCMP(items
[lasti
], "S") == 0)
5548 cur_aff
->ah_follows
= TRUE
;
5551 cur_aff
->ah_follows
= FALSE
;
5553 /* Myspell allows extra text after the item, but that might
5554 * mean mistakes go unnoticed. Require a comment-starter. */
5555 if (itemcnt
> lasti
&& *items
[lasti
] != '#')
5556 smsg((char_u
*)_(e_afftrailing
), fname
, lnum
, items
[lasti
]);
5558 if (STRCMP(items
[2], "Y") != 0 && STRCMP(items
[2], "N") != 0)
5559 smsg((char_u
*)_("Expected Y or N in %s line %d: %s"),
5560 fname
, lnum
, items
[2]);
5562 if (*items
[0] == 'P' && aff
->af_pfxpostpone
)
5564 if (cur_aff
->ah_newID
== 0)
5566 /* Use a new number in the .spl file later, to be able
5567 * to handle multiple .aff files. */
5568 check_renumber(spin
);
5569 cur_aff
->ah_newID
= ++spin
->si_newprefID
;
5571 /* We only really use ah_newID if the prefix is
5572 * postponed. We know that only after handling all
5574 did_postpone_prefix
= FALSE
;
5577 /* Did use the ID in a previous block. */
5578 did_postpone_prefix
= TRUE
;
5581 aff_todo
= atoi((char *)items
[3]);
5583 else if ((STRCMP(items
[0], "PFX") == 0
5584 || STRCMP(items
[0], "SFX") == 0)
5586 && STRCMP(cur_aff
->ah_key
, items
[1]) == 0
5589 affentry_T
*aff_entry
;
5593 /* Myspell allows extra text after the item, but that might
5594 * mean mistakes go unnoticed. Require a comment-starter.
5595 * Hunspell uses a "-" item. */
5596 if (itemcnt
> lasti
&& *items
[lasti
] != '#'
5597 && (STRCMP(items
[lasti
], "-") != 0
5598 || itemcnt
!= lasti
+ 1))
5599 smsg((char_u
*)_(e_afftrailing
), fname
, lnum
, items
[lasti
]);
5601 /* New item for an affix letter. */
5603 aff_entry
= (affentry_T
*)getroom(spin
,
5604 sizeof(affentry_T
), TRUE
);
5605 if (aff_entry
== NULL
)
5608 if (STRCMP(items
[2], "0") != 0)
5609 aff_entry
->ae_chop
= getroom_save(spin
, items
[2]);
5610 if (STRCMP(items
[3], "0") != 0)
5612 aff_entry
->ae_add
= getroom_save(spin
, items
[3]);
5614 /* Recognize flags on the affix: abcd/XYZ */
5615 aff_entry
->ae_flags
= vim_strchr(aff_entry
->ae_add
, '/');
5616 if (aff_entry
->ae_flags
!= NULL
)
5618 *aff_entry
->ae_flags
++ = NUL
;
5619 aff_process_flags(aff
, aff_entry
);
5623 /* Don't use an affix entry with non-ASCII characters when
5624 * "spin->si_ascii" is TRUE. */
5625 if (!spin
->si_ascii
|| !(has_non_ascii(aff_entry
->ae_chop
)
5626 || has_non_ascii(aff_entry
->ae_add
)))
5628 aff_entry
->ae_next
= cur_aff
->ah_first
;
5629 cur_aff
->ah_first
= aff_entry
;
5631 if (STRCMP(items
[4], ".") != 0)
5633 char_u buf
[MAXLINELEN
];
5635 aff_entry
->ae_cond
= getroom_save(spin
, items
[4]);
5636 if (*items
[0] == 'P')
5637 sprintf((char *)buf
, "^%s", items
[4]);
5639 sprintf((char *)buf
, "%s$", items
[4]);
5640 aff_entry
->ae_prog
= vim_regcomp(buf
,
5641 RE_MAGIC
+ RE_STRING
+ RE_STRICT
);
5642 if (aff_entry
->ae_prog
== NULL
)
5643 smsg((char_u
*)_("Broken condition in %s line %d: %s"),
5644 fname
, lnum
, items
[4]);
5647 /* For postponed prefixes we need an entry in si_prefcond
5648 * for the condition. Use an existing one if possible.
5649 * Can't be done for an affix with flags, ignoring
5650 * COMPOUNDFORBIDFLAG and COMPOUNDPERMITFLAG. */
5651 if (*items
[0] == 'P' && aff
->af_pfxpostpone
5652 && aff_entry
->ae_flags
== NULL
)
5654 /* When the chop string is one lower-case letter and
5655 * the add string ends in the upper-case letter we set
5656 * the "upper" flag, clear "ae_chop" and remove the
5657 * letters from "ae_add". The condition must either
5658 * be empty or start with the same letter. */
5659 if (aff_entry
->ae_chop
!= NULL
5660 && aff_entry
->ae_add
!= NULL
5662 && aff_entry
->ae_chop
[(*mb_ptr2len
)(
5663 aff_entry
->ae_chop
)] == NUL
5665 && aff_entry
->ae_chop
[1] == NUL
5671 c
= PTR2CHAR(aff_entry
->ae_chop
);
5672 c_up
= SPELL_TOUPPER(c
);
5674 && (aff_entry
->ae_cond
== NULL
5675 || PTR2CHAR(aff_entry
->ae_cond
) == c
))
5677 p
= aff_entry
->ae_add
5678 + STRLEN(aff_entry
->ae_add
);
5679 mb_ptr_back(aff_entry
->ae_add
, p
);
5680 if (PTR2CHAR(p
) == c_up
)
5683 aff_entry
->ae_chop
= NULL
;
5686 /* The condition is matched with the
5687 * actual word, thus must check for the
5688 * upper-case letter. */
5689 if (aff_entry
->ae_cond
!= NULL
)
5691 char_u buf
[MAXLINELEN
];
5695 onecap_copy(items
[4], buf
, TRUE
);
5696 aff_entry
->ae_cond
= getroom_save(
5701 *aff_entry
->ae_cond
= c_up
;
5702 if (aff_entry
->ae_cond
!= NULL
)
5704 sprintf((char *)buf
, "^%s",
5705 aff_entry
->ae_cond
);
5706 vim_free(aff_entry
->ae_prog
);
5707 aff_entry
->ae_prog
= vim_regcomp(
5708 buf
, RE_MAGIC
+ RE_STRING
);
5715 if (aff_entry
->ae_chop
== NULL
5716 && aff_entry
->ae_flags
== NULL
)
5722 /* Find a previously used condition. */
5723 for (idx
= spin
->si_prefcond
.ga_len
- 1; idx
>= 0;
5726 p
= ((char_u
**)spin
->si_prefcond
.ga_data
)[idx
];
5727 if (str_equal(p
, aff_entry
->ae_cond
))
5730 if (idx
< 0 && ga_grow(&spin
->si_prefcond
, 1) == OK
)
5732 /* Not found, add a new condition. */
5733 idx
= spin
->si_prefcond
.ga_len
++;
5734 pp
= ((char_u
**)spin
->si_prefcond
.ga_data
)
5736 if (aff_entry
->ae_cond
== NULL
)
5739 *pp
= getroom_save(spin
,
5740 aff_entry
->ae_cond
);
5743 /* Add the prefix to the prefix tree. */
5744 if (aff_entry
->ae_add
== NULL
)
5747 p
= aff_entry
->ae_add
;
5749 /* PFX_FLAGS is a negative number, so that
5750 * tree_add_word() knows this is the prefix tree. */
5752 if (!cur_aff
->ah_combine
)
5756 if (aff_entry
->ae_comppermit
)
5757 n
|= WFP_COMPPERMIT
;
5758 if (aff_entry
->ae_compforbid
)
5759 n
|= WFP_COMPFORBID
;
5760 tree_add_word(spin
, p
, spin
->si_prefroot
, n
,
5761 idx
, cur_aff
->ah_newID
);
5762 did_postpone_prefix
= TRUE
;
5765 /* Didn't actually use ah_newID, backup si_newprefID. */
5766 if (aff_todo
== 0 && !did_postpone_prefix
)
5768 --spin
->si_newprefID
;
5769 cur_aff
->ah_newID
= 0;
5774 else if (STRCMP(items
[0], "FOL") == 0 && itemcnt
== 2
5777 fol
= vim_strsave(items
[1]);
5779 else if (STRCMP(items
[0], "LOW") == 0 && itemcnt
== 2
5782 low
= vim_strsave(items
[1]);
5784 else if (STRCMP(items
[0], "UPP") == 0 && itemcnt
== 2
5787 upp
= vim_strsave(items
[1]);
5789 else if ((STRCMP(items
[0], "REP") == 0
5790 || STRCMP(items
[0], "REPSAL") == 0)
5793 /* Ignore REP/REPSAL count */;
5794 if (!isdigit(*items
[1]))
5795 smsg((char_u
*)_("Expected REP(SAL) count in %s line %d"),
5798 else if ((STRCMP(items
[0], "REP") == 0
5799 || STRCMP(items
[0], "REPSAL") == 0)
5802 /* REP/REPSAL item */
5803 /* Myspell ignores extra arguments, we require it starts with
5804 * # to detect mistakes. */
5805 if (itemcnt
> 3 && items
[3][0] != '#')
5806 smsg((char_u
*)_(e_afftrailing
), fname
, lnum
, items
[3]);
5807 if (items
[0][3] == 'S' ? do_repsal
: do_rep
)
5809 /* Replace underscore with space (can't include a space
5811 for (p
= items
[1]; *p
!= NUL
; mb_ptr_adv(p
))
5814 for (p
= items
[2]; *p
!= NUL
; mb_ptr_adv(p
))
5817 add_fromto(spin
, items
[0][3] == 'S'
5819 : &spin
->si_rep
, items
[1], items
[2]);
5822 else if (STRCMP(items
[0], "MAP") == 0 && itemcnt
== 2)
5824 /* MAP item or count */
5827 /* First line contains the count. */
5829 if (!isdigit(*items
[1]))
5830 smsg((char_u
*)_("Expected MAP count in %s line %d"),
5833 else if (do_mapline
)
5837 /* Check that every character appears only once. */
5838 for (p
= items
[1]; *p
!= NUL
; )
5841 c
= mb_ptr2char_adv(&p
);
5845 if ((spin
->si_map
.ga_len
> 0
5846 && vim_strchr(spin
->si_map
.ga_data
, c
)
5848 || vim_strchr(p
, c
) != NULL
)
5849 smsg((char_u
*)_("Duplicate character in MAP in %s line %d"),
5853 /* We simply concatenate all the MAP strings, separated by
5855 ga_concat(&spin
->si_map
, items
[1]);
5856 ga_append(&spin
->si_map
, '/');
5859 /* Accept "SAL from to" and "SAL from to # comment". */
5860 else if (STRCMP(items
[0], "SAL") == 0
5861 && (itemcnt
== 3 || (itemcnt
> 3 && items
[3][0] == '#')))
5865 /* SAL item (sounds-a-like)
5866 * Either one of the known keys or a from-to pair. */
5867 if (STRCMP(items
[1], "followup") == 0)
5868 spin
->si_followup
= sal_to_bool(items
[2]);
5869 else if (STRCMP(items
[1], "collapse_result") == 0)
5870 spin
->si_collapse
= sal_to_bool(items
[2]);
5871 else if (STRCMP(items
[1], "remove_accents") == 0)
5872 spin
->si_rem_accents
= sal_to_bool(items
[2]);
5874 /* when "to" is "_" it means empty */
5875 add_fromto(spin
, &spin
->si_sal
, items
[1],
5876 STRCMP(items
[2], "_") == 0 ? (char_u
*)""
5880 else if (STRCMP(items
[0], "SOFOFROM") == 0 && itemcnt
== 2
5881 && sofofrom
== NULL
)
5883 sofofrom
= getroom_save(spin
, items
[1]);
5885 else if (STRCMP(items
[0], "SOFOTO") == 0 && itemcnt
== 2
5888 sofoto
= getroom_save(spin
, items
[1]);
5890 else if (STRCMP(items
[0], "COMMON") == 0)
5894 for (i
= 1; i
< itemcnt
; ++i
)
5896 if (HASHITEM_EMPTY(hash_find(&spin
->si_commonwords
,
5899 p
= vim_strsave(items
[i
]);
5902 hash_add(&spin
->si_commonwords
, p
);
5907 smsg((char_u
*)_("Unrecognized or duplicate item in %s line %d: %s"),
5908 fname
, lnum
, items
[0]);
5912 if (fol
!= NULL
|| low
!= NULL
|| upp
!= NULL
)
5914 if (spin
->si_clear_chartab
)
5916 /* Clear the char type tables, don't want to use any of the
5917 * currently used spell properties. */
5918 init_spell_chartab();
5919 spin
->si_clear_chartab
= FALSE
;
5923 * Don't write a word table for an ASCII file, so that we don't check
5924 * for conflicts with a word table that matches 'encoding'.
5925 * Don't write one for utf-8 either, we use utf_*() and
5926 * mb_get_class(), the list of chars in the file will be incomplete.
5934 if (fol
== NULL
|| low
== NULL
|| upp
== NULL
)
5935 smsg((char_u
*)_("Missing FOL/LOW/UPP line in %s"), fname
);
5937 (void)set_spell_chartab(fol
, low
, upp
);
5945 /* Use compound specifications of the .aff file for the spell info. */
5948 aff_check_number(spin
->si_compmax
, compmax
, "COMPOUNDWORDMAX");
5949 spin
->si_compmax
= compmax
;
5952 if (compminlen
!= 0)
5954 aff_check_number(spin
->si_compminlen
, compminlen
, "COMPOUNDMIN");
5955 spin
->si_compminlen
= compminlen
;
5958 if (compsylmax
!= 0)
5960 if (syllable
== NULL
)
5961 smsg((char_u
*)_("COMPOUNDSYLMAX used without SYLLABLE"));
5962 aff_check_number(spin
->si_compsylmax
, compsylmax
, "COMPOUNDSYLMAX");
5963 spin
->si_compsylmax
= compsylmax
;
5966 if (compoptions
!= 0)
5968 aff_check_number(spin
->si_compoptions
, compoptions
, "COMPOUND options");
5969 spin
->si_compoptions
|= compoptions
;
5972 if (compflags
!= NULL
)
5973 process_compflags(spin
, aff
, compflags
);
5975 /* Check that we didn't use too many renumbered flags. */
5976 if (spin
->si_newcompID
< spin
->si_newprefID
)
5978 if (spin
->si_newcompID
== 127 || spin
->si_newcompID
== 255)
5979 MSG(_("Too many postponed prefixes"));
5980 else if (spin
->si_newprefID
== 0 || spin
->si_newprefID
== 127)
5981 MSG(_("Too many compound flags"));
5983 MSG(_("Too many posponed prefixes and/or compound flags"));
5986 if (syllable
!= NULL
)
5988 aff_check_string(spin
->si_syllable
, syllable
, "SYLLABLE");
5989 spin
->si_syllable
= syllable
;
5992 if (sofofrom
!= NULL
|| sofoto
!= NULL
)
5994 if (sofofrom
== NULL
|| sofoto
== NULL
)
5995 smsg((char_u
*)_("Missing SOFO%s line in %s"),
5996 sofofrom
== NULL
? "FROM" : "TO", fname
);
5997 else if (spin
->si_sal
.ga_len
> 0)
5998 smsg((char_u
*)_("Both SAL and SOFO lines in %s"), fname
);
6001 aff_check_string(spin
->si_sofofr
, sofofrom
, "SOFOFROM");
6002 aff_check_string(spin
->si_sofoto
, sofoto
, "SOFOTO");
6003 spin
->si_sofofr
= sofofrom
;
6004 spin
->si_sofoto
= sofoto
;
6008 if (midword
!= NULL
)
6010 aff_check_string(spin
->si_midword
, midword
, "MIDWORD");
6011 spin
->si_midword
= midword
;
6020 * For affix "entry" move COMPOUNDFORBIDFLAG and COMPOUNDPERMITFLAG from
6021 * ae_flags to ae_comppermit and ae_compforbid.
6024 aff_process_flags(affile
, entry
)
6032 if (entry
->ae_flags
!= NULL
6033 && (affile
->af_compforbid
!= 0 || affile
->af_comppermit
!= 0))
6035 for (p
= entry
->ae_flags
; *p
!= NUL
; )
6038 flag
= get_affitem(affile
->af_flagtype
, &p
);
6039 if (flag
== affile
->af_comppermit
|| flag
== affile
->af_compforbid
)
6043 if (flag
== affile
->af_comppermit
)
6044 entry
->ae_comppermit
= TRUE
;
6046 entry
->ae_compforbid
= TRUE
;
6048 if (affile
->af_flagtype
== AFT_NUM
&& *p
== ',')
6051 if (*entry
->ae_flags
== NUL
)
6052 entry
->ae_flags
= NULL
; /* nothing left */
6057 * Return TRUE if "s" is the name of an info item in the affix file.
6063 return STRCMP(s
, "NAME") == 0
6064 || STRCMP(s
, "HOME") == 0
6065 || STRCMP(s
, "VERSION") == 0
6066 || STRCMP(s
, "AUTHOR") == 0
6067 || STRCMP(s
, "EMAIL") == 0
6068 || STRCMP(s
, "COPYRIGHT") == 0;
6072 * Turn an affix flag name into a number, according to the FLAG type.
6073 * returns zero for failure.
6076 affitem2flag(flagtype
, item
, fname
, lnum
)
6085 res
= get_affitem(flagtype
, &p
);
6088 if (flagtype
== AFT_NUM
)
6089 smsg((char_u
*)_("Flag is not a number in %s line %d: %s"),
6092 smsg((char_u
*)_("Illegal flag in %s line %d: %s"),
6097 smsg((char_u
*)_(e_affname
), fname
, lnum
, item
);
6105 * Get one affix name from "*pp" and advance the pointer.
6106 * Returns zero for an error, still advances the pointer then.
6109 get_affitem(flagtype
, pp
)
6115 if (flagtype
== AFT_NUM
)
6117 if (!VIM_ISDIGIT(**pp
))
6119 ++*pp
; /* always advance, avoid getting stuck */
6122 res
= getdigits(pp
);
6127 res
= mb_ptr2char_adv(pp
);
6131 if (flagtype
== AFT_LONG
|| (flagtype
== AFT_CAPLONG
6132 && res
>= 'A' && res
<= 'Z'))
6137 res
= mb_ptr2char_adv(pp
) + (res
<< 16);
6139 res
= *(*pp
)++ + (res
<< 16);
6147 * Process the "compflags" string used in an affix file and append it to
6148 * spin->si_compflags.
6149 * The processing involves changing the affix names to ID numbers, so that
6150 * they fit in one byte.
6153 process_compflags(spin
, aff
, compflags
)
6165 char_u key
[AH_KEY_LEN
];
6168 /* Make room for the old and the new compflags, concatenated with a / in
6169 * between. Processing it makes it shorter, but we don't know by how
6170 * much, thus allocate the maximum. */
6171 len
= (int)STRLEN(compflags
) + 1;
6172 if (spin
->si_compflags
!= NULL
)
6173 len
+= (int)STRLEN(spin
->si_compflags
) + 1;
6174 p
= getroom(spin
, len
, FALSE
);
6177 if (spin
->si_compflags
!= NULL
)
6179 STRCPY(p
, spin
->si_compflags
);
6182 spin
->si_compflags
= p
;
6185 for (p
= compflags
; *p
!= NUL
; )
6187 if (vim_strchr((char_u
*)"/*+[]", *p
) != NULL
)
6188 /* Copy non-flag characters directly. */
6192 /* First get the flag number, also checks validity. */
6194 flag
= get_affitem(aff
->af_flagtype
, &p
);
6197 /* Find the flag in the hashtable. If it was used before, use
6198 * the existing ID. Otherwise add a new entry. */
6199 vim_strncpy(key
, prevp
, p
- prevp
);
6200 hi
= hash_find(&aff
->af_comp
, key
);
6201 if (!HASHITEM_EMPTY(hi
))
6202 id
= HI2CI(hi
)->ci_newID
;
6205 ci
= (compitem_T
*)getroom(spin
, sizeof(compitem_T
), TRUE
);
6208 STRCPY(ci
->ci_key
, key
);
6210 /* Avoid using a flag ID that has a special meaning in a
6211 * regexp (also inside []). */
6214 check_renumber(spin
);
6215 id
= spin
->si_newcompID
--;
6216 } while (vim_strchr((char_u
*)"/+*[]\\-^", id
) != NULL
);
6218 hash_add(&aff
->af_comp
, ci
->ci_key
);
6222 if (aff
->af_flagtype
== AFT_NUM
&& *p
== ',')
6231 * Check that the new IDs for postponed affixes and compounding don't overrun
6232 * each other. We have almost 255 available, but start at 0-127 to avoid
6233 * using two bytes for utf-8. When the 0-127 range is used up go to 128-255.
6234 * When that is used up an error message is given.
6237 check_renumber(spin
)
6240 if (spin
->si_newprefID
== spin
->si_newcompID
&& spin
->si_newcompID
< 128)
6242 spin
->si_newprefID
= 127;
6243 spin
->si_newcompID
= 255;
6248 * Return TRUE if flag "flag" appears in affix list "afflist".
6251 flag_in_afflist(flagtype
, afflist
, flag
)
6262 return vim_strchr(afflist
, flag
) != NULL
;
6266 for (p
= afflist
; *p
!= NUL
; )
6269 n
= mb_ptr2char_adv(&p
);
6273 if ((flagtype
== AFT_LONG
|| (n
>= 'A' && n
<= 'Z'))
6276 n
= mb_ptr2char_adv(&p
) + (n
<< 16);
6278 n
= *p
++ + (n
<< 16);
6286 for (p
= afflist
; *p
!= NUL
; )
6291 if (*p
!= NUL
) /* skip over comma */
6300 * Give a warning when "spinval" and "affval" numbers are set and not the same.
6303 aff_check_number(spinval
, affval
, name
)
6308 if (spinval
!= 0 && spinval
!= affval
)
6309 smsg((char_u
*)_("%s value differs from what is used in another .aff file"), name
);
6313 * Give a warning when "spinval" and "affval" strings are set and not the same.
6316 aff_check_string(spinval
, affval
, name
)
6321 if (spinval
!= NULL
&& STRCMP(spinval
, affval
) != 0)
6322 smsg((char_u
*)_("%s value differs from what is used in another .aff file"), name
);
6326 * Return TRUE if strings "s1" and "s2" are equal. Also consider both being
6334 if (s1
== NULL
|| s2
== NULL
)
6336 return STRCMP(s1
, s2
) == 0;
6340 * Add a from-to item to "gap". Used for REP and SAL items.
6341 * They are stored case-folded.
6344 add_fromto(spin
, gap
, from
, to
)
6351 char_u word
[MAXWLEN
];
6353 if (ga_grow(gap
, 1) == OK
)
6355 ftp
= ((fromto_T
*)gap
->ga_data
) + gap
->ga_len
;
6356 (void)spell_casefold(from
, (int)STRLEN(from
), word
, MAXWLEN
);
6357 ftp
->ft_from
= getroom_save(spin
, word
);
6358 (void)spell_casefold(to
, (int)STRLEN(to
), word
, MAXWLEN
);
6359 ftp
->ft_to
= getroom_save(spin
, word
);
6365 * Convert a boolean argument in a SAL line to TRUE or FALSE;
6371 return STRCMP(s
, "1") == 0 || STRCMP(s
, "true") == 0;
6375 * Return TRUE if string "s" contains a non-ASCII character (128 or higher).
6376 * When "s" is NULL FALSE is returned.
6385 for (p
= s
; *p
!= NUL
; ++p
)
6392 * Free the structure filled by spell_read_aff().
6404 vim_free(aff
->af_enc
);
6406 /* All this trouble to free the "ae_prog" items... */
6407 for (ht
= &aff
->af_pref
; ; ht
= &aff
->af_suff
)
6409 todo
= (int)ht
->ht_used
;
6410 for (hi
= ht
->ht_array
; todo
> 0; ++hi
)
6412 if (!HASHITEM_EMPTY(hi
))
6416 for (ae
= ah
->ah_first
; ae
!= NULL
; ae
= ae
->ae_next
)
6417 vim_free(ae
->ae_prog
);
6420 if (ht
== &aff
->af_suff
)
6424 hash_clear(&aff
->af_pref
);
6425 hash_clear(&aff
->af_suff
);
6426 hash_clear(&aff
->af_comp
);
6430 * Read dictionary file "fname".
6431 * Returns OK or FAIL;
6434 spell_read_dic(spin
, fname
, affile
)
6440 char_u line
[MAXLINELEN
];
6443 char_u store_afflist
[MAXWLEN
];
6456 char_u message
[MAXLINELEN
+ MAXWLEN
];
6463 fd
= mch_fopen((char *)fname
, "r");
6466 EMSG2(_(e_notopen
), fname
);
6470 /* The hashtable is only used to detect duplicated words. */
6473 vim_snprintf((char *)IObuff
, IOSIZE
,
6474 _("Reading dictionary file %s ..."), fname
);
6475 spell_message(spin
, IObuff
);
6477 /* start with a message for the first line */
6478 spin
->si_msg_count
= 999999;
6480 /* Read and ignore the first line: word count. */
6481 (void)vim_fgets(line
, MAXLINELEN
, fd
);
6482 if (!vim_isdigit(*skipwhite(line
)))
6483 EMSG2(_("E760: No word count in %s"), fname
);
6486 * Read all the lines in the file one by one.
6487 * The words are converted to 'encoding' here, before being added to
6490 while (!vim_fgets(line
, MAXLINELEN
, fd
) && !got_int
)
6494 if (line
[0] == '#' || line
[0] == '/')
6495 continue; /* comment line */
6497 /* Remove CR, LF and white space from the end. White space halfway
6498 * the word is kept to allow e.g., "et al.". */
6499 l
= (int)STRLEN(line
);
6500 while (l
> 0 && line
[l
- 1] <= ' ')
6503 continue; /* empty line */
6507 /* Convert from "SET" to 'encoding' when needed. */
6508 if (spin
->si_conv
.vc_type
!= CONV_NONE
)
6510 pc
= string_convert(&spin
->si_conv
, line
, NULL
);
6513 smsg((char_u
*)_("Conversion failure for word in %s line %d: %s"),
6526 /* Truncate the word at the "/", set "afflist" to what follows.
6527 * Replace "\/" by "/" and "\\" by "\". */
6529 for (p
= w
; *p
!= NUL
; mb_ptr_adv(p
))
6531 if (*p
== '\\' && (p
[1] == '\\' || p
[1] == '/'))
6541 /* Skip non-ASCII words when "spin->si_ascii" is TRUE. */
6542 if (spin
->si_ascii
&& has_non_ascii(w
))
6549 /* This takes time, print a message every 10000 words. */
6550 if (spin
->si_verbose
&& spin
->si_msg_count
> 10000)
6552 spin
->si_msg_count
= 0;
6553 vim_snprintf((char *)message
, sizeof(message
),
6554 _("line %6d, word %6d - %s"),
6555 lnum
, spin
->si_foldwcount
+ spin
->si_keepwcount
, w
);
6557 msg_puts_long_attr(message
, 0);
6564 /* Store the word in the hashtable to be able to find duplicates. */
6565 dw
= (char_u
*)getroom_save(spin
, w
);
6573 hash
= hash_hash(dw
);
6574 hi
= hash_lookup(&ht
, dw
, hash
);
6575 if (!HASHITEM_EMPTY(hi
))
6578 smsg((char_u
*)_("Duplicate word in %s line %d: %s"),
6580 else if (duplicate
== 0)
6581 smsg((char_u
*)_("First duplicate word in %s line %d: %s"),
6586 hash_add_item(&ht
, hi
, dw
, hash
);
6589 store_afflist
[0] = NUL
;
6592 if (afflist
!= NULL
)
6594 /* Extract flags from the affix list. */
6595 flags
|= get_affix_flags(affile
, afflist
);
6597 if (affile
->af_needaffix
!= 0 && flag_in_afflist(
6598 affile
->af_flagtype
, afflist
, affile
->af_needaffix
))
6601 if (affile
->af_pfxpostpone
)
6602 /* Need to store the list of prefix IDs with the word. */
6603 pfxlen
= get_pfxlist(affile
, afflist
, store_afflist
);
6605 if (spin
->si_compflags
!= NULL
)
6606 /* Need to store the list of compound flags with the word.
6607 * Concatenate them to the list of prefix IDs. */
6608 get_compflags(affile
, afflist
, store_afflist
+ pfxlen
);
6611 /* Add the word to the word tree(s). */
6612 if (store_word(spin
, dw
, flags
, spin
->si_region
,
6613 store_afflist
, need_affix
) == FAIL
)
6616 if (afflist
!= NULL
)
6618 /* Find all matching suffixes and add the resulting words.
6619 * Additionally do matching prefixes that combine. */
6620 if (store_aff_word(spin
, dw
, afflist
, affile
,
6621 &affile
->af_suff
, &affile
->af_pref
,
6622 CONDIT_SUF
, flags
, store_afflist
, pfxlen
) == FAIL
)
6625 /* Find all matching prefixes and add the resulting words. */
6626 if (store_aff_word(spin
, dw
, afflist
, affile
,
6627 &affile
->af_pref
, NULL
,
6628 CONDIT_SUF
, flags
, store_afflist
, pfxlen
) == FAIL
)
6636 smsg((char_u
*)_("%d duplicate word(s) in %s"), duplicate
, fname
);
6637 if (spin
->si_ascii
&& non_ascii
> 0)
6638 smsg((char_u
*)_("Ignored %d word(s) with non-ASCII characters in %s"),
6647 * Check for affix flags in "afflist" that are turned into word flags.
6651 get_affix_flags(affile
, afflist
)
6657 if (affile
->af_keepcase
!= 0 && flag_in_afflist(
6658 affile
->af_flagtype
, afflist
, affile
->af_keepcase
))
6659 flags
|= WF_KEEPCAP
| WF_FIXCAP
;
6660 if (affile
->af_rare
!= 0 && flag_in_afflist(
6661 affile
->af_flagtype
, afflist
, affile
->af_rare
))
6663 if (affile
->af_bad
!= 0 && flag_in_afflist(
6664 affile
->af_flagtype
, afflist
, affile
->af_bad
))
6666 if (affile
->af_needcomp
!= 0 && flag_in_afflist(
6667 affile
->af_flagtype
, afflist
, affile
->af_needcomp
))
6668 flags
|= WF_NEEDCOMP
;
6669 if (affile
->af_comproot
!= 0 && flag_in_afflist(
6670 affile
->af_flagtype
, afflist
, affile
->af_comproot
))
6671 flags
|= WF_COMPROOT
;
6672 if (affile
->af_nosuggest
!= 0 && flag_in_afflist(
6673 affile
->af_flagtype
, afflist
, affile
->af_nosuggest
))
6674 flags
|= WF_NOSUGGEST
;
6679 * Get the list of prefix IDs from the affix list "afflist".
6680 * Used for PFXPOSTPONE.
6681 * Put the resulting flags in "store_afflist[MAXWLEN]" with a terminating NUL
6682 * and return the number of affixes.
6685 get_pfxlist(affile
, afflist
, store_afflist
)
6688 char_u
*store_afflist
;
6694 char_u key
[AH_KEY_LEN
];
6697 for (p
= afflist
; *p
!= NUL
; )
6700 if (get_affitem(affile
->af_flagtype
, &p
) != 0)
6702 /* A flag is a postponed prefix flag if it appears in "af_pref"
6703 * and it's ID is not zero. */
6704 vim_strncpy(key
, prevp
, p
- prevp
);
6705 hi
= hash_find(&affile
->af_pref
, key
);
6706 if (!HASHITEM_EMPTY(hi
))
6708 id
= HI2AH(hi
)->ah_newID
;
6710 store_afflist
[cnt
++] = id
;
6713 if (affile
->af_flagtype
== AFT_NUM
&& *p
== ',')
6717 store_afflist
[cnt
] = NUL
;
6722 * Get the list of compound IDs from the affix list "afflist" that are used
6723 * for compound words.
6724 * Puts the flags in "store_afflist[]".
6727 get_compflags(affile
, afflist
, store_afflist
)
6730 char_u
*store_afflist
;
6735 char_u key
[AH_KEY_LEN
];
6738 for (p
= afflist
; *p
!= NUL
; )
6741 if (get_affitem(affile
->af_flagtype
, &p
) != 0)
6743 /* A flag is a compound flag if it appears in "af_comp". */
6744 vim_strncpy(key
, prevp
, p
- prevp
);
6745 hi
= hash_find(&affile
->af_comp
, key
);
6746 if (!HASHITEM_EMPTY(hi
))
6747 store_afflist
[cnt
++] = HI2CI(hi
)->ci_newID
;
6749 if (affile
->af_flagtype
== AFT_NUM
&& *p
== ',')
6753 store_afflist
[cnt
] = NUL
;
6757 * Apply affixes to a word and store the resulting words.
6758 * "ht" is the hashtable with affentry_T that need to be applied, either
6759 * prefixes or suffixes.
6760 * "xht", when not NULL, is the prefix hashtable, to be used additionally on
6761 * the resulting words for combining affixes.
6763 * Returns FAIL when out of memory.
6766 store_aff_word(spin
, word
, afflist
, affile
, ht
, xht
, condit
, flags
,
6768 spellinfo_T
*spin
; /* spell info */
6769 char_u
*word
; /* basic word start */
6770 char_u
*afflist
; /* list of names of supported affixes */
6774 int condit
; /* CONDIT_SUF et al. */
6775 int flags
; /* flags for the word */
6776 char_u
*pfxlist
; /* list of prefix IDs */
6777 int pfxlen
; /* nr of flags in "pfxlist" for prefixes, rest
6778 * is compound flags */
6784 regmatch_T regmatch
;
6785 char_u newword
[MAXWLEN
];
6790 char_u
*use_pfxlist
;
6793 char_u store_afflist
[MAXWLEN
];
6794 char_u pfx_pfxlist
[MAXWLEN
];
6795 size_t wordlen
= STRLEN(word
);
6798 todo
= (int)ht
->ht_used
;
6799 for (hi
= ht
->ht_array
; todo
> 0 && retval
== OK
; ++hi
)
6801 if (!HASHITEM_EMPTY(hi
))
6806 /* Check that the affix combines, if required, and that the word
6807 * supports this affix. */
6808 if (((condit
& CONDIT_COMB
) == 0 || ah
->ah_combine
)
6809 && flag_in_afflist(affile
->af_flagtype
, afflist
,
6812 /* Loop over all affix entries with this name. */
6813 for (ae
= ah
->ah_first
; ae
!= NULL
; ae
= ae
->ae_next
)
6815 /* Check the condition. It's not logical to match case
6816 * here, but it is required for compatibility with
6818 * Another requirement from Myspell is that the chop
6819 * string is shorter than the word itself.
6820 * For prefixes, when "PFXPOSTPONE" was used, only do
6821 * prefixes with a chop string and/or flags.
6822 * When a previously added affix had CIRCUMFIX this one
6823 * must have it too, if it had not then this one must not
6824 * have one either. */
6825 regmatch
.regprog
= ae
->ae_prog
;
6826 regmatch
.rm_ic
= FALSE
;
6827 if ((xht
!= NULL
|| !affile
->af_pfxpostpone
6828 || ae
->ae_chop
!= NULL
6829 || ae
->ae_flags
!= NULL
)
6830 && (ae
->ae_chop
== NULL
6831 || STRLEN(ae
->ae_chop
) < wordlen
)
6832 && (ae
->ae_prog
== NULL
6833 || vim_regexec(®match
, word
, (colnr_T
)0))
6834 && (((condit
& CONDIT_CFIX
) == 0)
6835 == ((condit
& CONDIT_AFF
) == 0
6836 || ae
->ae_flags
== NULL
6837 || !flag_in_afflist(affile
->af_flagtype
,
6838 ae
->ae_flags
, affile
->af_circumfix
))))
6840 /* Match. Remove the chop and add the affix. */
6843 /* prefix: chop/add at the start of the word */
6844 if (ae
->ae_add
== NULL
)
6847 STRCPY(newword
, ae
->ae_add
);
6849 if (ae
->ae_chop
!= NULL
)
6851 /* Skip chop string. */
6855 i
= mb_charlen(ae
->ae_chop
);
6861 p
+= STRLEN(ae
->ae_chop
);
6867 /* suffix: chop/add at the end of the word */
6868 STRCPY(newword
, word
);
6869 if (ae
->ae_chop
!= NULL
)
6871 /* Remove chop string. */
6872 p
= newword
+ STRLEN(newword
);
6873 i
= (int)MB_CHARLEN(ae
->ae_chop
);
6875 mb_ptr_back(newword
, p
);
6878 if (ae
->ae_add
!= NULL
)
6879 STRCAT(newword
, ae
->ae_add
);
6883 use_pfxlist
= pfxlist
;
6884 use_pfxlen
= pfxlen
;
6886 use_condit
= condit
| CONDIT_COMB
| CONDIT_AFF
;
6887 if (ae
->ae_flags
!= NULL
)
6889 /* Extract flags from the affix list. */
6890 use_flags
|= get_affix_flags(affile
, ae
->ae_flags
);
6892 if (affile
->af_needaffix
!= 0 && flag_in_afflist(
6893 affile
->af_flagtype
, ae
->ae_flags
,
6894 affile
->af_needaffix
))
6897 /* When there is a CIRCUMFIX flag the other affix
6898 * must also have it and we don't add the word
6899 * with one affix. */
6900 if (affile
->af_circumfix
!= 0 && flag_in_afflist(
6901 affile
->af_flagtype
, ae
->ae_flags
,
6902 affile
->af_circumfix
))
6904 use_condit
|= CONDIT_CFIX
;
6905 if ((condit
& CONDIT_CFIX
) == 0)
6909 if (affile
->af_pfxpostpone
6910 || spin
->si_compflags
!= NULL
)
6912 if (affile
->af_pfxpostpone
)
6913 /* Get prefix IDS from the affix list. */
6914 use_pfxlen
= get_pfxlist(affile
,
6915 ae
->ae_flags
, store_afflist
);
6918 use_pfxlist
= store_afflist
;
6920 /* Combine the prefix IDs. Avoid adding the
6922 for (i
= 0; i
< pfxlen
; ++i
)
6924 for (j
= 0; j
< use_pfxlen
; ++j
)
6925 if (pfxlist
[i
] == use_pfxlist
[j
])
6927 if (j
== use_pfxlen
)
6928 use_pfxlist
[use_pfxlen
++] = pfxlist
[i
];
6931 if (spin
->si_compflags
!= NULL
)
6932 /* Get compound IDS from the affix list. */
6933 get_compflags(affile
, ae
->ae_flags
,
6934 use_pfxlist
+ use_pfxlen
);
6936 /* Combine the list of compound flags.
6937 * Concatenate them to the prefix IDs list.
6938 * Avoid adding the same ID twice. */
6939 for (i
= pfxlen
; pfxlist
[i
] != NUL
; ++i
)
6941 for (j
= use_pfxlen
;
6942 use_pfxlist
[j
] != NUL
; ++j
)
6943 if (pfxlist
[i
] == use_pfxlist
[j
])
6945 if (use_pfxlist
[j
] == NUL
)
6947 use_pfxlist
[j
++] = pfxlist
[i
];
6948 use_pfxlist
[j
] = NUL
;
6954 /* Obey a "COMPOUNDFORBIDFLAG" of the affix: don't
6955 * use the compound flags. */
6956 if (use_pfxlist
!= NULL
&& ae
->ae_compforbid
)
6958 vim_strncpy(pfx_pfxlist
, use_pfxlist
, use_pfxlen
);
6959 use_pfxlist
= pfx_pfxlist
;
6962 /* When there are postponed prefixes... */
6963 if (spin
->si_prefroot
!= NULL
6964 && spin
->si_prefroot
->wn_sibling
!= NULL
)
6966 /* ... add a flag to indicate an affix was used. */
6967 use_flags
|= WF_HAS_AFF
;
6969 /* ... don't use a prefix list if combining
6970 * affixes is not allowed. But do use the
6971 * compound flags after them. */
6972 if (!ah
->ah_combine
&& use_pfxlist
!= NULL
)
6973 use_pfxlist
+= use_pfxlen
;
6976 /* When compounding is supported and there is no
6977 * "COMPOUNDPERMITFLAG" then forbid compounding on the
6978 * side where the affix is applied. */
6979 if (spin
->si_compflags
!= NULL
&& !ae
->ae_comppermit
)
6982 use_flags
|= WF_NOCOMPAFT
;
6984 use_flags
|= WF_NOCOMPBEF
;
6987 /* Store the modified word. */
6988 if (store_word(spin
, newword
, use_flags
,
6989 spin
->si_region
, use_pfxlist
,
6990 need_affix
) == FAIL
)
6993 /* When added a prefix or a first suffix and the affix
6994 * has flags may add a(nother) suffix. RECURSIVE! */
6995 if ((condit
& CONDIT_SUF
) && ae
->ae_flags
!= NULL
)
6996 if (store_aff_word(spin
, newword
, ae
->ae_flags
,
6997 affile
, &affile
->af_suff
, xht
,
6998 use_condit
& (xht
== NULL
6999 ? ~0 : ~CONDIT_SUF
),
7000 use_flags
, use_pfxlist
, pfxlen
) == FAIL
)
7003 /* When added a suffix and combining is allowed also
7004 * try adding a prefix additionally. Both for the
7005 * word flags and for the affix flags. RECURSIVE! */
7006 if (xht
!= NULL
&& ah
->ah_combine
)
7008 if (store_aff_word(spin
, newword
,
7010 xht
, NULL
, use_condit
,
7011 use_flags
, use_pfxlist
,
7013 || (ae
->ae_flags
!= NULL
7014 && store_aff_word(spin
, newword
,
7015 ae
->ae_flags
, affile
,
7016 xht
, NULL
, use_condit
,
7017 use_flags
, use_pfxlist
,
7031 * Read a file with a list of words.
7034 spell_read_wordfile(spin
, fname
)
7040 char_u rline
[MAXLINELEN
];
7046 int did_word
= FALSE
;
7054 fd
= mch_fopen((char *)fname
, "r");
7057 EMSG2(_(e_notopen
), fname
);
7061 vim_snprintf((char *)IObuff
, IOSIZE
, _("Reading word file %s ..."), fname
);
7062 spell_message(spin
, IObuff
);
7065 * Read all the lines in the file one by one.
7067 while (!vim_fgets(rline
, MAXLINELEN
, fd
) && !got_int
)
7072 /* Skip comment lines. */
7076 /* Remove CR, LF and white space from the end. */
7077 l
= (int)STRLEN(rline
);
7078 while (l
> 0 && rline
[l
- 1] <= ' ')
7081 continue; /* empty or blank line */
7084 /* Convert from "/encoding={encoding}" to 'encoding' when needed. */
7087 if (spin
->si_conv
.vc_type
!= CONV_NONE
)
7089 pc
= string_convert(&spin
->si_conv
, rline
, NULL
);
7092 smsg((char_u
*)_("Conversion failure for word in %s line %d: %s"),
7093 fname
, lnum
, rline
);
7108 if (STRNCMP(line
, "encoding=", 9) == 0)
7110 if (spin
->si_conv
.vc_type
!= CONV_NONE
)
7111 smsg((char_u
*)_("Duplicate /encoding= line ignored in %s line %d: %s"),
7112 fname
, lnum
, line
- 1);
7114 smsg((char_u
*)_("/encoding= line after word ignored in %s line %d: %s"),
7115 fname
, lnum
, line
- 1);
7121 /* Setup for conversion to 'encoding'. */
7123 enc
= enc_canonize(line
);
7124 if (enc
!= NULL
&& !spin
->si_ascii
7125 && convert_setup(&spin
->si_conv
, enc
,
7127 smsg((char_u
*)_("Conversion in %s not supported: from %s to %s"),
7128 fname
, line
, p_enc
);
7130 spin
->si_conv
.vc_fail
= TRUE
;
7132 smsg((char_u
*)_("Conversion in %s not supported"), fname
);
7138 if (STRNCMP(line
, "regions=", 8) == 0)
7140 if (spin
->si_region_count
> 1)
7141 smsg((char_u
*)_("Duplicate /regions= line ignored in %s line %d: %s"),
7146 if (STRLEN(line
) > 16)
7147 smsg((char_u
*)_("Too many regions in %s line %d: %s"),
7151 spin
->si_region_count
= (int)STRLEN(line
) / 2;
7152 STRCPY(spin
->si_region_name
, line
);
7154 /* Adjust the mask for a word valid in all regions. */
7155 spin
->si_region
= (1 << spin
->si_region_count
) - 1;
7161 smsg((char_u
*)_("/ line ignored in %s line %d: %s"),
7162 fname
, lnum
, line
- 1);
7167 regionmask
= spin
->si_region
;
7169 /* Check for flags and region after a slash. */
7170 p
= vim_strchr(line
, '/');
7176 if (*p
== '=') /* keep-case word */
7177 flags
|= WF_KEEPCAP
| WF_FIXCAP
;
7178 else if (*p
== '!') /* Bad, bad, wicked word. */
7180 else if (*p
== '?') /* Rare word. */
7182 else if (VIM_ISDIGIT(*p
)) /* region number(s) */
7184 if ((flags
& WF_REGION
) == 0) /* first one */
7189 if (l
> spin
->si_region_count
)
7191 smsg((char_u
*)_("Invalid region nr in %s line %d: %s"),
7195 regionmask
|= 1 << (l
- 1);
7199 smsg((char_u
*)_("Unrecognized flags in %s line %d: %s"),
7207 /* Skip non-ASCII words when "spin->si_ascii" is TRUE. */
7208 if (spin
->si_ascii
&& has_non_ascii(line
))
7214 /* Normal word: store it. */
7215 if (store_word(spin
, line
, flags
, regionmask
, NULL
, FALSE
) == FAIL
)
7226 if (spin
->si_ascii
&& non_ascii
> 0)
7228 vim_snprintf((char *)IObuff
, IOSIZE
,
7229 _("Ignored %d words with non-ASCII characters"), non_ascii
);
7230 spell_message(spin
, IObuff
);
7237 * Get part of an sblock_T, "len" bytes long.
7238 * This avoids calling free() for every little struct we use (and keeping
7240 * The memory is cleared to all zeros.
7241 * Returns NULL when out of memory.
7244 getroom(spin
, len
, align
)
7246 size_t len
; /* length needed */
7247 int align
; /* align for pointer */
7250 sblock_T
*bl
= spin
->si_blocks
;
7252 if (align
&& bl
!= NULL
)
7253 /* Round size up for alignment. On some systems structures need to be
7254 * aligned to the size of a pointer (e.g., SPARC). */
7255 bl
->sb_used
= (bl
->sb_used
+ sizeof(char *) - 1)
7256 & ~(sizeof(char *) - 1);
7258 if (bl
== NULL
|| bl
->sb_used
+ len
> SBLOCKSIZE
)
7260 /* Allocate a block of memory. This is not freed until much later. */
7261 bl
= (sblock_T
*)alloc_clear((unsigned)(sizeof(sblock_T
) + SBLOCKSIZE
));
7264 bl
->sb_next
= spin
->si_blocks
;
7265 spin
->si_blocks
= bl
;
7267 ++spin
->si_blocks_cnt
;
7270 p
= bl
->sb_data
+ bl
->sb_used
;
7271 bl
->sb_used
+= (int)len
;
7277 * Make a copy of a string into memory allocated with getroom().
7280 getroom_save(spin
, s
)
7286 sc
= (char_u
*)getroom(spin
, STRLEN(s
) + 1, FALSE
);
7294 * Free the list of allocated sblock_T.
7311 * Allocate the root of a word tree.
7314 wordtree_alloc(spin
)
7317 return (wordnode_T
*)getroom(spin
, sizeof(wordnode_T
), TRUE
);
7321 * Store a word in the tree(s).
7322 * Always store it in the case-folded tree. For a keep-case word this is
7323 * useful when the word can also be used with all caps (no WF_FIXCAP flag) and
7324 * used to find suggestions.
7325 * For a keep-case word also store it in the keep-case tree.
7326 * When "pfxlist" is not NULL store the word for each postponed prefix ID and
7330 store_word(spin
, word
, flags
, region
, pfxlist
, need_affix
)
7333 int flags
; /* extra flags, WF_BANNED */
7334 int region
; /* supported region(s) */
7335 char_u
*pfxlist
; /* list of prefix IDs or NULL */
7336 int need_affix
; /* only store word with affix ID */
7338 int len
= (int)STRLEN(word
);
7339 int ct
= captype(word
, word
+ len
);
7340 char_u foldword
[MAXWLEN
];
7344 (void)spell_casefold(word
, len
, foldword
, MAXWLEN
);
7345 for (p
= pfxlist
; res
== OK
; ++p
)
7347 if (!need_affix
|| (p
!= NULL
&& *p
!= NUL
))
7348 res
= tree_add_word(spin
, foldword
, spin
->si_foldroot
, ct
| flags
,
7349 region
, p
== NULL
? 0 : *p
);
7350 if (p
== NULL
|| *p
== NUL
)
7353 ++spin
->si_foldwcount
;
7355 if (res
== OK
&& (ct
== WF_KEEPCAP
|| (flags
& WF_KEEPCAP
)))
7357 for (p
= pfxlist
; res
== OK
; ++p
)
7359 if (!need_affix
|| (p
!= NULL
&& *p
!= NUL
))
7360 res
= tree_add_word(spin
, word
, spin
->si_keeproot
, flags
,
7361 region
, p
== NULL
? 0 : *p
);
7362 if (p
== NULL
|| *p
== NUL
)
7365 ++spin
->si_keepwcount
;
7371 * Add word "word" to a word tree at "root".
7372 * When "flags" < 0 we are adding to the prefix tree where "flags" is used for
7373 * "rare" and "region" is the condition nr.
7374 * Returns FAIL when out of memory.
7377 tree_add_word(spin
, word
, root
, flags
, region
, affixID
)
7385 wordnode_T
*node
= root
;
7387 wordnode_T
*copyp
, **copyprev
;
7388 wordnode_T
**prev
= NULL
;
7391 /* Add each byte of the word to the tree, including the NUL at the end. */
7394 /* When there is more than one reference to this node we need to make
7395 * a copy, so that we can modify it. Copy the whole list of siblings
7396 * (we don't optimize for a partly shared list of siblings). */
7397 if (node
!= NULL
&& node
->wn_refs
> 1)
7401 for (copyp
= node
; copyp
!= NULL
; copyp
= copyp
->wn_sibling
)
7403 /* Allocate a new node and copy the info. */
7404 np
= get_wordnode(spin
);
7407 np
->wn_child
= copyp
->wn_child
;
7408 if (np
->wn_child
!= NULL
)
7409 ++np
->wn_child
->wn_refs
; /* child gets extra ref */
7410 np
->wn_byte
= copyp
->wn_byte
;
7411 if (np
->wn_byte
== NUL
)
7413 np
->wn_flags
= copyp
->wn_flags
;
7414 np
->wn_region
= copyp
->wn_region
;
7415 np
->wn_affixID
= copyp
->wn_affixID
;
7418 /* Link the new node in the list, there will be one ref. */
7420 if (copyprev
!= NULL
)
7422 copyprev
= &np
->wn_sibling
;
7424 /* Let "node" point to the head of the copied list. */
7430 /* Look for the sibling that has the same character. They are sorted
7431 * on byte value, thus stop searching when a sibling is found with a
7432 * higher byte value. For zero bytes (end of word) the sorting is
7433 * done on flags and then on affixID. */
7435 && (node
->wn_byte
< word
[i
]
7436 || (node
->wn_byte
== NUL
7438 ? node
->wn_affixID
< (unsigned)affixID
7439 : (node
->wn_flags
< (unsigned)(flags
& WN_MASK
)
7440 || (node
->wn_flags
== (flags
& WN_MASK
)
7441 && (spin
->si_sugtree
7442 ? (node
->wn_region
& 0xffff) < region
7444 < (unsigned)affixID
)))))))
7446 prev
= &node
->wn_sibling
;
7450 || node
->wn_byte
!= word
[i
]
7454 || node
->wn_flags
!= (flags
& WN_MASK
)
7455 || node
->wn_affixID
!= affixID
)))
7457 /* Allocate a new node. */
7458 np
= get_wordnode(spin
);
7461 np
->wn_byte
= word
[i
];
7463 /* If "node" is NULL this is a new child or the end of the sibling
7464 * list: ref count is one. Otherwise use ref count of sibling and
7465 * make ref count of sibling one (matters when inserting in front
7466 * of the list of siblings). */
7471 np
->wn_refs
= node
->wn_refs
;
7475 np
->wn_sibling
= node
;
7481 node
->wn_flags
= flags
;
7482 node
->wn_region
|= region
;
7483 node
->wn_affixID
= affixID
;
7486 prev
= &node
->wn_child
;
7489 #ifdef SPELL_PRINTTREE
7490 smsg("Added \"%s\"", word
);
7491 spell_print_tree(root
->wn_sibling
);
7494 /* count nr of words added since last message */
7495 ++spin
->si_msg_count
;
7497 if (spin
->si_compress_cnt
> 1)
7499 if (--spin
->si_compress_cnt
== 1)
7500 /* Did enough words to lower the block count limit. */
7501 spin
->si_blocks_cnt
+= compress_inc
;
7505 * When we have allocated lots of memory we need to compress the word tree
7506 * to free up some room. But compression is slow, and we might actually
7507 * need that room, thus only compress in the following situations:
7508 * 1. When not compressed before (si_compress_cnt == 0): when using
7509 * "compress_start" blocks.
7510 * 2. When compressed before and used "compress_inc" blocks before
7511 * adding "compress_added" words (si_compress_cnt > 1).
7512 * 3. When compressed before, added "compress_added" words
7513 * (si_compress_cnt == 1) and the number of free nodes drops below the
7514 * maximum word length.
7516 #ifndef SPELL_PRINTTREE
7517 if (spin
->si_compress_cnt
== 1
7518 ? spin
->si_free_count
< MAXWLEN
7519 : spin
->si_blocks_cnt
>= compress_start
)
7522 /* Decrement the block counter. The effect is that we compress again
7523 * when the freed up room has been used and another "compress_inc"
7524 * blocks have been allocated. Unless "compress_added" words have
7525 * been added, then the limit is put back again. */
7526 spin
->si_blocks_cnt
-= compress_inc
;
7527 spin
->si_compress_cnt
= compress_added
;
7529 if (spin
->si_verbose
)
7532 msg_puts((char_u
*)_(msg_compressing
));
7539 /* Compress both trees. Either they both have many nodes, which makes
7540 * compression useful, or one of them is small, which means
7541 * compression goes fast. But when filling the souldfold word tree
7542 * there is no keep-case tree. */
7543 wordtree_compress(spin
, spin
->si_foldroot
);
7545 wordtree_compress(spin
, spin
->si_keeproot
);
7552 * Check the 'mkspellmem' option. Return FAIL if it's wrong.
7563 if (!VIM_ISDIGIT(*p
))
7565 /* block count = (value * 1024) / SBLOCKSIZE (but avoid overflow)*/
7566 start
= (getdigits(&p
) * 10) / (SBLOCKSIZE
/ 102);
7570 if (!VIM_ISDIGIT(*p
))
7572 incr
= (getdigits(&p
) * 102) / (SBLOCKSIZE
/ 10);
7576 if (!VIM_ISDIGIT(*p
))
7578 added
= getdigits(&p
) * 1024;
7582 if (start
== 0 || incr
== 0 || added
== 0 || incr
> start
)
7585 compress_start
= start
;
7586 compress_inc
= incr
;
7587 compress_added
= added
;
7593 * Get a wordnode_T, either from the list of previously freed nodes or
7594 * allocate a new one.
7602 if (spin
->si_first_free
== NULL
)
7603 n
= (wordnode_T
*)getroom(spin
, sizeof(wordnode_T
), TRUE
);
7606 n
= spin
->si_first_free
;
7607 spin
->si_first_free
= n
->wn_child
;
7608 vim_memset(n
, 0, sizeof(wordnode_T
));
7609 --spin
->si_free_count
;
7611 #ifdef SPELL_PRINTTREE
7612 n
->wn_nr
= ++spin
->si_wordnode_nr
;
7618 * Decrement the reference count on a node (which is the head of a list of
7619 * siblings). If the reference count becomes zero free the node and its
7621 * Returns the number of nodes actually freed.
7624 deref_wordnode(spin
, node
)
7631 if (--node
->wn_refs
== 0)
7633 for (np
= node
; np
!= NULL
; np
= np
->wn_sibling
)
7635 if (np
->wn_child
!= NULL
)
7636 cnt
+= deref_wordnode(spin
, np
->wn_child
);
7637 free_wordnode(spin
, np
);
7640 ++cnt
; /* length field */
7646 * Free a wordnode_T for re-use later.
7647 * Only the "wn_child" field becomes invalid.
7650 free_wordnode(spin
, n
)
7654 n
->wn_child
= spin
->si_first_free
;
7655 spin
->si_first_free
= n
;
7656 ++spin
->si_free_count
;
7660 * Compress a tree: find tails that are identical and can be shared.
7663 wordtree_compress(spin
, root
)
7672 /* Skip the root itself, it's not actually used. The first sibling is the
7673 * start of the tree. */
7674 if (root
->wn_sibling
!= NULL
)
7677 n
= node_compress(spin
, root
->wn_sibling
, &ht
, &tot
);
7679 #ifndef SPELL_PRINTTREE
7680 if (spin
->si_verbose
|| p_verbose
> 2)
7684 perc
= (tot
- n
) / (tot
/ 100);
7688 perc
= (tot
- n
) * 100 / tot
;
7689 vim_snprintf((char *)IObuff
, IOSIZE
,
7690 _("Compressed %d of %d nodes; %d (%d%%) remaining"),
7691 n
, tot
, tot
- n
, perc
);
7692 spell_message(spin
, IObuff
);
7694 #ifdef SPELL_PRINTTREE
7695 spell_print_tree(root
->wn_sibling
);
7702 * Compress a node, its siblings and its children, depth first.
7703 * Returns the number of compressed nodes.
7706 node_compress(spin
, node
, ht
, tot
)
7710 int *tot
; /* total count of nodes before compressing,
7711 incremented while going through the tree */
7723 * Go through the list of siblings. Compress each child and then try
7724 * finding an identical child to replace it.
7725 * Note that with "child" we mean not just the node that is pointed to,
7726 * but the whole list of siblings of which the child node is the first.
7728 for (np
= node
; np
!= NULL
&& !got_int
; np
= np
->wn_sibling
)
7731 if ((child
= np
->wn_child
) != NULL
)
7733 /* Compress the child first. This fills hashkey. */
7734 compressed
+= node_compress(spin
, child
, ht
, tot
);
7736 /* Try to find an identical child. */
7737 hash
= hash_hash(child
->wn_u1
.hashkey
);
7738 hi
= hash_lookup(ht
, child
->wn_u1
.hashkey
, hash
);
7739 if (!HASHITEM_EMPTY(hi
))
7741 /* There are children we encountered before with a hash value
7742 * identical to the current child. Now check if there is one
7743 * that is really identical. */
7744 for (tp
= HI2WN(hi
); tp
!= NULL
; tp
= tp
->wn_u2
.next
)
7745 if (node_equal(child
, tp
))
7747 /* Found one! Now use that child in place of the
7748 * current one. This means the current child and all
7749 * its siblings is unlinked from the tree. */
7751 compressed
+= deref_wordnode(spin
, child
);
7757 /* No other child with this hash value equals the child of
7758 * the node, add it to the linked list after the first
7761 child
->wn_u2
.next
= tp
->wn_u2
.next
;
7762 tp
->wn_u2
.next
= child
;
7766 /* No other child has this hash value, add it to the
7768 hash_add_item(ht
, hi
, child
->wn_u1
.hashkey
, hash
);
7771 *tot
+= len
+ 1; /* add one for the node that stores the length */
7774 * Make a hash key for the node and its siblings, so that we can quickly
7775 * find a lookalike node. This must be done after compressing the sibling
7776 * list, otherwise the hash key would become invalid by the compression.
7778 node
->wn_u1
.hashkey
[0] = len
;
7780 for (np
= node
; np
!= NULL
; np
= np
->wn_sibling
)
7782 if (np
->wn_byte
== NUL
)
7783 /* end node: use wn_flags, wn_region and wn_affixID */
7784 n
= np
->wn_flags
+ (np
->wn_region
<< 8) + (np
->wn_affixID
<< 16);
7786 /* byte node: use the byte value and the child pointer */
7787 n
= (unsigned)(np
->wn_byte
+ ((long_u
)np
->wn_child
<< 8));
7791 /* Avoid NUL bytes, it terminates the hash key. */
7793 node
->wn_u1
.hashkey
[1] = n
== 0 ? 1 : n
;
7794 n
= (nr
>> 8) & 0xff;
7795 node
->wn_u1
.hashkey
[2] = n
== 0 ? 1 : n
;
7796 n
= (nr
>> 16) & 0xff;
7797 node
->wn_u1
.hashkey
[3] = n
== 0 ? 1 : n
;
7798 n
= (nr
>> 24) & 0xff;
7799 node
->wn_u1
.hashkey
[4] = n
== 0 ? 1 : n
;
7800 node
->wn_u1
.hashkey
[5] = NUL
;
7802 /* Check for CTRL-C pressed now and then. */
7809 * Return TRUE when two nodes have identical siblings and children.
7819 for (p1
= n1
, p2
= n2
; p1
!= NULL
&& p2
!= NULL
;
7820 p1
= p1
->wn_sibling
, p2
= p2
->wn_sibling
)
7821 if (p1
->wn_byte
!= p2
->wn_byte
7822 || (p1
->wn_byte
== NUL
7823 ? (p1
->wn_flags
!= p2
->wn_flags
7824 || p1
->wn_region
!= p2
->wn_region
7825 || p1
->wn_affixID
!= p2
->wn_affixID
)
7826 : (p1
->wn_child
!= p2
->wn_child
)))
7829 return p1
== NULL
&& p2
== NULL
;
7833 * Write a number to file "fd", MSB first, in "len" bytes.
7836 put_bytes(fd
, nr
, len
)
7843 for (i
= len
- 1; i
>= 0; --i
)
7844 putc((int)(nr
>> (i
* 8)), fd
);
7848 # if (_MSC_VER <= 1200)
7849 /* This line is required for VC6 without the service pack. Also see the
7850 * matching #pragma below. */
7851 # pragma optimize("", off)
7856 * Write spin->si_sugtime to file "fd".
7859 put_sugtime(spin
, fd
)
7866 /* time_t can be up to 8 bytes in size, more than long_u, thus we
7867 * can't use put_bytes() here. */
7868 for (i
= 7; i
>= 0; --i
)
7869 if (i
+ 1 > sizeof(time_t))
7870 /* ">>" doesn't work well when shifting more bits than avail */
7874 c
= (unsigned)spin
->si_sugtime
>> (i
* 8);
7880 # if (_MSC_VER <= 1200)
7881 # pragma optimize("", on)
7889 rep_compare
__ARGS((const void *s1
, const void *s2
));
7892 * Function given to qsort() to sort the REP items on "from" string.
7902 fromto_T
*p1
= (fromto_T
*)s1
;
7903 fromto_T
*p2
= (fromto_T
*)s2
;
7905 return STRCMP(p1
->ft_from
, p2
->ft_from
);
7909 * Write the Vim .spl file "fname".
7910 * Return FAIL or OK;
7913 write_vim_spell(spin
, fname
)
7930 fd
= mch_fopen((char *)fname
, "w");
7933 EMSG2(_(e_notopen
), fname
);
7937 /* <HEADER>: <fileID> <versionnr> */
7939 if (fwrite(VIMSPELLMAGIC
, VIMSPELLMAGICL
, (size_t)1, fd
) != 1)
7944 putc(VIMSPELLVERSION
, fd
); /* <versionnr> */
7947 * <SECTIONS>: <section> ... <sectionend>
7950 /* SN_INFO: <infotext> */
7951 if (spin
->si_info
!= NULL
)
7953 putc(SN_INFO
, fd
); /* <sectionID> */
7954 putc(0, fd
); /* <sectionflags> */
7956 i
= (int)STRLEN(spin
->si_info
);
7957 put_bytes(fd
, (long_u
)i
, 4); /* <sectionlen> */
7958 fwrite(spin
->si_info
, (size_t)i
, (size_t)1, fd
); /* <infotext> */
7961 /* SN_REGION: <regionname> ...
7962 * Write the region names only if there is more than one. */
7963 if (spin
->si_region_count
> 1)
7965 putc(SN_REGION
, fd
); /* <sectionID> */
7966 putc(SNF_REQUIRED
, fd
); /* <sectionflags> */
7967 l
= spin
->si_region_count
* 2;
7968 put_bytes(fd
, (long_u
)l
, 4); /* <sectionlen> */
7969 fwrite(spin
->si_region_name
, (size_t)l
, (size_t)1, fd
);
7970 /* <regionname> ... */
7971 regionmask
= (1 << spin
->si_region_count
) - 1;
7976 /* SN_CHARFLAGS: <charflagslen> <charflags> <folcharslen> <folchars>
7978 * The table with character flags and the table for case folding.
7979 * This makes sure the same characters are recognized as word characters
7980 * when generating an when using a spell file.
7981 * Skip this for ASCII, the table may conflict with the one used for
7983 * Also skip this for an .add.spl file, the main spell file must contain
7984 * the table (avoids that it conflicts). File is shorter too.
7986 if (!spin
->si_ascii
&& !spin
->si_add
)
7988 char_u folchars
[128 * 8];
7991 putc(SN_CHARFLAGS
, fd
); /* <sectionID> */
7992 putc(SNF_REQUIRED
, fd
); /* <sectionflags> */
7994 /* Form the <folchars> string first, we need to know its length. */
7996 for (i
= 128; i
< 256; ++i
)
8000 l
+= mb_char2bytes(spelltab
.st_fold
[i
], folchars
+ l
);
8003 folchars
[l
++] = spelltab
.st_fold
[i
];
8005 put_bytes(fd
, (long_u
)(1 + 128 + 2 + l
), 4); /* <sectionlen> */
8007 fputc(128, fd
); /* <charflagslen> */
8008 for (i
= 128; i
< 256; ++i
)
8011 if (spelltab
.st_isw
[i
])
8013 if (spelltab
.st_isu
[i
])
8015 fputc(flags
, fd
); /* <charflags> */
8018 put_bytes(fd
, (long_u
)l
, 2); /* <folcharslen> */
8019 fwrite(folchars
, (size_t)l
, (size_t)1, fd
); /* <folchars> */
8022 /* SN_MIDWORD: <midword> */
8023 if (spin
->si_midword
!= NULL
)
8025 putc(SN_MIDWORD
, fd
); /* <sectionID> */
8026 putc(SNF_REQUIRED
, fd
); /* <sectionflags> */
8028 i
= (int)STRLEN(spin
->si_midword
);
8029 put_bytes(fd
, (long_u
)i
, 4); /* <sectionlen> */
8030 fwrite(spin
->si_midword
, (size_t)i
, (size_t)1, fd
); /* <midword> */
8033 /* SN_PREFCOND: <prefcondcnt> <prefcond> ... */
8034 if (spin
->si_prefcond
.ga_len
> 0)
8036 putc(SN_PREFCOND
, fd
); /* <sectionID> */
8037 putc(SNF_REQUIRED
, fd
); /* <sectionflags> */
8039 l
= write_spell_prefcond(NULL
, &spin
->si_prefcond
);
8040 put_bytes(fd
, (long_u
)l
, 4); /* <sectionlen> */
8042 write_spell_prefcond(fd
, &spin
->si_prefcond
);
8045 /* SN_REP: <repcount> <rep> ...
8046 * SN_SAL: <salflags> <salcount> <sal> ...
8047 * SN_REPSAL: <repcount> <rep> ... */
8049 /* round 1: SN_REP section
8050 * round 2: SN_SAL section (unless SN_SOFO is used)
8051 * round 3: SN_REPSAL section */
8052 for (round
= 1; round
<= 3; ++round
)
8055 gap
= &spin
->si_rep
;
8056 else if (round
== 2)
8058 /* Don't write SN_SAL when using a SN_SOFO section */
8059 if (spin
->si_sofofr
!= NULL
&& spin
->si_sofoto
!= NULL
)
8061 gap
= &spin
->si_sal
;
8064 gap
= &spin
->si_repsal
;
8066 /* Don't write the section if there are no items. */
8067 if (gap
->ga_len
== 0)
8070 /* Sort the REP/REPSAL items. */
8072 qsort(gap
->ga_data
, (size_t)gap
->ga_len
,
8073 sizeof(fromto_T
), rep_compare
);
8075 i
= round
== 1 ? SN_REP
: (round
== 2 ? SN_SAL
: SN_REPSAL
);
8076 putc(i
, fd
); /* <sectionID> */
8078 /* This is for making suggestions, section is not required. */
8079 putc(0, fd
); /* <sectionflags> */
8081 /* Compute the length of what follows. */
8082 l
= 2; /* count <repcount> or <salcount> */
8083 for (i
= 0; i
< gap
->ga_len
; ++i
)
8085 ftp
= &((fromto_T
*)gap
->ga_data
)[i
];
8086 l
+= 1 + (int)STRLEN(ftp
->ft_from
); /* count <*fromlen> and <*from> */
8087 l
+= 1 + (int)STRLEN(ftp
->ft_to
); /* count <*tolen> and <*to> */
8090 ++l
; /* count <salflags> */
8091 put_bytes(fd
, (long_u
)l
, 4); /* <sectionlen> */
8096 if (spin
->si_followup
)
8098 if (spin
->si_collapse
)
8100 if (spin
->si_rem_accents
)
8101 i
|= SAL_REM_ACCENTS
;
8102 putc(i
, fd
); /* <salflags> */
8105 put_bytes(fd
, (long_u
)gap
->ga_len
, 2); /* <repcount> or <salcount> */
8106 for (i
= 0; i
< gap
->ga_len
; ++i
)
8108 /* <rep> : <repfromlen> <repfrom> <reptolen> <repto> */
8109 /* <sal> : <salfromlen> <salfrom> <saltolen> <salto> */
8110 ftp
= &((fromto_T
*)gap
->ga_data
)[i
];
8111 for (rr
= 1; rr
<= 2; ++rr
)
8113 p
= rr
== 1 ? ftp
->ft_from
: ftp
->ft_to
;
8116 fwrite(p
, l
, (size_t)1, fd
);
8122 /* SN_SOFO: <sofofromlen> <sofofrom> <sofotolen> <sofoto>
8123 * This is for making suggestions, section is not required. */
8124 if (spin
->si_sofofr
!= NULL
&& spin
->si_sofoto
!= NULL
)
8126 putc(SN_SOFO
, fd
); /* <sectionID> */
8127 putc(0, fd
); /* <sectionflags> */
8129 l
= (int)STRLEN(spin
->si_sofofr
);
8130 put_bytes(fd
, (long_u
)(l
+ STRLEN(spin
->si_sofoto
) + 4), 4);
8133 put_bytes(fd
, (long_u
)l
, 2); /* <sofofromlen> */
8134 fwrite(spin
->si_sofofr
, l
, (size_t)1, fd
); /* <sofofrom> */
8136 l
= (int)STRLEN(spin
->si_sofoto
);
8137 put_bytes(fd
, (long_u
)l
, 2); /* <sofotolen> */
8138 fwrite(spin
->si_sofoto
, l
, (size_t)1, fd
); /* <sofoto> */
8141 /* SN_WORDS: <word> ...
8142 * This is for making suggestions, section is not required. */
8143 if (spin
->si_commonwords
.ht_used
> 0)
8145 putc(SN_WORDS
, fd
); /* <sectionID> */
8146 putc(0, fd
); /* <sectionflags> */
8148 /* round 1: count the bytes
8149 * round 2: write the bytes */
8150 for (round
= 1; round
<= 2; ++round
)
8156 todo
= (int)spin
->si_commonwords
.ht_used
;
8157 for (hi
= spin
->si_commonwords
.ht_array
; todo
> 0; ++hi
)
8158 if (!HASHITEM_EMPTY(hi
))
8160 l
= (int)STRLEN(hi
->hi_key
) + 1;
8162 if (round
== 2) /* <word> */
8163 fwrite(hi
->hi_key
, (size_t)l
, (size_t)1, fd
);
8167 put_bytes(fd
, (long_u
)len
, 4); /* <sectionlen> */
8172 * This is for making suggestions, section is not required. */
8173 if (spin
->si_map
.ga_len
> 0)
8175 putc(SN_MAP
, fd
); /* <sectionID> */
8176 putc(0, fd
); /* <sectionflags> */
8177 l
= spin
->si_map
.ga_len
;
8178 put_bytes(fd
, (long_u
)l
, 4); /* <sectionlen> */
8179 fwrite(spin
->si_map
.ga_data
, (size_t)l
, (size_t)1, fd
);
8183 /* SN_SUGFILE: <timestamp>
8184 * This is used to notify that a .sug file may be available and at the
8185 * same time allows for checking that a .sug file that is found matches
8186 * with this .spl file. That's because the word numbers must be exactly
8188 if (!spin
->si_nosugfile
8189 && (spin
->si_sal
.ga_len
> 0
8190 || (spin
->si_sofofr
!= NULL
&& spin
->si_sofoto
!= NULL
)))
8192 putc(SN_SUGFILE
, fd
); /* <sectionID> */
8193 putc(0, fd
); /* <sectionflags> */
8194 put_bytes(fd
, (long_u
)8, 4); /* <sectionlen> */
8196 /* Set si_sugtime and write it to the file. */
8197 spin
->si_sugtime
= time(NULL
);
8198 put_sugtime(spin
, fd
); /* <timestamp> */
8201 /* SN_NOSPLITSUGS: nothing
8202 * This is used to notify that no suggestions with word splits are to be
8204 if (spin
->si_nosplitsugs
)
8206 putc(SN_NOSPLITSUGS
, fd
); /* <sectionID> */
8207 putc(0, fd
); /* <sectionflags> */
8208 put_bytes(fd
, (long_u
)0, 4); /* <sectionlen> */
8211 /* SN_COMPOUND: compound info.
8212 * We don't mark it required, when not supported all compound words will
8214 if (spin
->si_compflags
!= NULL
)
8216 putc(SN_COMPOUND
, fd
); /* <sectionID> */
8217 putc(0, fd
); /* <sectionflags> */
8219 l
= (int)STRLEN(spin
->si_compflags
);
8220 for (i
= 0; i
< spin
->si_comppat
.ga_len
; ++i
)
8221 l
+= (int)STRLEN(((char_u
**)(spin
->si_comppat
.ga_data
))[i
]) + 1;
8222 put_bytes(fd
, (long_u
)(l
+ 7), 4); /* <sectionlen> */
8224 putc(spin
->si_compmax
, fd
); /* <compmax> */
8225 putc(spin
->si_compminlen
, fd
); /* <compminlen> */
8226 putc(spin
->si_compsylmax
, fd
); /* <compsylmax> */
8227 putc(0, fd
); /* for Vim 7.0b compatibility */
8228 putc(spin
->si_compoptions
, fd
); /* <compoptions> */
8229 put_bytes(fd
, (long_u
)spin
->si_comppat
.ga_len
, 2);
8230 /* <comppatcount> */
8231 for (i
= 0; i
< spin
->si_comppat
.ga_len
; ++i
)
8233 p
= ((char_u
**)(spin
->si_comppat
.ga_data
))[i
];
8234 putc((int)STRLEN(p
), fd
); /* <comppatlen> */
8235 fwrite(p
, (size_t)STRLEN(p
), (size_t)1, fd
);/* <comppattext> */
8238 fwrite(spin
->si_compflags
, (size_t)STRLEN(spin
->si_compflags
),
8242 /* SN_NOBREAK: NOBREAK flag */
8243 if (spin
->si_nobreak
)
8245 putc(SN_NOBREAK
, fd
); /* <sectionID> */
8246 putc(0, fd
); /* <sectionflags> */
8248 /* It's empty, the presence of the section flags the feature. */
8249 put_bytes(fd
, (long_u
)0, 4); /* <sectionlen> */
8252 /* SN_SYLLABLE: syllable info.
8253 * We don't mark it required, when not supported syllables will not be
8255 if (spin
->si_syllable
!= NULL
)
8257 putc(SN_SYLLABLE
, fd
); /* <sectionID> */
8258 putc(0, fd
); /* <sectionflags> */
8260 l
= (int)STRLEN(spin
->si_syllable
);
8261 put_bytes(fd
, (long_u
)l
, 4); /* <sectionlen> */
8262 fwrite(spin
->si_syllable
, (size_t)l
, (size_t)1, fd
); /* <syllable> */
8265 /* end of <SECTIONS> */
8266 putc(SN_END
, fd
); /* <sectionend> */
8270 * <LWORDTREE> <KWORDTREE> <PREFIXTREE>
8272 spin
->si_memtot
= 0;
8273 for (round
= 1; round
<= 3; ++round
)
8276 tree
= spin
->si_foldroot
->wn_sibling
;
8277 else if (round
== 2)
8278 tree
= spin
->si_keeproot
->wn_sibling
;
8280 tree
= spin
->si_prefroot
->wn_sibling
;
8282 /* Clear the index and wnode fields in the tree. */
8285 /* Count the number of nodes. Needed to be able to allocate the
8286 * memory when reading the nodes. Also fills in index for shared
8288 nodecount
= put_node(NULL
, tree
, 0, regionmask
, round
== 3);
8290 /* number of nodes in 4 bytes */
8291 put_bytes(fd
, (long_u
)nodecount
, 4); /* <nodecount> */
8292 spin
->si_memtot
+= nodecount
+ nodecount
* sizeof(int);
8294 /* Write the nodes. */
8295 (void)put_node(fd
, tree
, 0, regionmask
, round
== 3);
8298 /* Write another byte to check for errors. */
8299 if (putc(0, fd
) == EOF
)
8302 if (fclose(fd
) == EOF
)
8309 * Clear the index and wnode fields of "node", it siblings and its
8310 * children. This is needed because they are a union with other items to save
8320 for (np
= node
; np
!= NULL
; np
= np
->wn_sibling
)
8322 np
->wn_u1
.index
= 0;
8323 np
->wn_u2
.wnode
= NULL
;
8325 if (np
->wn_byte
!= NUL
)
8326 clear_node(np
->wn_child
);
8332 * Dump a word tree at node "node".
8334 * This first writes the list of possible bytes (siblings). Then for each
8335 * byte recursively write the children.
8337 * NOTE: The code here must match the code in read_tree_node(), since
8338 * assumptions are made about the indexes (so that we don't have to write them
8341 * Returns the number of nodes used.
8344 put_node(fd
, node
, idx
, regionmask
, prefixtree
)
8345 FILE *fd
; /* NULL when only counting */
8349 int prefixtree
; /* TRUE for PREFIXTREE */
8352 int siblingcount
= 0;
8356 /* If "node" is zero the tree is empty. */
8360 /* Store the index where this node is written. */
8361 node
->wn_u1
.index
= idx
;
8363 /* Count the number of siblings. */
8364 for (np
= node
; np
!= NULL
; np
= np
->wn_sibling
)
8367 /* Write the sibling count. */
8369 putc(siblingcount
, fd
); /* <siblingcount> */
8371 /* Write each sibling byte and optionally extra info. */
8372 for (np
= node
; np
!= NULL
; np
= np
->wn_sibling
)
8374 if (np
->wn_byte
== 0)
8378 /* For a NUL byte (end of word) write the flags etc. */
8381 /* In PREFIXTREE write the required affixID and the
8382 * associated condition nr (stored in wn_region). The
8383 * byte value is misused to store the "rare" and "not
8384 * combining" flags */
8385 if (np
->wn_flags
== (short_u
)PFX_FLAGS
)
8386 putc(BY_NOFLAGS
, fd
); /* <byte> */
8389 putc(BY_FLAGS
, fd
); /* <byte> */
8390 putc(np
->wn_flags
, fd
); /* <pflags> */
8392 putc(np
->wn_affixID
, fd
); /* <affixID> */
8393 put_bytes(fd
, (long_u
)np
->wn_region
, 2); /* <prefcondnr> */
8397 /* For word trees we write the flag/region items. */
8398 flags
= np
->wn_flags
;
8399 if (regionmask
!= 0 && np
->wn_region
!= regionmask
)
8401 if (np
->wn_affixID
!= 0)
8405 /* word without flags or region */
8406 putc(BY_NOFLAGS
, fd
); /* <byte> */
8410 if (np
->wn_flags
>= 0x100)
8412 putc(BY_FLAGS2
, fd
); /* <byte> */
8413 putc(flags
, fd
); /* <flags> */
8414 putc((unsigned)flags
>> 8, fd
); /* <flags2> */
8418 putc(BY_FLAGS
, fd
); /* <byte> */
8419 putc(flags
, fd
); /* <flags> */
8421 if (flags
& WF_REGION
)
8422 putc(np
->wn_region
, fd
); /* <region> */
8424 putc(np
->wn_affixID
, fd
); /* <affixID> */
8431 if (np
->wn_child
->wn_u1
.index
!= 0
8432 && np
->wn_child
->wn_u2
.wnode
!= node
)
8434 /* The child is written elsewhere, write the reference. */
8437 putc(BY_INDEX
, fd
); /* <byte> */
8439 put_bytes(fd
, (long_u
)np
->wn_child
->wn_u1
.index
, 3);
8442 else if (np
->wn_child
->wn_u2
.wnode
== NULL
)
8443 /* We will write the child below and give it an index. */
8444 np
->wn_child
->wn_u2
.wnode
= node
;
8447 if (putc(np
->wn_byte
, fd
) == EOF
) /* <byte> or <xbyte> */
8455 /* Space used in the array when reading: one for each sibling and one for
8457 newindex
+= siblingcount
+ 1;
8459 /* Recursively dump the children of each sibling. */
8460 for (np
= node
; np
!= NULL
; np
= np
->wn_sibling
)
8461 if (np
->wn_byte
!= 0 && np
->wn_child
->wn_u2
.wnode
== node
)
8462 newindex
= put_node(fd
, np
->wn_child
, newindex
, regionmask
,
8470 * ":mkspell [-ascii] outfile infile ..."
8471 * ":mkspell [-ascii] addfile"
8479 char_u
*arg
= eap
->arg
;
8482 if (STRNCMP(arg
, "-ascii", 6) == 0)
8485 arg
= skipwhite(arg
+ 6);
8488 /* Expand all the remaining arguments (e.g., $VIMRUNTIME). */
8489 if (get_arglist_exp(arg
, &fcount
, &fnames
) == OK
)
8491 mkspell(fcount
, fnames
, ascii
, eap
->forceit
, FALSE
);
8492 FreeWild(fcount
, fnames
);
8497 * Create the .sug file.
8498 * Uses the soundfold info in "spin".
8499 * Writes the file with the name "wfname", with ".spl" changed to ".sug".
8502 spell_make_sugfile(spin
, wfname
)
8506 char_u fname
[MAXPATHL
];
8509 int free_slang
= FALSE
;
8512 * Read back the .spl file that was written. This fills the required
8513 * info for soundfolding. This also uses less memory than the
8514 * pointer-linked version of the trie. And it avoids having two versions
8515 * of the code for the soundfolding stuff.
8516 * It might have been done already by spell_reload_one().
8518 for (slang
= first_lang
; slang
!= NULL
; slang
= slang
->sl_next
)
8519 if (fullpathcmp(wfname
, slang
->sl_fname
, FALSE
) == FPC_SAME
)
8523 spell_message(spin
, (char_u
*)_("Reading back spell file..."));
8524 slang
= spell_load_file(wfname
, NULL
, NULL
, FALSE
);
8531 * Clear the info in "spin" that is used.
8533 spin
->si_blocks
= NULL
;
8534 spin
->si_blocks_cnt
= 0;
8535 spin
->si_compress_cnt
= 0; /* will stay at 0 all the time*/
8536 spin
->si_free_count
= 0;
8537 spin
->si_first_free
= NULL
;
8538 spin
->si_foldwcount
= 0;
8541 * Go through the trie of good words, soundfold each word and add it to
8542 * the soundfold trie.
8544 spell_message(spin
, (char_u
*)_("Performing soundfolding..."));
8545 if (sug_filltree(spin
, slang
) == FAIL
)
8549 * Create the table which links each soundfold word with a list of the
8550 * good words it may come from. Creates buffer "spin->si_spellbuf".
8551 * This also removes the wordnr from the NUL byte entries to make
8552 * compression possible.
8554 if (sug_maketable(spin
) == FAIL
)
8557 smsg((char_u
*)_("Number of words after soundfolding: %ld"),
8558 (long)spin
->si_spellbuf
->b_ml
.ml_line_count
);
8561 * Compress the soundfold trie.
8563 spell_message(spin
, (char_u
*)_(msg_compressing
));
8564 wordtree_compress(spin
, spin
->si_foldroot
);
8567 * Write the .sug file.
8568 * Make the file name by changing ".spl" to ".sug".
8570 STRCPY(fname
, wfname
);
8571 len
= (int)STRLEN(fname
);
8572 fname
[len
- 2] = 'u';
8573 fname
[len
- 1] = 'g';
8574 sug_write(spin
, fname
);
8579 free_blocks(spin
->si_blocks
);
8580 close_spellbuf(spin
->si_spellbuf
);
8584 * Build the soundfold trie for language "slang".
8587 sug_filltree(spin
, slang
)
8594 idx_T arridx
[MAXWLEN
];
8596 char_u tword
[MAXWLEN
];
8597 char_u tsalword
[MAXWLEN
];
8600 unsigned words_done
= 0;
8601 int wordcount
[MAXWLEN
];
8603 /* We use si_foldroot for the souldfolded trie. */
8604 spin
->si_foldroot
= wordtree_alloc(spin
);
8605 if (spin
->si_foldroot
== NULL
)
8608 /* let tree_add_word() know we're adding to the soundfolded tree */
8609 spin
->si_sugtree
= TRUE
;
8612 * Go through the whole case-folded tree, soundfold each word and put it
8615 byts
= slang
->sl_fbyts
;
8616 idxs
= slang
->sl_fidxs
;
8623 while (depth
>= 0 && !got_int
)
8625 if (curi
[depth
] > byts
[arridx
[depth
]])
8627 /* Done all bytes at this node, go up one level. */
8628 idxs
[arridx
[depth
]] = wordcount
[depth
];
8630 wordcount
[depth
- 1] += wordcount
[depth
];
8638 /* Do one more byte at this node. */
8639 n
= arridx
[depth
] + curi
[depth
];
8645 /* Sound-fold the word. */
8647 spell_soundfold(slang
, tword
, TRUE
, tsalword
);
8649 /* We use the "flags" field for the MSB of the wordnr,
8650 * "region" for the LSB of the wordnr. */
8651 if (tree_add_word(spin
, tsalword
, spin
->si_foldroot
,
8652 words_done
>> 16, words_done
& 0xffff,
8659 /* Reset the block count each time to avoid compression
8661 spin
->si_blocks_cnt
= 0;
8663 /* Skip over any other NUL bytes (same word with different
8665 while (byts
[n
+ 1] == 0)
8673 /* Normal char, go one level deeper. */
8675 arridx
[depth
] = idxs
[n
];
8677 wordcount
[depth
] = 0;
8682 smsg((char_u
*)_("Total number of words: %d"), words_done
);
8688 * Make the table that links each word in the soundfold trie to the words it
8689 * can be produced from.
8690 * This is not unlike lines in a file, thus use a memfile to be able to access
8691 * the table efficiently.
8692 * Returns FAIL when out of memory.
8701 /* Allocate a buffer, open a memline for it and create the swap file
8702 * (uses a temp file, not a .swp file). */
8703 spin
->si_spellbuf
= open_spellbuf();
8704 if (spin
->si_spellbuf
== NULL
)
8707 /* Use a buffer to store the line info, avoids allocating many small
8708 * pieces of memory. */
8709 ga_init2(&ga
, 1, 100);
8711 /* recursively go through the tree */
8712 if (sug_filltable(spin
, spin
->si_foldroot
->wn_sibling
, 0, &ga
) == -1)
8720 * Fill the table for one node and its children.
8721 * Returns the wordnr at the start of the node.
8722 * Returns -1 when out of memory.
8725 sug_filltable(spin
, node
, startwordnr
, gap
)
8729 garray_T
*gap
; /* place to store line of numbers */
8732 int wordnr
= startwordnr
;
8736 for (p
= node
; p
!= NULL
; p
= p
->wn_sibling
)
8738 if (p
->wn_byte
== NUL
)
8742 for (np
= p
; np
!= NULL
&& np
->wn_byte
== NUL
; np
= np
->wn_sibling
)
8744 if (ga_grow(gap
, 10) == FAIL
)
8747 nr
= (np
->wn_flags
<< 16) + (np
->wn_region
& 0xffff);
8748 /* Compute the offset from the previous nr and store the
8749 * offset in a way that it takes a minimum number of bytes.
8750 * It's a bit like utf-8, but without the need to mark
8751 * following bytes. */
8754 gap
->ga_len
+= offset2bytes(nr
,
8755 (char_u
*)gap
->ga_data
+ gap
->ga_len
);
8758 /* add the NUL byte */
8759 ((char_u
*)gap
->ga_data
)[gap
->ga_len
++] = NUL
;
8761 if (ml_append_buf(spin
->si_spellbuf
, (linenr_T
)wordnr
,
8762 gap
->ga_data
, gap
->ga_len
, TRUE
) == FAIL
)
8766 /* Remove extra NUL entries, we no longer need them. We don't
8767 * bother freeing the nodes, the won't be reused anyway. */
8768 while (p
->wn_sibling
!= NULL
&& p
->wn_sibling
->wn_byte
== NUL
)
8769 p
->wn_sibling
= p
->wn_sibling
->wn_sibling
;
8771 /* Clear the flags on the remaining NUL node, so that compression
8772 * works a lot better. */
8778 wordnr
= sug_filltable(spin
, p
->wn_child
, wordnr
, gap
);
8787 * Convert an offset into a minimal number of bytes.
8788 * Similar to utf_char2byters, but use 8 bits in followup bytes and avoid NUL
8792 offset2bytes(nr
, buf
)
8799 /* Split the number in parts of base 255. We need to avoid NUL bytes. */
8807 if (b4
> 1 || b3
> 0x1f) /* 4 bytes */
8815 if (b3
> 1 || b2
> 0x3f ) /* 3 bytes */
8822 if (b2
> 1 || b1
> 0x7f ) /* 2 bytes */
8834 * Opposite of offset2bytes().
8835 * "pp" points to the bytes and is advanced over it.
8836 * Returns the offset.
8847 if ((c
& 0x80) == 0x00) /* 1 byte */
8851 else if ((c
& 0xc0) == 0x80) /* 2 bytes */
8853 nr
= (c
& 0x3f) - 1;
8854 nr
= nr
* 255 + (*p
++ - 1);
8856 else if ((c
& 0xe0) == 0xc0) /* 3 bytes */
8858 nr
= (c
& 0x1f) - 1;
8859 nr
= nr
* 255 + (*p
++ - 1);
8860 nr
= nr
* 255 + (*p
++ - 1);
8864 nr
= (c
& 0x0f) - 1;
8865 nr
= nr
* 255 + (*p
++ - 1);
8866 nr
= nr
* 255 + (*p
++ - 1);
8867 nr
= nr
* 255 + (*p
++ - 1);
8875 * Write the .sug file in "fname".
8878 sug_write(spin
, fname
)
8890 /* Create the file. Note that an existing file is silently overwritten! */
8891 fd
= mch_fopen((char *)fname
, "w");
8894 EMSG2(_(e_notopen
), fname
);
8898 vim_snprintf((char *)IObuff
, IOSIZE
,
8899 _("Writing suggestion file %s ..."), fname
);
8900 spell_message(spin
, IObuff
);
8903 * <SUGHEADER>: <fileID> <versionnr> <timestamp>
8905 if (fwrite(VIMSUGMAGIC
, VIMSUGMAGICL
, (size_t)1, fd
) != 1) /* <fileID> */
8910 putc(VIMSUGVERSION
, fd
); /* <versionnr> */
8912 /* Write si_sugtime to the file. */
8913 put_sugtime(spin
, fd
); /* <timestamp> */
8918 spin
->si_memtot
= 0;
8919 tree
= spin
->si_foldroot
->wn_sibling
;
8921 /* Clear the index and wnode fields in the tree. */
8924 /* Count the number of nodes. Needed to be able to allocate the
8925 * memory when reading the nodes. Also fills in index for shared
8927 nodecount
= put_node(NULL
, tree
, 0, 0, FALSE
);
8929 /* number of nodes in 4 bytes */
8930 put_bytes(fd
, (long_u
)nodecount
, 4); /* <nodecount> */
8931 spin
->si_memtot
+= nodecount
+ nodecount
* sizeof(int);
8933 /* Write the nodes. */
8934 (void)put_node(fd
, tree
, 0, 0, FALSE
);
8937 * <SUGTABLE>: <sugwcount> <sugline> ...
8939 wcount
= spin
->si_spellbuf
->b_ml
.ml_line_count
;
8940 put_bytes(fd
, (long_u
)wcount
, 4); /* <sugwcount> */
8942 for (lnum
= 1; lnum
<= (linenr_T
)wcount
; ++lnum
)
8944 /* <sugline>: <sugnr> ... NUL */
8945 line
= ml_get_buf(spin
->si_spellbuf
, lnum
, FALSE
);
8946 len
= (int)STRLEN(line
) + 1;
8947 if (fwrite(line
, (size_t)len
, (size_t)1, fd
) == 0)
8952 spin
->si_memtot
+= len
;
8955 /* Write another byte to check for errors. */
8956 if (putc(0, fd
) == EOF
)
8959 vim_snprintf((char *)IObuff
, IOSIZE
,
8960 _("Estimated runtime memory use: %d bytes"), spin
->si_memtot
);
8961 spell_message(spin
, IObuff
);
8964 /* close the file */
8969 * Open a spell buffer. This is a nameless buffer that is not in the buffer
8970 * list and only contains text lines. Can use a swapfile to reduce memory
8972 * Most other fields are invalid! Esp. watch out for string options being
8973 * NULL and there is no undo info.
8974 * Returns NULL when out of memory.
8981 buf
= (buf_T
*)alloc_clear(sizeof(buf_T
));
8984 buf
->b_spell
= TRUE
;
8985 buf
->b_p_swf
= TRUE
; /* may create a swap file */
8987 ml_open_file(buf
); /* create swap file now */
8993 * Close the buffer used for spell info.
9001 ml_close(buf
, TRUE
);
9008 * Create a Vim spell file from one or more word lists.
9009 * "fnames[0]" is the output file name.
9010 * "fnames[fcount - 1]" is the last input file name.
9011 * Exception: when "fnames[0]" ends in ".add" it's used as the input file name
9012 * and ".spl" is appended to make the output file name.
9015 mkspell(fcount
, fnames
, ascii
, overwrite
, added_word
)
9018 int ascii
; /* -ascii argument given */
9019 int overwrite
; /* overwrite existing output file */
9020 int added_word
; /* invoked through "zg" */
9022 char_u fname
[MAXPATHL
];
9023 char_u wfname
[MAXPATHL
];
9026 afffile_T
*(afile
[8]);
9033 vim_memset(&spin
, 0, sizeof(spin
));
9034 spin
.si_verbose
= !added_word
;
9035 spin
.si_ascii
= ascii
;
9036 spin
.si_followup
= TRUE
;
9037 spin
.si_rem_accents
= TRUE
;
9038 ga_init2(&spin
.si_rep
, (int)sizeof(fromto_T
), 20);
9039 ga_init2(&spin
.si_repsal
, (int)sizeof(fromto_T
), 20);
9040 ga_init2(&spin
.si_sal
, (int)sizeof(fromto_T
), 20);
9041 ga_init2(&spin
.si_map
, (int)sizeof(char_u
), 100);
9042 ga_init2(&spin
.si_comppat
, (int)sizeof(char_u
*), 20);
9043 ga_init2(&spin
.si_prefcond
, (int)sizeof(char_u
*), 50);
9044 hash_init(&spin
.si_commonwords
);
9045 spin
.si_newcompID
= 127; /* start compound ID at first maximum */
9047 /* default: fnames[0] is output file, following are input files */
9048 innames
= &fnames
[1];
9049 incount
= fcount
- 1;
9053 len
= (int)STRLEN(fnames
[0]);
9054 if (fcount
== 1 && len
> 4 && STRCMP(fnames
[0] + len
- 4, ".add") == 0)
9056 /* For ":mkspell path/en.latin1.add" output file is
9057 * "path/en.latin1.add.spl". */
9058 innames
= &fnames
[0];
9060 vim_snprintf((char *)wfname
, sizeof(wfname
), "%s.spl", fnames
[0]);
9062 else if (fcount
== 1)
9064 /* For ":mkspell path/vim" output file is "path/vim.latin1.spl". */
9065 innames
= &fnames
[0];
9067 vim_snprintf((char *)wfname
, sizeof(wfname
), "%s.%s.spl", fnames
[0],
9068 spin
.si_ascii
? (char_u
*)"ascii" : spell_enc());
9070 else if (len
> 4 && STRCMP(fnames
[0] + len
- 4, ".spl") == 0)
9072 /* Name ends in ".spl", use as the file name. */
9073 vim_strncpy(wfname
, fnames
[0], sizeof(wfname
) - 1);
9076 /* Name should be language, make the file name from it. */
9077 vim_snprintf((char *)wfname
, sizeof(wfname
), "%s.%s.spl", fnames
[0],
9078 spin
.si_ascii
? (char_u
*)"ascii" : spell_enc());
9080 /* Check for .ascii.spl. */
9081 if (strstr((char *)gettail(wfname
), ".ascii.") != NULL
)
9082 spin
.si_ascii
= TRUE
;
9084 /* Check for .add.spl. */
9085 if (strstr((char *)gettail(wfname
), ".add.") != NULL
)
9090 EMSG(_(e_invarg
)); /* need at least output and input names */
9091 else if (vim_strchr(gettail(wfname
), '_') != NULL
)
9092 EMSG(_("E751: Output file name must not have region name"));
9093 else if (incount
> 8)
9094 EMSG(_("E754: Only up to 8 regions supported"));
9097 /* Check for overwriting before doing things that may take a lot of
9099 if (!overwrite
&& mch_stat((char *)wfname
, &st
) >= 0)
9104 if (mch_isdir(wfname
))
9106 EMSG2(_(e_isadir2
), wfname
);
9111 * Init the aff and dic pointers.
9112 * Get the region names if there are more than 2 arguments.
9114 for (i
= 0; i
< incount
; ++i
)
9120 len
= (int)STRLEN(innames
[i
]);
9121 if (STRLEN(gettail(innames
[i
])) < 5
9122 || innames
[i
][len
- 3] != '_')
9124 EMSG2(_("E755: Invalid region in %s"), innames
[i
]);
9127 spin
.si_region_name
[i
* 2] = TOLOWER_ASC(innames
[i
][len
- 2]);
9128 spin
.si_region_name
[i
* 2 + 1] =
9129 TOLOWER_ASC(innames
[i
][len
- 1]);
9132 spin
.si_region_count
= incount
;
9134 spin
.si_foldroot
= wordtree_alloc(&spin
);
9135 spin
.si_keeproot
= wordtree_alloc(&spin
);
9136 spin
.si_prefroot
= wordtree_alloc(&spin
);
9137 if (spin
.si_foldroot
== NULL
9138 || spin
.si_keeproot
== NULL
9139 || spin
.si_prefroot
== NULL
)
9141 free_blocks(spin
.si_blocks
);
9145 /* When not producing a .add.spl file clear the character table when
9146 * we encounter one in the .aff file. This means we dump the current
9147 * one in the .spl file if the .aff file doesn't define one. That's
9148 * better than guessing the contents, the table will match a
9149 * previously loaded spell file. */
9151 spin
.si_clear_chartab
= TRUE
;
9154 * Read all the .aff and .dic files.
9155 * Text is converted to 'encoding'.
9156 * Words are stored in the case-folded and keep-case trees.
9158 for (i
= 0; i
< incount
&& !error
; ++i
)
9160 spin
.si_conv
.vc_type
= CONV_NONE
;
9161 spin
.si_region
= 1 << i
;
9163 vim_snprintf((char *)fname
, sizeof(fname
), "%s.aff", innames
[i
]);
9164 if (mch_stat((char *)fname
, &st
) >= 0)
9166 /* Read the .aff file. Will init "spin->si_conv" based on the
9168 afile
[i
] = spell_read_aff(&spin
, fname
);
9169 if (afile
[i
] == NULL
)
9173 /* Read the .dic file and store the words in the trees. */
9174 vim_snprintf((char *)fname
, sizeof(fname
), "%s.dic",
9176 if (spell_read_dic(&spin
, fname
, afile
[i
]) == FAIL
)
9182 /* No .aff file, try reading the file as a word list. Store
9183 * the words in the trees. */
9184 if (spell_read_wordfile(&spin
, innames
[i
]) == FAIL
)
9189 /* Free any conversion stuff. */
9190 convert_setup(&spin
.si_conv
, NULL
, NULL
);
9194 if (spin
.si_compflags
!= NULL
&& spin
.si_nobreak
)
9195 MSG(_("Warning: both compounding and NOBREAK specified"));
9197 if (!error
&& !got_int
)
9200 * Combine tails in the tree.
9202 spell_message(&spin
, (char_u
*)_(msg_compressing
));
9203 wordtree_compress(&spin
, spin
.si_foldroot
);
9204 wordtree_compress(&spin
, spin
.si_keeproot
);
9205 wordtree_compress(&spin
, spin
.si_prefroot
);
9208 if (!error
&& !got_int
)
9211 * Write the info in the spell file.
9213 vim_snprintf((char *)IObuff
, IOSIZE
,
9214 _("Writing spell file %s ..."), wfname
);
9215 spell_message(&spin
, IObuff
);
9217 error
= write_vim_spell(&spin
, wfname
) == FAIL
;
9219 spell_message(&spin
, (char_u
*)_("Done!"));
9220 vim_snprintf((char *)IObuff
, IOSIZE
,
9221 _("Estimated runtime memory use: %d bytes"), spin
.si_memtot
);
9222 spell_message(&spin
, IObuff
);
9225 * If the file is loaded need to reload it.
9228 spell_reload_one(wfname
, added_word
);
9231 /* Free the allocated memory. */
9232 ga_clear(&spin
.si_rep
);
9233 ga_clear(&spin
.si_repsal
);
9234 ga_clear(&spin
.si_sal
);
9235 ga_clear(&spin
.si_map
);
9236 ga_clear(&spin
.si_comppat
);
9237 ga_clear(&spin
.si_prefcond
);
9238 hash_clear_all(&spin
.si_commonwords
, 0);
9240 /* Free the .aff file structures. */
9241 for (i
= 0; i
< incount
; ++i
)
9242 if (afile
[i
] != NULL
)
9243 spell_free_aff(afile
[i
]);
9245 /* Free all the bits and pieces at once. */
9246 free_blocks(spin
.si_blocks
);
9249 * If there is soundfolding info and no NOSUGFILE item create the
9250 * .sug file with the soundfolded word trie.
9252 if (spin
.si_sugtime
!= 0 && !error
&& !got_int
)
9253 spell_make_sugfile(&spin
, wfname
);
9259 * Display a message for spell file processing when 'verbose' is set or using
9260 * ":mkspell". "str" can be IObuff.
9263 spell_message(spin
, str
)
9267 if (spin
->si_verbose
|| p_verbose
> 2)
9269 if (!spin
->si_verbose
)
9273 if (!spin
->si_verbose
)
9279 * ":[count]spellgood {word}"
9280 * ":[count]spellwrong {word}"
9281 * ":[count]spellundo {word}"
9287 spell_add_word(eap
->arg
, (int)STRLEN(eap
->arg
), eap
->cmdidx
== CMD_spellwrong
,
9288 eap
->forceit
? 0 : (int)eap
->line2
,
9289 eap
->cmdidx
== CMD_spellundo
);
9293 * Add "word[len]" to 'spellfile' as a good or bad word.
9296 spell_add_word(word
, len
, bad
, idx
, undo
)
9300 int idx
; /* "zG" and "zW": zero, otherwise index in
9302 int undo
; /* TRUE for "zug", "zuG", "zuw" and "zuW" */
9306 int new_spf
= FALSE
;
9308 char_u fnamebuf
[MAXPATHL
];
9309 char_u line
[MAXWLEN
* 2];
9310 long fpos
, fpos_next
= 0;
9314 if (idx
== 0) /* use internal wordlist */
9316 if (int_wordlist
== NULL
)
9318 int_wordlist
= vim_tempname('s');
9319 if (int_wordlist
== NULL
)
9322 fname
= int_wordlist
;
9326 /* If 'spellfile' isn't set figure out a good default value. */
9327 if (*curbuf
->b_p_spf
== NUL
)
9333 if (*curbuf
->b_p_spf
== NUL
)
9335 EMSG2(_(e_notset
), "spellfile");
9339 for (spf
= curbuf
->b_p_spf
, i
= 1; *spf
!= NUL
; ++i
)
9341 copy_option_part(&spf
, fnamebuf
, MAXPATHL
, ",");
9346 EMSGN(_("E765: 'spellfile' does not have %ld entries"), idx
);
9351 /* Check that the user isn't editing the .add file somewhere. */
9352 buf
= buflist_findname_exp(fnamebuf
);
9353 if (buf
!= NULL
&& buf
->b_ml
.ml_mfp
== NULL
)
9355 if (buf
!= NULL
&& bufIsChanged(buf
))
9357 EMSG(_(e_bufloaded
));
9366 /* When the word appears as good word we need to remove that one,
9367 * since its flags sort before the one with WF_BANNED. */
9368 fd
= mch_fopen((char *)fname
, "r");
9371 while (!vim_fgets(line
, MAXWLEN
* 2, fd
))
9374 fpos_next
= ftell(fd
);
9375 if (STRNCMP(word
, line
, len
) == 0
9376 && (line
[len
] == '/' || line
[len
] < ' '))
9378 /* Found duplicate word. Remove it by writing a '#' at
9379 * the start of the line. Mixing reading and writing
9380 * doesn't work for all systems, close the file first. */
9382 fd
= mch_fopen((char *)fname
, "r+");
9385 if (fseek(fd
, fpos
, SEEK_SET
) == 0)
9390 home_replace(NULL
, fname
, NameBuff
, MAXPATHL
, TRUE
);
9391 smsg((char_u
*)_("Word removed from %s"), NameBuff
);
9394 fseek(fd
, fpos_next
, SEEK_SET
);
9403 fd
= mch_fopen((char *)fname
, "a");
9404 if (fd
== NULL
&& new_spf
)
9408 /* We just initialized the 'spellfile' option and can't open the
9409 * file. We may need to create the "spell" directory first. We
9410 * already checked the runtime directory is writable in
9411 * init_spellfile(). */
9412 if (!dir_of_file_exists(fname
) && (p
= gettail_sep(fname
)) != fname
)
9416 /* The directory doesn't exist. Try creating it and opening
9417 * the file again. */
9419 vim_mkdir(fname
, 0755);
9421 fd
= mch_fopen((char *)fname
, "a");
9426 EMSG2(_(e_notopen
), fname
);
9430 fprintf(fd
, "%.*s/!\n", len
, word
);
9432 fprintf(fd
, "%.*s\n", len
, word
);
9435 home_replace(NULL
, fname
, NameBuff
, MAXPATHL
, TRUE
);
9436 smsg((char_u
*)_("Word added to %s"), NameBuff
);
9442 /* Update the .add.spl file. */
9443 mkspell(1, &fname
, FALSE
, TRUE
, TRUE
);
9445 /* If the .add file is edited somewhere, reload it. */
9447 buf_reload(buf
, buf
->b_orig_mode
);
9449 redraw_all_later(SOME_VALID
);
9454 * Initialize 'spellfile' for the current buffer.
9459 char_u buf
[MAXPATHL
];
9465 char_u
*lstart
= curbuf
->b_p_spl
;
9467 if (*curbuf
->b_p_spl
!= NUL
&& curbuf
->b_langp
.ga_len
> 0)
9469 /* Find the end of the language name. Exclude the region. If there
9470 * is a path separator remember the start of the tail. */
9471 for (lend
= curbuf
->b_p_spl
; *lend
!= NUL
9472 && vim_strchr((char_u
*)",._", *lend
) == NULL
; ++lend
)
9473 if (vim_ispathsep(*lend
))
9479 /* Loop over all entries in 'runtimepath'. Use the first one where we
9480 * are allowed to write. */
9485 /* Use directory of an entry with path, e.g., for
9486 * "/dir/lg.utf-8.spl" use "/dir". */
9487 vim_strncpy(buf
, curbuf
->b_p_spl
, lstart
- curbuf
->b_p_spl
- 1);
9489 /* Copy the path from 'runtimepath' to buf[]. */
9490 copy_option_part(&rtp
, buf
, MAXPATHL
, ",");
9491 if (filewritable(buf
) == 2)
9493 /* Use the first language name from 'spelllang' and the
9494 * encoding used in the first loaded .spl file. */
9496 vim_strncpy(buf
, curbuf
->b_p_spl
, lend
- curbuf
->b_p_spl
);
9499 /* Create the "spell" directory if it doesn't exist yet. */
9500 l
= (int)STRLEN(buf
);
9501 vim_snprintf((char *)buf
+ l
, MAXPATHL
- l
, "/spell");
9502 if (!filewritable(buf
) != 2)
9503 vim_mkdir(buf
, 0755);
9505 l
= (int)STRLEN(buf
);
9506 vim_snprintf((char *)buf
+ l
, MAXPATHL
- l
,
9507 "/%.*s", (int)(lend
- lstart
), lstart
);
9509 l
= (int)STRLEN(buf
);
9510 fname
= LANGP_ENTRY(curbuf
->b_langp
, 0)->lp_slang
->sl_fname
;
9511 vim_snprintf((char *)buf
+ l
, MAXPATHL
- l
, ".%s.add",
9513 && strstr((char *)gettail(fname
), ".ascii.") != NULL
9514 ? (char_u
*)"ascii" : spell_enc());
9515 set_option_value((char_u
*)"spellfile", 0L, buf
, OPT_LOCAL
);
9525 * Init the chartab used for spelling for ASCII.
9526 * EBCDIC is not supported!
9529 clear_spell_chartab(sp
)
9534 /* Init everything to FALSE. */
9535 vim_memset(sp
->st_isw
, FALSE
, sizeof(sp
->st_isw
));
9536 vim_memset(sp
->st_isu
, FALSE
, sizeof(sp
->st_isu
));
9537 for (i
= 0; i
< 256; ++i
)
9540 sp
->st_upper
[i
] = i
;
9543 /* We include digits. A word shouldn't start with a digit, but handling
9544 * that is done separately. */
9545 for (i
= '0'; i
<= '9'; ++i
)
9546 sp
->st_isw
[i
] = TRUE
;
9547 for (i
= 'A'; i
<= 'Z'; ++i
)
9549 sp
->st_isw
[i
] = TRUE
;
9550 sp
->st_isu
[i
] = TRUE
;
9551 sp
->st_fold
[i
] = i
+ 0x20;
9553 for (i
= 'a'; i
<= 'z'; ++i
)
9555 sp
->st_isw
[i
] = TRUE
;
9556 sp
->st_upper
[i
] = i
- 0x20;
9561 * Init the chartab used for spelling. Only depends on 'encoding'.
9562 * Called once while starting up and when 'encoding' changes.
9563 * The default is to use isalpha(), but the spell file should define the word
9564 * characters to make it possible that 'encoding' differs from the current
9565 * locale. For utf-8 we don't use isalpha() but our own functions.
9568 init_spell_chartab()
9572 did_set_spelltab
= FALSE
;
9573 clear_spell_chartab(&spelltab
);
9577 /* DBCS: assume double-wide characters are word characters. */
9578 for (i
= 128; i
<= 255; ++i
)
9579 if (MB_BYTE2LEN(i
) == 2)
9580 spelltab
.st_isw
[i
] = TRUE
;
9584 for (i
= 128; i
< 256; ++i
)
9586 spelltab
.st_isu
[i
] = utf_isupper(i
);
9587 spelltab
.st_isw
[i
] = spelltab
.st_isu
[i
] || utf_islower(i
);
9588 spelltab
.st_fold
[i
] = utf_fold(i
);
9589 spelltab
.st_upper
[i
] = utf_toupper(i
);
9595 /* Rough guess: use locale-dependent library functions. */
9596 for (i
= 128; i
< 256; ++i
)
9600 spelltab
.st_isw
[i
] = TRUE
;
9601 spelltab
.st_isu
[i
] = TRUE
;
9602 spelltab
.st_fold
[i
] = MB_TOLOWER(i
);
9604 else if (MB_ISLOWER(i
))
9606 spelltab
.st_isw
[i
] = TRUE
;
9607 spelltab
.st_upper
[i
] = MB_TOUPPER(i
);
9614 * Set the spell character tables from strings in the affix file.
9617 set_spell_chartab(fol
, low
, upp
)
9622 /* We build the new tables here first, so that we can compare with the
9625 char_u
*pf
= fol
, *pl
= low
, *pu
= upp
;
9628 clear_spell_chartab(&new_st
);
9632 if (*pl
== NUL
|| *pu
== NUL
)
9638 f
= mb_ptr2char_adv(&pf
);
9639 l
= mb_ptr2char_adv(&pl
);
9640 u
= mb_ptr2char_adv(&pu
);
9646 /* Every character that appears is a word character. */
9648 new_st
.st_isw
[f
] = TRUE
;
9650 new_st
.st_isw
[l
] = TRUE
;
9652 new_st
.st_isw
[u
] = TRUE
;
9654 /* if "LOW" and "FOL" are not the same the "LOW" char needs
9656 if (l
< 256 && l
!= f
)
9660 EMSG(_(e_affrange
));
9663 new_st
.st_fold
[l
] = f
;
9666 /* if "UPP" and "FOL" are not the same the "UPP" char needs
9667 * case-folding, it's upper case and the "UPP" is the upper case of
9669 if (u
< 256 && u
!= f
)
9673 EMSG(_(e_affrange
));
9676 new_st
.st_fold
[u
] = f
;
9677 new_st
.st_isu
[u
] = TRUE
;
9678 new_st
.st_upper
[f
] = u
;
9682 if (*pl
!= NUL
|| *pu
!= NUL
)
9688 return set_spell_finish(&new_st
);
9692 * Set the spell character tables from strings in the .spl file.
9695 set_spell_charflags(flags
, cnt
, fol
)
9697 int cnt
; /* length of "flags" */
9700 /* We build the new tables here first, so that we can compare with the
9707 clear_spell_chartab(&new_st
);
9709 for (i
= 0; i
< 128; ++i
)
9713 new_st
.st_isw
[i
+ 128] = (flags
[i
] & CF_WORD
) != 0;
9714 new_st
.st_isu
[i
+ 128] = (flags
[i
] & CF_UPPER
) != 0;
9720 c
= mb_ptr2char_adv(&p
);
9724 new_st
.st_fold
[i
+ 128] = c
;
9725 if (i
+ 128 != c
&& new_st
.st_isu
[i
+ 128] && c
< 256)
9726 new_st
.st_upper
[c
] = i
+ 128;
9730 (void)set_spell_finish(&new_st
);
9734 set_spell_finish(new_st
)
9739 if (did_set_spelltab
)
9741 /* check that it's the same table */
9742 for (i
= 0; i
< 256; ++i
)
9744 if (spelltab
.st_isw
[i
] != new_st
->st_isw
[i
]
9745 || spelltab
.st_isu
[i
] != new_st
->st_isu
[i
]
9746 || spelltab
.st_fold
[i
] != new_st
->st_fold
[i
]
9747 || spelltab
.st_upper
[i
] != new_st
->st_upper
[i
])
9749 EMSG(_("E763: Word characters differ between spell files"));
9756 /* copy the new spelltab into the one being used */
9758 did_set_spelltab
= TRUE
;
9765 * Return TRUE if "p" points to a word character.
9766 * As a special case we see "midword" characters as word character when it is
9767 * followed by a word character. This finds they'there but not 'they there'.
9768 * Thus this only works properly when past the first character of the word.
9771 spell_iswordp(p
, buf
)
9773 buf_T
*buf
; /* buffer used */
9782 l
= MB_BYTE2LEN(*p
);
9786 /* be quick for ASCII */
9787 if (buf
->b_spell_ismw
[*p
])
9789 s
= p
+ 1; /* skip a mid-word character */
9790 l
= MB_BYTE2LEN(*s
);
9796 if (c
< 256 ? buf
->b_spell_ismw
[c
]
9797 : (buf
->b_spell_ismw_mb
!= NULL
9798 && vim_strchr(buf
->b_spell_ismw_mb
, c
) != NULL
))
9801 l
= MB_BYTE2LEN(*s
);
9807 return spell_mb_isword_class(mb_get_class(s
));
9808 return spelltab
.st_isw
[c
];
9812 return spelltab
.st_isw
[buf
->b_spell_ismw
[*p
] ? p
[1] : p
[0]];
9816 * Return TRUE if "p" points to a word character.
9817 * Unlike spell_iswordp() this doesn't check for "midword" characters.
9820 spell_iswordp_nmw(p
)
9830 return spell_mb_isword_class(mb_get_class(p
));
9831 return spelltab
.st_isw
[c
];
9834 return spelltab
.st_isw
[*p
];
9839 * Return TRUE if word class indicates a word character.
9840 * Only for characters above 255.
9841 * Unicode subscript and superscript are not considered word characters.
9844 spell_mb_isword_class(cl
)
9847 return cl
>= 2 && cl
!= 0x2070 && cl
!= 0x2080;
9851 * Return TRUE if "p" points to a word character.
9852 * Wide version of spell_iswordp().
9855 spell_iswordp_w(p
, buf
)
9861 if (*p
< 256 ? buf
->b_spell_ismw
[*p
]
9862 : (buf
->b_spell_ismw_mb
!= NULL
9863 && vim_strchr(buf
->b_spell_ismw_mb
, *p
) != NULL
))
9871 return spell_mb_isword_class(utf_class(*s
));
9873 return dbcs_class((unsigned)*s
>> 8, *s
& 0xff) >= 2;
9876 return spelltab
.st_isw
[*s
];
9881 * Write the table with prefix conditions to the .spl file.
9882 * When "fd" is NULL only count the length of what is written.
9885 write_spell_prefcond(fd
, gap
)
9895 put_bytes(fd
, (long_u
)gap
->ga_len
, 2); /* <prefcondcnt> */
9897 totlen
= 2 + gap
->ga_len
; /* length of <prefcondcnt> and <condlen> bytes */
9899 for (i
= 0; i
< gap
->ga_len
; ++i
)
9901 /* <prefcond> : <condlen> <condstr> */
9902 p
= ((char_u
**)gap
->ga_data
)[i
];
9905 len
= (int)STRLEN(p
);
9909 fwrite(p
, (size_t)len
, (size_t)1, fd
);
9913 else if (fd
!= NULL
)
9921 * Case-fold "str[len]" into "buf[buflen]". The result is NUL terminated.
9922 * Uses the character definitions from the .spl file.
9923 * When using a multi-byte 'encoding' the length may change!
9924 * Returns FAIL when something wrong.
9927 spell_casefold(str
, len
, buf
, buflen
)
9938 return FAIL
; /* result will not fit */
9948 /* Fold one character at a time. */
9949 for (p
= str
; p
< str
+ len
; )
9951 if (outi
+ MB_MAXBYTES
> buflen
)
9956 c
= mb_cptr2char_adv(&p
);
9957 outi
+= mb_char2bytes(SPELL_TOFOLD(c
), buf
+ outi
);
9964 /* Be quick for non-multibyte encodings. */
9965 for (i
= 0; i
< len
; ++i
)
9966 buf
[i
] = spelltab
.st_fold
[str
[i
]];
9973 /* values for sps_flags */
9976 #define SPS_DOUBLE 4
9978 static int sps_flags
= SPS_BEST
; /* flags from 'spellsuggest' */
9979 static int sps_limit
= 9999; /* max nr of suggestions given */
9982 * Check the 'spellsuggest' option. Return FAIL if it's wrong.
9983 * Sets "sps_flags" and "sps_limit".
9990 char_u buf
[MAXPATHL
];
9996 for (p
= p_sps
; *p
!= NUL
; )
9998 copy_option_part(&p
, buf
, MAXPATHL
, ",");
10001 if (VIM_ISDIGIT(*buf
))
10004 sps_limit
= getdigits(&s
);
10005 if (*s
!= NUL
&& !VIM_ISDIGIT(*s
))
10008 else if (STRCMP(buf
, "best") == 0)
10010 else if (STRCMP(buf
, "fast") == 0)
10012 else if (STRCMP(buf
, "double") == 0)
10014 else if (STRNCMP(buf
, "expr:", 5) != 0
10015 && STRNCMP(buf
, "file:", 5) != 0)
10018 if (f
== -1 || (sps_flags
!= 0 && f
!= 0))
10020 sps_flags
= SPS_BEST
;
10028 if (sps_flags
== 0)
10029 sps_flags
= SPS_BEST
;
10035 * "z?": Find badly spelled word under or after the cursor.
10036 * Give suggestions for the properly spelled word.
10037 * In Visual mode use the highlighted word as the bad word.
10038 * When "count" is non-zero use that suggestion.
10041 spell_suggest(count
)
10045 pos_T prev_cursor
= curwin
->w_cursor
;
10046 char_u wcopy
[MAXWLEN
+ 2];
10055 int selected
= count
;
10058 if (no_spell_checking(curwin
))
10064 /* Use the Visually selected text as the bad word. But reject
10065 * a multi-line selection. */
10066 if (curwin
->w_cursor
.lnum
!= VIsual
.lnum
)
10071 badlen
= (int)curwin
->w_cursor
.col
- (int)VIsual
.col
;
10075 curwin
->w_cursor
.col
= VIsual
.col
;
10081 /* Find the start of the badly spelled word. */
10082 if (spell_move_to(curwin
, FORWARD
, TRUE
, TRUE
, NULL
) == 0
10083 || curwin
->w_cursor
.col
> prev_cursor
.col
)
10085 /* No bad word or it starts after the cursor: use the word under the
10087 curwin
->w_cursor
= prev_cursor
;
10088 line
= ml_get_curline();
10089 p
= line
+ curwin
->w_cursor
.col
;
10090 /* Backup to before start of word. */
10091 while (p
> line
&& spell_iswordp_nmw(p
))
10092 mb_ptr_back(line
, p
);
10093 /* Forward to start of word. */
10094 while (*p
!= NUL
&& !spell_iswordp_nmw(p
))
10097 if (!spell_iswordp_nmw(p
)) /* No word found. */
10102 curwin
->w_cursor
.col
= (colnr_T
)(p
- line
);
10105 /* Get the word and its length. */
10107 /* Figure out if the word should be capitalised. */
10108 need_cap
= check_need_cap(curwin
->w_cursor
.lnum
, curwin
->w_cursor
.col
);
10110 line
= ml_get_curline();
10112 /* Get the list of suggestions. Limit to 'lines' - 2 or the number in
10113 * 'spellsuggest', whatever is smaller. */
10114 if (sps_limit
> (int)Rows
- 2)
10115 limit
= (int)Rows
- 2;
10118 spell_find_suggest(line
+ curwin
->w_cursor
.col
, badlen
, &sug
, limit
,
10119 TRUE
, need_cap
, TRUE
);
10121 if (sug
.su_ga
.ga_len
== 0)
10122 MSG(_("Sorry, no suggestions"));
10123 else if (count
> 0)
10125 if (count
> sug
.su_ga
.ga_len
)
10126 smsg((char_u
*)_("Sorry, only %ld suggestions"),
10127 (long)sug
.su_ga
.ga_len
);
10131 vim_free(repl_from
);
10136 #ifdef FEAT_RIGHTLEFT
10137 /* When 'rightleft' is set the list is drawn right-left. */
10138 cmdmsg_rl
= curwin
->w_p_rl
;
10140 msg_col
= Columns
- 1;
10143 /* List the suggestions. */
10145 msg_row
= Rows
- 1; /* for when 'cmdheight' > 1 */
10146 lines_left
= Rows
; /* avoid more prompt */
10147 vim_snprintf((char *)IObuff
, IOSIZE
, _("Change \"%.*s\" to:"),
10148 sug
.su_badlen
, sug
.su_badptr
);
10149 #ifdef FEAT_RIGHTLEFT
10150 if (cmdmsg_rl
&& STRNCMP(IObuff
, "Change", 6) == 0)
10152 /* And now the rabbit from the high hat: Avoid showing the
10153 * untranslated message rightleft. */
10154 vim_snprintf((char *)IObuff
, IOSIZE
, ":ot \"%.*s\" egnahC",
10155 sug
.su_badlen
, sug
.su_badptr
);
10163 for (i
= 0; i
< sug
.su_ga
.ga_len
; ++i
)
10165 stp
= &SUG(sug
.su_ga
, i
);
10167 /* The suggested word may replace only part of the bad word, add
10168 * the not replaced part. */
10169 STRCPY(wcopy
, stp
->st_word
);
10170 if (sug
.su_badlen
> stp
->st_orglen
)
10171 vim_strncpy(wcopy
+ stp
->st_wordlen
,
10172 sug
.su_badptr
+ stp
->st_orglen
,
10173 sug
.su_badlen
- stp
->st_orglen
);
10174 vim_snprintf((char *)IObuff
, IOSIZE
, "%2d", i
+ 1);
10175 #ifdef FEAT_RIGHTLEFT
10181 vim_snprintf((char *)IObuff
, IOSIZE
, " \"%s\"", wcopy
);
10184 /* The word may replace more than "su_badlen". */
10185 if (sug
.su_badlen
< stp
->st_orglen
)
10187 vim_snprintf((char *)IObuff
, IOSIZE
, _(" < \"%.*s\""),
10188 stp
->st_orglen
, sug
.su_badptr
);
10194 /* Add the score. */
10195 if (sps_flags
& (SPS_DOUBLE
| SPS_BEST
))
10196 vim_snprintf((char *)IObuff
, IOSIZE
, " (%s%d - %d)",
10197 stp
->st_salscore
? "s " : "",
10198 stp
->st_score
, stp
->st_altscore
);
10200 vim_snprintf((char *)IObuff
, IOSIZE
, " (%d)",
10202 #ifdef FEAT_RIGHTLEFT
10204 /* Mirror the numbers, but keep the leading space. */
10205 rl_mirror(IObuff
+ 1);
10213 #ifdef FEAT_RIGHTLEFT
10217 /* Ask for choice. */
10218 selected
= prompt_for_number(&mouse_used
);
10220 selected
-= lines_left
;
10221 lines_left
= Rows
; /* avoid more prompt */
10224 if (selected
> 0 && selected
<= sug
.su_ga
.ga_len
&& u_save_cursor() == OK
)
10226 /* Save the from and to text for :spellrepall. */
10227 stp
= &SUG(sug
.su_ga
, selected
- 1);
10228 if (sug
.su_badlen
> stp
->st_orglen
)
10230 /* Replacing less than "su_badlen", append the remainder to
10232 repl_from
= vim_strnsave(sug
.su_badptr
, sug
.su_badlen
);
10233 vim_snprintf((char *)IObuff
, IOSIZE
, "%s%.*s", stp
->st_word
,
10234 sug
.su_badlen
- stp
->st_orglen
,
10235 sug
.su_badptr
+ stp
->st_orglen
);
10236 repl_to
= vim_strsave(IObuff
);
10240 /* Replacing su_badlen or more, use the whole word. */
10241 repl_from
= vim_strnsave(sug
.su_badptr
, stp
->st_orglen
);
10242 repl_to
= vim_strsave(stp
->st_word
);
10245 /* Replace the word. */
10246 p
= alloc((unsigned)STRLEN(line
) - stp
->st_orglen
+ stp
->st_wordlen
+ 1);
10249 c
= (int)(sug
.su_badptr
- line
);
10250 mch_memmove(p
, line
, c
);
10251 STRCPY(p
+ c
, stp
->st_word
);
10252 STRCAT(p
, sug
.su_badptr
+ stp
->st_orglen
);
10253 ml_replace(curwin
->w_cursor
.lnum
, p
, FALSE
);
10254 curwin
->w_cursor
.col
= c
;
10256 /* For redo we use a change-word command. */
10258 AppendToRedobuff((char_u
*)"ciw");
10259 AppendToRedobuffLit(p
+ c
,
10260 stp
->st_wordlen
+ sug
.su_badlen
- stp
->st_orglen
);
10261 AppendCharToRedobuff(ESC
);
10263 /* After this "p" may be invalid. */
10264 changed_bytes(curwin
->w_cursor
.lnum
, c
);
10268 curwin
->w_cursor
= prev_cursor
;
10270 spell_find_cleanup(&sug
);
10274 * Check if the word at line "lnum" column "col" is required to start with a
10275 * capital. This uses 'spellcapcheck' of the current buffer.
10278 check_need_cap(lnum
, col
)
10282 int need_cap
= FALSE
;
10284 char_u
*line_copy
= NULL
;
10287 regmatch_T regmatch
;
10289 if (curbuf
->b_cap_prog
== NULL
)
10292 line
= ml_get_curline();
10294 if ((int)(skipwhite(line
) - line
) >= (int)col
)
10296 /* At start of line, check if previous line is empty or sentence
10302 line
= ml_get(lnum
- 1);
10303 if (*skipwhite(line
) == NUL
)
10307 /* Append a space in place of the line break. */
10308 line_copy
= concat_str(line
, (char_u
*)" ");
10310 endcol
= (colnr_T
)STRLEN(line
);
10319 /* Check if sentence ends before the bad word. */
10320 regmatch
.regprog
= curbuf
->b_cap_prog
;
10321 regmatch
.rm_ic
= FALSE
;
10325 mb_ptr_back(line
, p
);
10326 if (p
== line
|| spell_iswordp_nmw(p
))
10328 if (vim_regexec(®match
, p
, 0)
10329 && regmatch
.endp
[0] == line
+ endcol
)
10337 vim_free(line_copy
);
10348 ex_spellrepall(eap
)
10351 pos_T pos
= curwin
->w_cursor
;
10356 int save_ws
= p_ws
;
10357 linenr_T prev_lnum
= 0;
10359 if (repl_from
== NULL
|| repl_to
== NULL
)
10361 EMSG(_("E752: No previous spell replacement"));
10364 addlen
= (int)(STRLEN(repl_to
) - STRLEN(repl_from
));
10366 frompat
= alloc((unsigned)STRLEN(repl_from
) + 7);
10367 if (frompat
== NULL
)
10369 sprintf((char *)frompat
, "\\V\\<%s\\>", repl_from
);
10374 curwin
->w_cursor
.lnum
= 0;
10377 if (do_search(NULL
, '/', frompat
, 1L, SEARCH_KEEP
, NULL
) == 0
10378 || u_save_cursor() == FAIL
)
10381 /* Only replace when the right word isn't there yet. This happens
10382 * when changing "etc" to "etc.". */
10383 line
= ml_get_curline();
10384 if (addlen
<= 0 || STRNCMP(line
+ curwin
->w_cursor
.col
,
10385 repl_to
, STRLEN(repl_to
)) != 0)
10387 p
= alloc((unsigned)STRLEN(line
) + addlen
+ 1);
10390 mch_memmove(p
, line
, curwin
->w_cursor
.col
);
10391 STRCPY(p
+ curwin
->w_cursor
.col
, repl_to
);
10392 STRCAT(p
, line
+ curwin
->w_cursor
.col
+ STRLEN(repl_from
));
10393 ml_replace(curwin
->w_cursor
.lnum
, p
, FALSE
);
10394 changed_bytes(curwin
->w_cursor
.lnum
, curwin
->w_cursor
.col
);
10396 if (curwin
->w_cursor
.lnum
!= prev_lnum
)
10399 prev_lnum
= curwin
->w_cursor
.lnum
;
10403 curwin
->w_cursor
.col
+= (colnr_T
)STRLEN(repl_to
);
10407 curwin
->w_cursor
= pos
;
10410 if (sub_nsubs
== 0)
10411 EMSG2(_("E753: Not found: %s"), repl_from
);
10417 * Find spell suggestions for "word". Return them in the growarray "*gap" as
10418 * a list of allocated strings.
10421 spell_suggest_list(gap
, word
, maxcount
, need_cap
, interactive
)
10424 int maxcount
; /* maximum nr of suggestions */
10425 int need_cap
; /* 'spellcapcheck' matched */
10433 spell_find_suggest(word
, 0, &sug
, maxcount
, FALSE
, need_cap
, interactive
);
10435 /* Make room in "gap". */
10436 ga_init2(gap
, sizeof(char_u
*), sug
.su_ga
.ga_len
+ 1);
10437 if (ga_grow(gap
, sug
.su_ga
.ga_len
) == OK
)
10439 for (i
= 0; i
< sug
.su_ga
.ga_len
; ++i
)
10441 stp
= &SUG(sug
.su_ga
, i
);
10443 /* The suggested word may replace only part of "word", add the not
10444 * replaced part. */
10445 wcopy
= alloc(stp
->st_wordlen
10446 + (unsigned)STRLEN(sug
.su_badptr
+ stp
->st_orglen
) + 1);
10449 STRCPY(wcopy
, stp
->st_word
);
10450 STRCPY(wcopy
+ stp
->st_wordlen
, sug
.su_badptr
+ stp
->st_orglen
);
10451 ((char_u
**)gap
->ga_data
)[gap
->ga_len
++] = wcopy
;
10455 spell_find_cleanup(&sug
);
10459 * Find spell suggestions for the word at the start of "badptr".
10460 * Return the suggestions in "su->su_ga".
10461 * The maximum number of suggestions is "maxcount".
10462 * Note: does use info for the current window.
10463 * This is based on the mechanisms of Aspell, but completely reimplemented.
10466 spell_find_suggest(badptr
, badlen
, su
, maxcount
, banbadword
, need_cap
, interactive
)
10468 int badlen
; /* length of bad word or 0 if unknown */
10471 int banbadword
; /* don't include badword in suggestions */
10472 int need_cap
; /* word should start with capital */
10475 hlf_T attr
= HLF_COUNT
;
10476 char_u buf
[MAXPATHL
];
10478 int do_combine
= FALSE
;
10481 static int expr_busy
= FALSE
;
10488 * Set the info in "*su".
10490 vim_memset(su
, 0, sizeof(suginfo_T
));
10491 ga_init2(&su
->su_ga
, (int)sizeof(suggest_T
), 10);
10492 ga_init2(&su
->su_sga
, (int)sizeof(suggest_T
), 10);
10493 if (*badptr
== NUL
)
10495 hash_init(&su
->su_banned
);
10497 su
->su_badptr
= badptr
;
10499 su
->su_badlen
= badlen
;
10501 su
->su_badlen
= spell_check(curwin
, su
->su_badptr
, &attr
, NULL
, FALSE
);
10502 su
->su_maxcount
= maxcount
;
10503 su
->su_maxscore
= SCORE_MAXINIT
;
10505 if (su
->su_badlen
>= MAXWLEN
)
10506 su
->su_badlen
= MAXWLEN
- 1; /* just in case */
10507 vim_strncpy(su
->su_badword
, su
->su_badptr
, su
->su_badlen
);
10508 (void)spell_casefold(su
->su_badptr
, su
->su_badlen
,
10509 su
->su_fbadword
, MAXWLEN
);
10510 /* get caps flags for bad word */
10511 su
->su_badflags
= badword_captype(su
->su_badptr
,
10512 su
->su_badptr
+ su
->su_badlen
);
10514 su
->su_badflags
|= WF_ONECAP
;
10516 /* Find the default language for sound folding. We simply use the first
10517 * one in 'spelllang' that supports sound folding. That's good for when
10518 * using multiple files for one language, it's not that bad when mixing
10519 * languages (e.g., "pl,en"). */
10520 for (i
= 0; i
< curbuf
->b_langp
.ga_len
; ++i
)
10522 lp
= LANGP_ENTRY(curbuf
->b_langp
, i
);
10523 if (lp
->lp_sallang
!= NULL
)
10525 su
->su_sallang
= lp
->lp_sallang
;
10530 /* Soundfold the bad word with the default sound folding, so that we don't
10531 * have to do this many times. */
10532 if (su
->su_sallang
!= NULL
)
10533 spell_soundfold(su
->su_sallang
, su
->su_fbadword
, TRUE
,
10534 su
->su_sal_badword
);
10536 /* If the word is not capitalised and spell_check() doesn't consider the
10537 * word to be bad then it might need to be capitalised. Add a suggestion
10539 c
= PTR2CHAR(su
->su_badptr
);
10540 if (!SPELL_ISUPPER(c
) && attr
== HLF_COUNT
)
10542 make_case_word(su
->su_badword
, buf
, WF_ONECAP
);
10543 add_suggestion(su
, &su
->su_ga
, buf
, su
->su_badlen
, SCORE_ICASE
,
10544 0, TRUE
, su
->su_sallang
, FALSE
);
10547 /* Ban the bad word itself. It may appear in another region. */
10549 add_banned(su
, su
->su_badword
);
10551 /* Make a copy of 'spellsuggest', because the expression may change it. */
10552 sps_copy
= vim_strsave(p_sps
);
10553 if (sps_copy
== NULL
)
10556 /* Loop over the items in 'spellsuggest'. */
10557 for (p
= sps_copy
; *p
!= NUL
; )
10559 copy_option_part(&p
, buf
, MAXPATHL
, ",");
10561 if (STRNCMP(buf
, "expr:", 5) == 0)
10564 /* Evaluate an expression. Skip this when called recursively,
10565 * when using spellsuggest() in the expression. */
10569 spell_suggest_expr(su
, buf
+ 5);
10574 else if (STRNCMP(buf
, "file:", 5) == 0)
10575 /* Use list of suggestions in a file. */
10576 spell_suggest_file(su
, buf
+ 5);
10579 /* Use internal method. */
10580 spell_suggest_intern(su
, interactive
);
10581 if (sps_flags
& SPS_DOUBLE
)
10586 vim_free(sps_copy
);
10589 /* Combine the two list of suggestions. This must be done last,
10590 * because sorting changes the order again. */
10596 * Find suggestions by evaluating expression "expr".
10599 spell_suggest_expr(su
, expr
)
10608 /* The work is split up in a few parts to avoid having to export
10610 * First evaluate the expression and get the resulting list. */
10611 list
= eval_spell_expr(su
->su_badword
, expr
);
10614 /* Loop over the items in the list. */
10615 for (li
= list
->lv_first
; li
!= NULL
; li
= li
->li_next
)
10616 if (li
->li_tv
.v_type
== VAR_LIST
)
10618 /* Get the word and the score from the items. */
10619 score
= get_spellword(li
->li_tv
.vval
.v_list
, &p
);
10620 if (score
>= 0 && score
<= su
->su_maxscore
)
10621 add_suggestion(su
, &su
->su_ga
, p
, su
->su_badlen
,
10622 score
, 0, TRUE
, su
->su_sallang
, FALSE
);
10627 /* Remove bogus suggestions, sort and truncate at "maxcount". */
10628 check_suggestions(su
, &su
->su_ga
);
10629 (void)cleanup_suggestions(&su
->su_ga
, su
->su_maxscore
, su
->su_maxcount
);
10634 * Find suggestions in file "fname". Used for "file:" in 'spellsuggest'.
10637 spell_suggest_file(su
, fname
)
10642 char_u line
[MAXWLEN
* 2];
10645 char_u cword
[MAXWLEN
];
10647 /* Open the file. */
10648 fd
= mch_fopen((char *)fname
, "r");
10651 EMSG2(_(e_notopen
), fname
);
10655 /* Read it line by line. */
10656 while (!vim_fgets(line
, MAXWLEN
* 2, fd
) && !got_int
)
10660 p
= vim_strchr(line
, '/');
10662 continue; /* No Tab found, just skip the line. */
10664 if (STRICMP(su
->su_badword
, line
) == 0)
10666 /* Match! Isolate the good word, until CR or NL. */
10667 for (len
= 0; p
[len
] >= ' '; ++len
)
10671 /* If the suggestion doesn't have specific case duplicate the case
10672 * of the bad word. */
10673 if (captype(p
, NULL
) == 0)
10675 make_case_word(p
, cword
, su
->su_badflags
);
10679 add_suggestion(su
, &su
->su_ga
, p
, su
->su_badlen
,
10680 SCORE_FILE
, 0, TRUE
, su
->su_sallang
, FALSE
);
10686 /* Remove bogus suggestions, sort and truncate at "maxcount". */
10687 check_suggestions(su
, &su
->su_ga
);
10688 (void)cleanup_suggestions(&su
->su_ga
, su
->su_maxscore
, su
->su_maxcount
);
10692 * Find suggestions for the internal method indicated by "sps_flags".
10695 spell_suggest_intern(su
, interactive
)
10700 * Load the .sug file(s) that are available and not done yet.
10702 suggest_load_files();
10705 * 1. Try special cases, such as repeating a word: "the the" -> "the".
10707 * Set a maximum score to limit the combination of operations that is
10710 suggest_try_special(su
);
10713 * 2. Try inserting/deleting/swapping/changing a letter, use REP entries
10714 * from the .aff file and inserting a space (split the word).
10716 suggest_try_change(su
);
10718 /* For the resulting top-scorers compute the sound-a-like score. */
10719 if (sps_flags
& SPS_DOUBLE
)
10720 score_comp_sal(su
);
10723 * 3. Try finding sound-a-like words.
10725 if ((sps_flags
& SPS_FAST
) == 0)
10727 if (sps_flags
& SPS_BEST
)
10728 /* Adjust the word score for the suggestions found so far for how
10729 * they sounds like. */
10730 rescore_suggestions(su
);
10733 * While going throught the soundfold tree "su_maxscore" is the score
10734 * for the soundfold word, limits the changes that are being tried,
10735 * and "su_sfmaxscore" the rescored score, which is set by
10736 * cleanup_suggestions().
10737 * First find words with a small edit distance, because this is much
10738 * faster and often already finds the top-N suggestions. If we didn't
10739 * find many suggestions try again with a higher edit distance.
10740 * "sl_sounddone" is used to avoid doing the same word twice.
10742 suggest_try_soundalike_prep();
10743 su
->su_maxscore
= SCORE_SFMAX1
;
10744 su
->su_sfmaxscore
= SCORE_MAXINIT
* 3;
10745 suggest_try_soundalike(su
);
10746 if (su
->su_ga
.ga_len
< SUG_CLEAN_COUNT(su
))
10748 /* We didn't find enough matches, try again, allowing more
10749 * changes to the soundfold word. */
10750 su
->su_maxscore
= SCORE_SFMAX2
;
10751 suggest_try_soundalike(su
);
10752 if (su
->su_ga
.ga_len
< SUG_CLEAN_COUNT(su
))
10754 /* Still didn't find enough matches, try again, allowing even
10755 * more changes to the soundfold word. */
10756 su
->su_maxscore
= SCORE_SFMAX3
;
10757 suggest_try_soundalike(su
);
10760 su
->su_maxscore
= su
->su_sfmaxscore
;
10761 suggest_try_soundalike_finish();
10764 /* When CTRL-C was hit while searching do show the results. Only clear
10765 * got_int when using a command, not for spellsuggest(). */
10767 if (interactive
&& got_int
)
10773 if ((sps_flags
& SPS_DOUBLE
) == 0 && su
->su_ga
.ga_len
!= 0)
10775 if (sps_flags
& SPS_BEST
)
10776 /* Adjust the word score for how it sounds like. */
10777 rescore_suggestions(su
);
10779 /* Remove bogus suggestions, sort and truncate at "maxcount". */
10780 check_suggestions(su
, &su
->su_ga
);
10781 (void)cleanup_suggestions(&su
->su_ga
, su
->su_maxscore
, su
->su_maxcount
);
10786 * Load the .sug files for languages that have one and weren't loaded yet.
10789 suggest_load_files()
10796 char_u buf
[MAXWLEN
];
10804 /* Do this for all languages that support sound folding. */
10805 for (lpi
= 0; lpi
< curbuf
->b_langp
.ga_len
; ++lpi
)
10807 lp
= LANGP_ENTRY(curbuf
->b_langp
, lpi
);
10808 slang
= lp
->lp_slang
;
10809 if (slang
->sl_sugtime
!= 0 && !slang
->sl_sugloaded
)
10811 /* Change ".spl" to ".sug" and open the file. When the file isn't
10812 * found silently skip it. Do set "sl_sugloaded" so that we
10813 * don't try again and again. */
10814 slang
->sl_sugloaded
= TRUE
;
10816 dotp
= vim_strrchr(slang
->sl_fname
, '.');
10817 if (dotp
== NULL
|| fnamecmp(dotp
, ".spl") != 0)
10819 STRCPY(dotp
, ".sug");
10820 fd
= mch_fopen((char *)slang
->sl_fname
, "r");
10825 * <SUGHEADER>: <fileID> <versionnr> <timestamp>
10827 for (i
= 0; i
< VIMSUGMAGICL
; ++i
)
10828 buf
[i
] = getc(fd
); /* <fileID> */
10829 if (STRNCMP(buf
, VIMSUGMAGIC
, VIMSUGMAGICL
) != 0)
10831 EMSG2(_("E778: This does not look like a .sug file: %s"),
10835 c
= getc(fd
); /* <versionnr> */
10836 if (c
< VIMSUGVERSION
)
10838 EMSG2(_("E779: Old .sug file, needs to be updated: %s"),
10842 else if (c
> VIMSUGVERSION
)
10844 EMSG2(_("E780: .sug file is for newer version of Vim: %s"),
10849 /* Check the timestamp, it must be exactly the same as the one in
10850 * the .spl file. Otherwise the word numbers won't match. */
10851 timestamp
= get8c(fd
); /* <timestamp> */
10852 if (timestamp
!= slang
->sl_sugtime
)
10854 EMSG2(_("E781: .sug file doesn't match .spl file: %s"),
10860 * <SUGWORDTREE>: <wordtree>
10861 * Read the trie with the soundfolded words.
10863 if (spell_read_tree(fd
, &slang
->sl_sbyts
, &slang
->sl_sidxs
,
10867 EMSG2(_("E782: error while reading .sug file: %s"),
10869 slang_clear_sug(slang
);
10874 * <SUGTABLE>: <sugwcount> <sugline> ...
10876 * Read the table with word numbers. We use a file buffer for
10877 * this, because it's so much like a file with lines. Makes it
10878 * possible to swap the info and save on memory use.
10880 slang
->sl_sugbuf
= open_spellbuf();
10881 if (slang
->sl_sugbuf
== NULL
)
10884 wcount
= get4c(fd
);
10888 /* Read all the wordnr lists into the buffer, one NUL terminated
10889 * list per line. */
10890 ga_init2(&ga
, 1, 100);
10891 for (wordnr
= 0; wordnr
< wcount
; ++wordnr
)
10896 c
= getc(fd
); /* <sugline> */
10897 if (c
< 0 || ga_grow(&ga
, 1) == FAIL
)
10899 ((char_u
*)ga
.ga_data
)[ga
.ga_len
++] = c
;
10903 if (ml_append_buf(slang
->sl_sugbuf
, (linenr_T
)wordnr
,
10904 ga
.ga_data
, ga
.ga_len
, TRUE
) == FAIL
)
10910 * Need to put word counts in the word tries, so that we can find
10911 * a word by its number.
10913 tree_count_words(slang
->sl_fbyts
, slang
->sl_fidxs
);
10914 tree_count_words(slang
->sl_sbyts
, slang
->sl_sidxs
);
10919 STRCPY(dotp
, ".spl");
10926 * Fill in the wordcount fields for a trie.
10927 * Returns the total number of words.
10930 tree_count_words(byts
, idxs
)
10935 idx_T arridx
[MAXWLEN
];
10939 int wordcount
[MAXWLEN
];
10945 while (depth
>= 0 && !got_int
)
10947 if (curi
[depth
] > byts
[arridx
[depth
]])
10949 /* Done all bytes at this node, go up one level. */
10950 idxs
[arridx
[depth
]] = wordcount
[depth
];
10952 wordcount
[depth
- 1] += wordcount
[depth
];
10959 /* Do one more byte at this node. */
10960 n
= arridx
[depth
] + curi
[depth
];
10966 /* End of word, count it. */
10967 ++wordcount
[depth
];
10969 /* Skip over any other NUL bytes (same word with different
10971 while (byts
[n
+ 1] == 0)
10979 /* Normal char, go one level deeper to count the words. */
10981 arridx
[depth
] = idxs
[n
];
10983 wordcount
[depth
] = 0;
10990 * Free the info put in "*su" by spell_find_suggest().
10993 spell_find_cleanup(su
)
10998 /* Free the suggestions. */
10999 for (i
= 0; i
< su
->su_ga
.ga_len
; ++i
)
11000 vim_free(SUG(su
->su_ga
, i
).st_word
);
11001 ga_clear(&su
->su_ga
);
11002 for (i
= 0; i
< su
->su_sga
.ga_len
; ++i
)
11003 vim_free(SUG(su
->su_sga
, i
).st_word
);
11004 ga_clear(&su
->su_sga
);
11006 /* Free the banned words. */
11007 hash_clear_all(&su
->su_banned
, 0);
11011 * Make a copy of "word", with the first letter upper or lower cased, to
11012 * "wcopy[MAXWLEN]". "word" must not be empty.
11013 * The result is NUL terminated.
11016 onecap_copy(word
, wcopy
, upper
)
11019 int upper
; /* TRUE: first letter made upper case */
11028 c
= mb_cptr2char_adv(&p
);
11033 c
= SPELL_TOUPPER(c
);
11035 c
= SPELL_TOFOLD(c
);
11038 l
= mb_char2bytes(c
, wcopy
);
11045 vim_strncpy(wcopy
+ l
, p
, MAXWLEN
- l
- 1);
11049 * Make a copy of "word" with all the letters upper cased into
11050 * "wcopy[MAXWLEN]". The result is NUL terminated.
11053 allcap_copy(word
, wcopy
)
11062 for (s
= word
; *s
!= NUL
; )
11066 c
= mb_cptr2char_adv(&s
);
11072 /* We only change ß to SS when we are certain latin1 is used. It
11073 * would cause weird errors in other 8-bit encodings. */
11074 if (enc_latin1like
&& c
== 0xdf)
11077 if (d
- wcopy
>= MAXWLEN
- 1)
11083 c
= SPELL_TOUPPER(c
);
11088 if (d
- wcopy
>= MAXWLEN
- MB_MAXBYTES
)
11090 d
+= mb_char2bytes(c
, d
);
11095 if (d
- wcopy
>= MAXWLEN
- 1)
11104 * Try finding suggestions by recognizing specific situations.
11107 suggest_try_special(su
)
11113 char_u word
[MAXWLEN
];
11116 * Recognize a word that is repeated: "the the".
11118 p
= skiptowhite(su
->su_fbadword
);
11119 len
= p
- su
->su_fbadword
;
11121 if (STRLEN(p
) == len
&& STRNCMP(su
->su_fbadword
, p
, len
) == 0)
11123 /* Include badflags: if the badword is onecap or allcap
11124 * use that for the goodword too: "The the" -> "The". */
11125 c
= su
->su_fbadword
[len
];
11126 su
->su_fbadword
[len
] = NUL
;
11127 make_case_word(su
->su_fbadword
, word
, su
->su_badflags
);
11128 su
->su_fbadword
[len
] = c
;
11130 /* Give a soundalike score of 0, compute the score as if deleting one
11132 add_suggestion(su
, &su
->su_ga
, word
, su
->su_badlen
,
11133 RESCORE(SCORE_REP
, 0), 0, TRUE
, su
->su_sallang
, FALSE
);
11138 * Try finding suggestions by adding/removing/swapping letters.
11141 suggest_try_change(su
)
11144 char_u fword
[MAXWLEN
]; /* copy of the bad word, case-folded */
11150 /* We make a copy of the case-folded bad word, so that we can modify it
11151 * to find matches (esp. REP items). Append some more text, changing
11152 * chars after the bad word may help. */
11153 STRCPY(fword
, su
->su_fbadword
);
11154 n
= (int)STRLEN(fword
);
11155 p
= su
->su_badptr
+ su
->su_badlen
;
11156 (void)spell_casefold(p
, (int)STRLEN(p
), fword
+ n
, MAXWLEN
- n
);
11158 for (lpi
= 0; lpi
< curbuf
->b_langp
.ga_len
; ++lpi
)
11160 lp
= LANGP_ENTRY(curbuf
->b_langp
, lpi
);
11162 /* If reloading a spell file fails it's still in the list but
11163 * everything has been cleared. */
11164 if (lp
->lp_slang
->sl_fbyts
== NULL
)
11167 /* Try it for this language. Will add possible suggestions. */
11168 suggest_trie_walk(su
, lp
, fword
, FALSE
);
11172 /* Check the maximum score, if we go over it we won't try this change. */
11173 #define TRY_DEEPER(su, stack, depth, add) \
11174 (stack[depth].ts_score + (add) < su->su_maxscore)
11177 * Try finding suggestions by adding/removing/swapping letters.
11179 * This uses a state machine. At each node in the tree we try various
11180 * operations. When trying if an operation works "depth" is increased and the
11181 * stack[] is used to store info. This allows combinations, thus insert one
11182 * character, replace one and delete another. The number of changes is
11183 * limited by su->su_maxscore.
11185 * After implementing this I noticed an article by Kemal Oflazer that
11186 * describes something similar: "Error-tolerant Finite State Recognition with
11187 * Applications to Morphological Analysis and Spelling Correction" (1996).
11188 * The implementation in the article is simplified and requires a stack of
11189 * unknown depth. The implementation here only needs a stack depth equal to
11190 * the length of the word.
11192 * This is also used for the sound-folded word, "soundfold" is TRUE then.
11193 * The mechanism is the same, but we find a match with a sound-folded word
11194 * that comes from one or more original words. Each of these words may be
11195 * added, this is done by add_sound_suggest().
11197 * the prefix tree or the keep-case tree
11199 * anything to do with upper and lower case
11200 * anything to do with word or non-word characters ("spell_iswordp()")
11202 * word flags (rare, region, compounding)
11203 * word splitting for now
11204 * "similar_chars()"
11205 * use "slang->sl_repsal" instead of "lp->lp_replang->sl_rep"
11208 suggest_trie_walk(su
, lp
, fword
, soundfold
)
11214 char_u tword
[MAXWLEN
]; /* good word collected so far */
11215 trystate_T stack
[MAXWLEN
];
11216 char_u preword
[MAXWLEN
* 3]; /* word found with proper case;
11217 * concatanation of prefix compound
11218 * words and split word. NUL terminated
11219 * when going deeper but not when coming
11221 char_u compflags
[MAXWLEN
]; /* compound flags, one for each word */
11225 char_u
*byts
, *fbyts
, *pbyts
;
11226 idx_T
*idxs
, *fidxs
, *pidxs
;
11237 int repextra
= 0; /* extra bytes in fword[] from REP item */
11238 slang_T
*slang
= lp
->lp_slang
;
11241 #ifdef DEBUG_TRIEWALK
11242 /* Stores the name of the change made at each level. */
11243 char_u changename
[MAXWLEN
][80];
11245 int breakcheckcount
= 1000;
11249 * Go through the whole case-fold tree, try changes at each node.
11250 * "tword[]" contains the word collected from nodes in the tree.
11251 * "fword[]" the word we are trying to match with (initially the bad
11256 vim_memset(sp
, 0, sizeof(trystate_T
));
11261 /* Going through the soundfold tree. */
11262 byts
= fbyts
= slang
->sl_sbyts
;
11263 idxs
= fidxs
= slang
->sl_sidxs
;
11266 sp
->ts_prefixdepth
= PFD_NOPREFIX
;
11267 sp
->ts_state
= STATE_START
;
11272 * When there are postponed prefixes we need to use these first. At
11273 * the end of the prefix we continue in the case-fold tree.
11275 fbyts
= slang
->sl_fbyts
;
11276 fidxs
= slang
->sl_fidxs
;
11277 pbyts
= slang
->sl_pbyts
;
11278 pidxs
= slang
->sl_pidxs
;
11283 sp
->ts_prefixdepth
= PFD_PREFIXTREE
;
11284 sp
->ts_state
= STATE_NOPREFIX
; /* try without prefix first */
11290 sp
->ts_prefixdepth
= PFD_NOPREFIX
;
11291 sp
->ts_state
= STATE_START
;
11296 * Loop to find all suggestions. At each round we either:
11297 * - For the current state try one operation, advance "ts_curi",
11298 * increase "depth".
11299 * - When a state is done go to the next, set "ts_state".
11300 * - When all states are tried decrease "depth".
11302 while (depth
>= 0 && !got_int
)
11304 sp
= &stack
[depth
];
11305 switch (sp
->ts_state
)
11308 case STATE_NOPREFIX
:
11310 * Start of node: Deal with NUL bytes, which means
11311 * tword[] may end here.
11313 arridx
= sp
->ts_arridx
; /* current node in the tree */
11314 len
= byts
[arridx
]; /* bytes in this node */
11315 arridx
+= sp
->ts_curi
; /* index of current byte */
11317 if (sp
->ts_prefixdepth
== PFD_PREFIXTREE
)
11319 /* Skip over the NUL bytes, we use them later. */
11320 for (n
= 0; n
< len
&& byts
[arridx
+ n
] == 0; ++n
)
11324 /* Always past NUL bytes now. */
11325 n
= (int)sp
->ts_state
;
11326 sp
->ts_state
= STATE_ENDNUL
;
11327 sp
->ts_save_badflags
= su
->su_badflags
;
11329 /* At end of a prefix or at start of prefixtree: check for
11330 * following word. */
11331 if (byts
[arridx
] == 0 || n
== (int)STATE_NOPREFIX
)
11333 /* Set su->su_badflags to the caps type at this position.
11334 * Use the caps type until here for the prefix itself. */
11337 n
= nofold_len(fword
, sp
->ts_fidx
, su
->su_badptr
);
11341 flags
= badword_captype(su
->su_badptr
, su
->su_badptr
+ n
);
11342 su
->su_badflags
= badword_captype(su
->su_badptr
+ n
,
11343 su
->su_badptr
+ su
->su_badlen
);
11344 #ifdef DEBUG_TRIEWALK
11345 sprintf(changename
[depth
], "prefix");
11347 go_deeper(stack
, depth
, 0);
11349 sp
= &stack
[depth
];
11350 sp
->ts_prefixdepth
= depth
- 1;
11355 /* Move the prefix to preword[] with the right case
11356 * and make find_keepcap_word() works. */
11357 tword
[sp
->ts_twordlen
] = NUL
;
11358 make_case_word(tword
+ sp
->ts_splitoff
,
11359 preword
+ sp
->ts_prewordlen
, flags
);
11360 sp
->ts_prewordlen
= (char_u
)STRLEN(preword
);
11361 sp
->ts_splitoff
= sp
->ts_twordlen
;
11366 if (sp
->ts_curi
> len
|| byts
[arridx
] != 0)
11368 /* Past bytes in node and/or past NUL bytes. */
11369 sp
->ts_state
= STATE_ENDNUL
;
11370 sp
->ts_save_badflags
= su
->su_badflags
;
11375 * End of word in tree.
11377 ++sp
->ts_curi
; /* eat one NUL byte */
11379 flags
= (int)idxs
[arridx
];
11381 /* Skip words with the NOSUGGEST flag. */
11382 if (flags
& WF_NOSUGGEST
)
11385 fword_ends
= (fword
[sp
->ts_fidx
] == NUL
11387 ? vim_iswhite(fword
[sp
->ts_fidx
])
11388 : !spell_iswordp(fword
+ sp
->ts_fidx
, curbuf
)));
11389 tword
[sp
->ts_twordlen
] = NUL
;
11391 if (sp
->ts_prefixdepth
<= PFD_NOTSPECIAL
11392 && (sp
->ts_flags
& TSF_PREFIXOK
) == 0)
11394 /* There was a prefix before the word. Check that the prefix
11395 * can be used with this word. */
11396 /* Count the length of the NULs in the prefix. If there are
11397 * none this must be the first try without a prefix. */
11398 n
= stack
[sp
->ts_prefixdepth
].ts_arridx
;
11400 for (c
= 0; c
< len
&& pbyts
[n
+ c
] == 0; ++c
)
11404 c
= valid_word_prefix(c
, n
, flags
,
11405 tword
+ sp
->ts_splitoff
, slang
, FALSE
);
11409 /* Use the WF_RARE flag for a rare prefix. */
11410 if (c
& WF_RAREPFX
)
11413 /* Tricky: when checking for both prefix and compounding
11414 * we run into the prefix flag first.
11415 * Remember that it's OK, so that we accept the prefix
11416 * when arriving at a compound flag. */
11417 sp
->ts_flags
|= TSF_PREFIXOK
;
11421 /* Check NEEDCOMPOUND: can't use word without compounding. Do try
11422 * appending another compound word below. */
11423 if (sp
->ts_complen
== sp
->ts_compsplit
&& fword_ends
11424 && (flags
& WF_NEEDCOMP
))
11425 goodword_ends
= FALSE
;
11427 goodword_ends
= TRUE
;
11430 compound_ok
= TRUE
;
11431 if (sp
->ts_complen
> sp
->ts_compsplit
)
11433 if (slang
->sl_nobreak
)
11435 /* There was a word before this word. When there was no
11436 * change in this word (it was correct) add the first word
11437 * as a suggestion. If this word was corrected too, we
11438 * need to check if a correct word follows. */
11439 if (sp
->ts_fidx
- sp
->ts_splitfidx
11440 == sp
->ts_twordlen
- sp
->ts_splitoff
11441 && STRNCMP(fword
+ sp
->ts_splitfidx
,
11442 tword
+ sp
->ts_splitoff
,
11443 sp
->ts_fidx
- sp
->ts_splitfidx
) == 0)
11445 preword
[sp
->ts_prewordlen
] = NUL
;
11446 newscore
= score_wordcount_adj(slang
, sp
->ts_score
,
11447 preword
+ sp
->ts_prewordlen
,
11448 sp
->ts_prewordlen
> 0);
11449 /* Add the suggestion if the score isn't too bad. */
11450 if (newscore
<= su
->su_maxscore
)
11451 add_suggestion(su
, &su
->su_ga
, preword
,
11452 sp
->ts_splitfidx
- repextra
,
11453 newscore
, 0, FALSE
,
11454 lp
->lp_sallang
, FALSE
);
11460 /* There was a compound word before this word. If this
11461 * word does not support compounding then give up
11462 * (splitting is tried for the word without compound
11464 if (((unsigned)flags
>> 24) == 0
11465 || sp
->ts_twordlen
- sp
->ts_splitoff
11466 < slang
->sl_compminlen
)
11469 /* For multi-byte chars check character length against
11472 && slang
->sl_compminlen
> 0
11473 && mb_charlen(tword
+ sp
->ts_splitoff
)
11474 < slang
->sl_compminlen
)
11478 compflags
[sp
->ts_complen
] = ((unsigned)flags
>> 24);
11479 compflags
[sp
->ts_complen
+ 1] = NUL
;
11480 vim_strncpy(preword
+ sp
->ts_prewordlen
,
11481 tword
+ sp
->ts_splitoff
,
11482 sp
->ts_twordlen
- sp
->ts_splitoff
);
11484 while (*skiptowhite(p
) != NUL
)
11485 p
= skipwhite(skiptowhite(p
));
11486 if (fword_ends
&& !can_compound(slang
, p
,
11487 compflags
+ sp
->ts_compsplit
))
11488 /* Compound is not allowed. But it may still be
11489 * possible if we add another (short) word. */
11490 compound_ok
= FALSE
;
11492 /* Get pointer to last char of previous word. */
11493 p
= preword
+ sp
->ts_prewordlen
;
11494 mb_ptr_back(preword
, p
);
11499 * Form the word with proper case in preword.
11500 * If there is a word from a previous split, append.
11501 * For the soundfold tree don't change the case, simply append.
11504 STRCPY(preword
+ sp
->ts_prewordlen
, tword
+ sp
->ts_splitoff
);
11505 else if (flags
& WF_KEEPCAP
)
11506 /* Must find the word in the keep-case tree. */
11507 find_keepcap_word(slang
, tword
+ sp
->ts_splitoff
,
11508 preword
+ sp
->ts_prewordlen
);
11511 /* Include badflags: If the badword is onecap or allcap
11512 * use that for the goodword too. But if the badword is
11513 * allcap and it's only one char long use onecap. */
11514 c
= su
->su_badflags
;
11515 if ((c
& WF_ALLCAP
)
11517 && su
->su_badlen
== (*mb_ptr2len
)(su
->su_badptr
)
11519 && su
->su_badlen
== 1
11525 /* When appending a compound word after a word character don't
11527 if (p
!= NULL
&& spell_iswordp_nmw(p
))
11529 make_case_word(tword
+ sp
->ts_splitoff
,
11530 preword
+ sp
->ts_prewordlen
, c
);
11535 /* Don't use a banned word. It may appear again as a good
11536 * word, thus remember it. */
11537 if (flags
& WF_BANNED
)
11539 add_banned(su
, preword
+ sp
->ts_prewordlen
);
11542 if ((sp
->ts_complen
== sp
->ts_compsplit
11543 && WAS_BANNED(su
, preword
+ sp
->ts_prewordlen
))
11544 || WAS_BANNED(su
, preword
))
11546 if (slang
->sl_compprog
== NULL
)
11548 /* the word so far was banned but we may try compounding */
11549 goodword_ends
= FALSE
;
11554 if (!soundfold
) /* soundfold words don't have flags */
11556 if ((flags
& WF_REGION
)
11557 && (((unsigned)flags
>> 16) & lp
->lp_region
) == 0)
11558 newscore
+= SCORE_REGION
;
11559 if (flags
& WF_RARE
)
11560 newscore
+= SCORE_RARE
;
11562 if (!spell_valid_case(su
->su_badflags
,
11563 captype(preword
+ sp
->ts_prewordlen
, NULL
)))
11564 newscore
+= SCORE_ICASE
;
11567 /* TODO: how about splitting in the soundfold tree? */
11570 && sp
->ts_fidx
>= sp
->ts_fidxtry
11573 /* The badword also ends: add suggestions. */
11574 #ifdef DEBUG_TRIEWALK
11575 if (soundfold
&& STRCMP(preword
, "smwrd") == 0)
11579 /* print the stack of changes that brought us here */
11580 smsg("------ %s -------", fword
);
11581 for (j
= 0; j
< depth
; ++j
)
11582 smsg("%s", changename
[j
]);
11587 /* For soundfolded words we need to find the original
11588 * words, the edit distance and then add them. */
11589 add_sound_suggest(su
, preword
, sp
->ts_score
, lp
);
11593 /* Give a penalty when changing non-word char to word
11594 * char, e.g., "thes," -> "these". */
11595 p
= fword
+ sp
->ts_fidx
;
11596 mb_ptr_back(fword
, p
);
11597 if (!spell_iswordp(p
, curbuf
))
11599 p
= preword
+ STRLEN(preword
);
11600 mb_ptr_back(preword
, p
);
11601 if (spell_iswordp(p
, curbuf
))
11602 newscore
+= SCORE_NONWORD
;
11605 /* Give a bonus to words seen before. */
11606 score
= score_wordcount_adj(slang
,
11607 sp
->ts_score
+ newscore
,
11608 preword
+ sp
->ts_prewordlen
,
11609 sp
->ts_prewordlen
> 0);
11611 /* Add the suggestion if the score isn't too bad. */
11612 if (score
<= su
->su_maxscore
)
11614 add_suggestion(su
, &su
->su_ga
, preword
,
11615 sp
->ts_fidx
- repextra
,
11616 score
, 0, FALSE
, lp
->lp_sallang
, FALSE
);
11618 if (su
->su_badflags
& WF_MIXCAP
)
11620 /* We really don't know if the word should be
11621 * upper or lower case, add both. */
11622 c
= captype(preword
, NULL
);
11623 if (c
== 0 || c
== WF_ALLCAP
)
11625 make_case_word(tword
+ sp
->ts_splitoff
,
11626 preword
+ sp
->ts_prewordlen
,
11627 c
== 0 ? WF_ALLCAP
: 0);
11629 add_suggestion(su
, &su
->su_ga
, preword
,
11630 sp
->ts_fidx
- repextra
,
11631 score
+ SCORE_ICASE
, 0, FALSE
,
11632 lp
->lp_sallang
, FALSE
);
11640 * Try word split and/or compounding.
11642 if ((sp
->ts_fidx
>= sp
->ts_fidxtry
|| fword_ends
)
11644 /* Don't split halfway a character. */
11645 && (!has_mbyte
|| sp
->ts_tcharlen
== 0)
11652 /* If past the end of the bad word don't try a split.
11653 * Otherwise try changing the next word. E.g., find
11654 * suggestions for "the the" where the second "the" is
11655 * different. It's done like a split.
11656 * TODO: word split for soundfold words */
11657 try_split
= (sp
->ts_fidx
- repextra
< su
->su_badlen
)
11660 /* Get here in several situations:
11661 * 1. The word in the tree ends:
11662 * If the word allows compounding try that. Otherwise try
11663 * a split by inserting a space. For both check that a
11664 * valid words starts at fword[sp->ts_fidx].
11665 * For NOBREAK do like compounding to be able to check if
11666 * the next word is valid.
11667 * 2. The badword does end, but it was due to a change (e.g.,
11668 * a swap). No need to split, but do check that the
11669 * following word is valid.
11670 * 3. The badword and the word in the tree end. It may still
11671 * be possible to compound another (short) word.
11673 try_compound
= FALSE
;
11675 && slang
->sl_compprog
!= NULL
11676 && ((unsigned)flags
>> 24) != 0
11677 && sp
->ts_twordlen
- sp
->ts_splitoff
11678 >= slang
->sl_compminlen
11681 || slang
->sl_compminlen
== 0
11682 || mb_charlen(tword
+ sp
->ts_splitoff
)
11683 >= slang
->sl_compminlen
)
11685 && (slang
->sl_compsylmax
< MAXWLEN
11686 || sp
->ts_complen
+ 1 - sp
->ts_compsplit
11687 < slang
->sl_compmax
)
11688 && (byte_in_str(sp
->ts_complen
== sp
->ts_compsplit
11689 ? slang
->sl_compstartflags
11690 : slang
->sl_compallflags
,
11691 ((unsigned)flags
>> 24))))
11693 try_compound
= TRUE
;
11694 compflags
[sp
->ts_complen
] = ((unsigned)flags
>> 24);
11695 compflags
[sp
->ts_complen
+ 1] = NUL
;
11698 /* For NOBREAK we never try splitting, it won't make any word
11700 if (slang
->sl_nobreak
)
11701 try_compound
= TRUE
;
11703 /* If we could add a compound word, and it's also possible to
11704 * split at this point, do the split first and set
11705 * TSF_DIDSPLIT to avoid doing it again. */
11706 else if (!fword_ends
11708 && (sp
->ts_flags
& TSF_DIDSPLIT
) == 0)
11710 try_compound
= FALSE
;
11711 sp
->ts_flags
|= TSF_DIDSPLIT
;
11712 --sp
->ts_curi
; /* do the same NUL again */
11713 compflags
[sp
->ts_complen
] = NUL
;
11716 sp
->ts_flags
&= ~TSF_DIDSPLIT
;
11718 if (try_split
|| try_compound
)
11720 if (!try_compound
&& (!fword_ends
|| !goodword_ends
))
11722 /* If we're going to split need to check that the
11723 * words so far are valid for compounding. If there
11724 * is only one word it must not have the NEEDCOMPOUND
11726 if (sp
->ts_complen
== sp
->ts_compsplit
11727 && (flags
& WF_NEEDCOMP
))
11730 while (*skiptowhite(p
) != NUL
)
11731 p
= skipwhite(skiptowhite(p
));
11732 if (sp
->ts_complen
> sp
->ts_compsplit
11733 && !can_compound(slang
, p
,
11734 compflags
+ sp
->ts_compsplit
))
11737 if (slang
->sl_nosplitsugs
)
11738 newscore
+= SCORE_SPLIT_NO
;
11740 newscore
+= SCORE_SPLIT
;
11742 /* Give a bonus to words seen before. */
11743 newscore
= score_wordcount_adj(slang
, newscore
,
11744 preword
+ sp
->ts_prewordlen
, TRUE
);
11747 if (TRY_DEEPER(su
, stack
, depth
, newscore
))
11749 go_deeper(stack
, depth
, newscore
);
11750 #ifdef DEBUG_TRIEWALK
11751 if (!try_compound
&& !fword_ends
)
11752 sprintf(changename
[depth
], "%.*s-%s: split",
11753 sp
->ts_twordlen
, tword
, fword
+ sp
->ts_fidx
);
11755 sprintf(changename
[depth
], "%.*s-%s: compound",
11756 sp
->ts_twordlen
, tword
, fword
+ sp
->ts_fidx
);
11758 /* Save things to be restored at STATE_SPLITUNDO. */
11759 sp
->ts_save_badflags
= su
->su_badflags
;
11760 sp
->ts_state
= STATE_SPLITUNDO
;
11763 sp
= &stack
[depth
];
11765 /* Append a space to preword when splitting. */
11766 if (!try_compound
&& !fword_ends
)
11767 STRCAT(preword
, " ");
11768 sp
->ts_prewordlen
= (char_u
)STRLEN(preword
);
11769 sp
->ts_splitoff
= sp
->ts_twordlen
;
11770 sp
->ts_splitfidx
= sp
->ts_fidx
;
11772 /* If the badword has a non-word character at this
11773 * position skip it. That means replacing the
11774 * non-word character with a space. Always skip a
11775 * character when the word ends. But only when the
11776 * good word can end. */
11777 if (((!try_compound
&& !spell_iswordp_nmw(fword
11780 && fword
[sp
->ts_fidx
] != NUL
11787 l
= MB_BYTE2LEN(fword
[sp
->ts_fidx
]);
11793 /* Copy the skipped character to preword. */
11794 mch_memmove(preword
+ sp
->ts_prewordlen
,
11795 fword
+ sp
->ts_fidx
, l
);
11796 sp
->ts_prewordlen
+= l
;
11797 preword
[sp
->ts_prewordlen
] = NUL
;
11800 sp
->ts_score
-= SCORE_SPLIT
- SCORE_SUBST
;
11804 /* When compounding include compound flag in
11805 * compflags[] (already set above). When splitting we
11806 * may start compounding over again. */
11810 sp
->ts_compsplit
= sp
->ts_complen
;
11811 sp
->ts_prefixdepth
= PFD_NOPREFIX
;
11813 /* set su->su_badflags to the caps type at this
11817 n
= nofold_len(fword
, sp
->ts_fidx
, su
->su_badptr
);
11821 su
->su_badflags
= badword_captype(su
->su_badptr
+ n
,
11822 su
->su_badptr
+ su
->su_badlen
);
11824 /* Restart at top of the tree. */
11827 /* If there are postponed prefixes, try these too. */
11832 sp
->ts_prefixdepth
= PFD_PREFIXTREE
;
11833 sp
->ts_state
= STATE_NOPREFIX
;
11840 case STATE_SPLITUNDO
:
11841 /* Undo the changes done for word split or compound word. */
11842 su
->su_badflags
= sp
->ts_save_badflags
;
11844 /* Continue looking for NUL bytes. */
11845 sp
->ts_state
= STATE_START
;
11847 /* In case we went into the prefix tree. */
11853 /* Past the NUL bytes in the node. */
11854 su
->su_badflags
= sp
->ts_save_badflags
;
11855 if (fword
[sp
->ts_fidx
] == NUL
11857 && sp
->ts_tcharlen
== 0
11861 /* The badword ends, can't use STATE_PLAIN. */
11862 sp
->ts_state
= STATE_DEL
;
11865 sp
->ts_state
= STATE_PLAIN
;
11870 * Go over all possible bytes at this node, add each to tword[]
11871 * and use child node. "ts_curi" is the index.
11873 arridx
= sp
->ts_arridx
;
11874 if (sp
->ts_curi
> byts
[arridx
])
11876 /* Done all bytes at this node, do next state. When still at
11877 * already changed bytes skip the other tricks. */
11878 if (sp
->ts_fidx
>= sp
->ts_fidxtry
)
11879 sp
->ts_state
= STATE_DEL
;
11881 sp
->ts_state
= STATE_FINAL
;
11885 arridx
+= sp
->ts_curi
++;
11888 /* Normal byte, go one level deeper. If it's not equal to the
11889 * byte in the bad word adjust the score. But don't even try
11890 * when the byte was already changed. And don't try when we
11891 * just deleted this byte, accepting it is always cheaper then
11892 * delete + substitute. */
11893 if (c
== fword
[sp
->ts_fidx
]
11895 || (sp
->ts_tcharlen
> 0 && sp
->ts_isdiff
!= DIFF_NONE
)
11900 newscore
= SCORE_SUBST
;
11902 || (sp
->ts_fidx
>= sp
->ts_fidxtry
11903 && ((sp
->ts_flags
& TSF_DIDDEL
) == 0
11904 || c
!= fword
[sp
->ts_delidx
])))
11905 && TRY_DEEPER(su
, stack
, depth
, newscore
))
11907 go_deeper(stack
, depth
, newscore
);
11908 #ifdef DEBUG_TRIEWALK
11910 sprintf(changename
[depth
], "%.*s-%s: subst %c to %c",
11911 sp
->ts_twordlen
, tword
, fword
+ sp
->ts_fidx
,
11912 fword
[sp
->ts_fidx
], c
);
11914 sprintf(changename
[depth
], "%.*s-%s: accept %c",
11915 sp
->ts_twordlen
, tword
, fword
+ sp
->ts_fidx
,
11916 fword
[sp
->ts_fidx
]);
11919 sp
= &stack
[depth
];
11921 tword
[sp
->ts_twordlen
++] = c
;
11922 sp
->ts_arridx
= idxs
[arridx
];
11924 if (newscore
== SCORE_SUBST
)
11925 sp
->ts_isdiff
= DIFF_YES
;
11928 /* Multi-byte characters are a bit complicated to
11929 * handle: They differ when any of the bytes differ
11930 * and then their length may also differ. */
11931 if (sp
->ts_tcharlen
== 0)
11934 sp
->ts_tcharidx
= 0;
11935 sp
->ts_tcharlen
= MB_BYTE2LEN(c
);
11936 sp
->ts_fcharstart
= sp
->ts_fidx
- 1;
11937 sp
->ts_isdiff
= (newscore
!= 0)
11938 ? DIFF_YES
: DIFF_NONE
;
11940 else if (sp
->ts_isdiff
== DIFF_INSERT
)
11941 /* When inserting trail bytes don't advance in the
11944 if (++sp
->ts_tcharidx
== sp
->ts_tcharlen
)
11946 /* Last byte of character. */
11947 if (sp
->ts_isdiff
== DIFF_YES
)
11949 /* Correct ts_fidx for the byte length of the
11950 * character (we didn't check that before). */
11951 sp
->ts_fidx
= sp
->ts_fcharstart
11953 fword
[sp
->ts_fcharstart
]);
11955 /* For changing a composing character adjust
11956 * the score from SCORE_SUBST to
11957 * SCORE_SUBCOMP. */
11959 && utf_iscomposing(
11962 - sp
->ts_tcharlen
))
11963 && utf_iscomposing(
11965 + sp
->ts_fcharstart
)))
11967 SCORE_SUBST
- SCORE_SUBCOMP
;
11969 /* For a similar character adjust score from
11970 * SCORE_SUBST to SCORE_SIMILAR. */
11971 else if (!soundfold
11972 && slang
->sl_has_map
11973 && similar_chars(slang
,
11976 - sp
->ts_tcharlen
),
11978 + sp
->ts_fcharstart
)))
11980 SCORE_SUBST
- SCORE_SIMILAR
;
11982 else if (sp
->ts_isdiff
== DIFF_INSERT
11983 && sp
->ts_twordlen
> sp
->ts_tcharlen
)
11985 p
= tword
+ sp
->ts_twordlen
- sp
->ts_tcharlen
;
11986 c
= mb_ptr2char(p
);
11987 if (enc_utf8
&& utf_iscomposing(c
))
11989 /* Inserting a composing char doesn't
11990 * count that much. */
11991 sp
->ts_score
-= SCORE_INS
- SCORE_INSCOMP
;
11995 /* If the previous character was the same,
11996 * thus doubling a character, give a bonus
11997 * to the score. Also for the soundfold
11998 * tree (might seem illogical but does
11999 * give better scores). */
12000 mb_ptr_back(tword
, p
);
12001 if (c
== mb_ptr2char(p
))
12002 sp
->ts_score
-= SCORE_INS
12007 /* Starting a new char, reset the length. */
12008 sp
->ts_tcharlen
= 0;
12014 /* If we found a similar char adjust the score.
12015 * We do this after calling go_deeper() because
12019 && slang
->sl_has_map
12020 && similar_chars(slang
,
12021 c
, fword
[sp
->ts_fidx
- 1]))
12022 sp
->ts_score
-= SCORE_SUBST
- SCORE_SIMILAR
;
12030 /* When past the first byte of a multi-byte char don't try
12031 * delete/insert/swap a character. */
12032 if (has_mbyte
&& sp
->ts_tcharlen
> 0)
12034 sp
->ts_state
= STATE_FINAL
;
12039 * Try skipping one character in the bad word (delete it).
12041 sp
->ts_state
= STATE_INS_PREP
;
12043 if (soundfold
&& sp
->ts_fidx
== 0 && fword
[sp
->ts_fidx
] == '*')
12044 /* Deleting a vowel at the start of a word counts less, see
12045 * soundalike_score(). */
12046 newscore
= 2 * SCORE_DEL
/ 3;
12048 newscore
= SCORE_DEL
;
12049 if (fword
[sp
->ts_fidx
] != NUL
12050 && TRY_DEEPER(su
, stack
, depth
, newscore
))
12052 go_deeper(stack
, depth
, newscore
);
12053 #ifdef DEBUG_TRIEWALK
12054 sprintf(changename
[depth
], "%.*s-%s: delete %c",
12055 sp
->ts_twordlen
, tword
, fword
+ sp
->ts_fidx
,
12056 fword
[sp
->ts_fidx
]);
12060 /* Remember what character we deleted, so that we can avoid
12061 * inserting it again. */
12062 stack
[depth
].ts_flags
|= TSF_DIDDEL
;
12063 stack
[depth
].ts_delidx
= sp
->ts_fidx
;
12065 /* Advance over the character in fword[]. Give a bonus to the
12066 * score if the same character is following "nn" -> "n". It's
12067 * a bit illogical for soundfold tree but it does give better
12072 c
= mb_ptr2char(fword
+ sp
->ts_fidx
);
12073 stack
[depth
].ts_fidx
+= MB_BYTE2LEN(fword
[sp
->ts_fidx
]);
12074 if (enc_utf8
&& utf_iscomposing(c
))
12075 stack
[depth
].ts_score
-= SCORE_DEL
- SCORE_DELCOMP
;
12076 else if (c
== mb_ptr2char(fword
+ stack
[depth
].ts_fidx
))
12077 stack
[depth
].ts_score
-= SCORE_DEL
- SCORE_DELDUP
;
12082 ++stack
[depth
].ts_fidx
;
12083 if (fword
[sp
->ts_fidx
] == fword
[sp
->ts_fidx
+ 1])
12084 stack
[depth
].ts_score
-= SCORE_DEL
- SCORE_DELDUP
;
12090 case STATE_INS_PREP
:
12091 if (sp
->ts_flags
& TSF_DIDDEL
)
12093 /* If we just deleted a byte then inserting won't make sense,
12094 * a substitute is always cheaper. */
12095 sp
->ts_state
= STATE_SWAP
;
12099 /* skip over NUL bytes */
12103 if (sp
->ts_curi
> byts
[n
])
12105 /* Only NUL bytes at this node, go to next state. */
12106 sp
->ts_state
= STATE_SWAP
;
12109 if (byts
[n
+ sp
->ts_curi
] != NUL
)
12111 /* Found a byte to insert. */
12112 sp
->ts_state
= STATE_INS
;
12122 /* Insert one byte. Repeat this for each possible byte at this
12125 if (sp
->ts_curi
> byts
[n
])
12127 /* Done all bytes at this node, go to next state. */
12128 sp
->ts_state
= STATE_SWAP
;
12132 /* Do one more byte at this node, but:
12133 * - Skip NUL bytes.
12134 * - Skip the byte if it's equal to the byte in the word,
12135 * accepting that byte is always better.
12137 n
+= sp
->ts_curi
++;
12139 if (soundfold
&& sp
->ts_twordlen
== 0 && c
== '*')
12140 /* Inserting a vowel at the start of a word counts less,
12141 * see soundalike_score(). */
12142 newscore
= 2 * SCORE_INS
/ 3;
12144 newscore
= SCORE_INS
;
12145 if (c
!= fword
[sp
->ts_fidx
]
12146 && TRY_DEEPER(su
, stack
, depth
, newscore
))
12148 go_deeper(stack
, depth
, newscore
);
12149 #ifdef DEBUG_TRIEWALK
12150 sprintf(changename
[depth
], "%.*s-%s: insert %c",
12151 sp
->ts_twordlen
, tword
, fword
+ sp
->ts_fidx
,
12155 sp
= &stack
[depth
];
12156 tword
[sp
->ts_twordlen
++] = c
;
12157 sp
->ts_arridx
= idxs
[n
];
12161 fl
= MB_BYTE2LEN(c
);
12164 /* There are following bytes for the same character.
12165 * We must find all bytes before trying
12166 * delete/insert/swap/etc. */
12167 sp
->ts_tcharlen
= fl
;
12168 sp
->ts_tcharidx
= 1;
12169 sp
->ts_isdiff
= DIFF_INSERT
;
12177 /* If the previous character was the same, thus doubling a
12178 * character, give a bonus to the score. Also for
12179 * soundfold words (illogical but does give a better
12181 if (sp
->ts_twordlen
>= 2
12182 && tword
[sp
->ts_twordlen
- 2] == c
)
12183 sp
->ts_score
-= SCORE_INS
- SCORE_INSDUP
;
12190 * Swap two bytes in the bad word: "12" -> "21".
12191 * We change "fword" here, it's changed back afterwards at
12194 p
= fword
+ sp
->ts_fidx
;
12198 /* End of word, can't swap or replace. */
12199 sp
->ts_state
= STATE_FINAL
;
12203 /* Don't swap if the first character is not a word character.
12204 * SWAP3 etc. also don't make sense then. */
12205 if (!soundfold
&& !spell_iswordp(p
, curbuf
))
12207 sp
->ts_state
= STATE_REP_INI
;
12214 n
= mb_cptr2len(p
);
12215 c
= mb_ptr2char(p
);
12218 else if (!soundfold
&& !spell_iswordp(p
+ n
, curbuf
))
12219 c2
= c
; /* don't swap non-word char */
12221 c2
= mb_ptr2char(p
+ n
);
12228 else if (!soundfold
&& !spell_iswordp(p
+ 1, curbuf
))
12229 c2
= c
; /* don't swap non-word char */
12234 /* When the second character is NUL we can't swap. */
12237 sp
->ts_state
= STATE_REP_INI
;
12241 /* When characters are identical, swap won't do anything.
12242 * Also get here if the second char is not a word character. */
12245 sp
->ts_state
= STATE_SWAP3
;
12248 if (c2
!= NUL
&& TRY_DEEPER(su
, stack
, depth
, SCORE_SWAP
))
12250 go_deeper(stack
, depth
, SCORE_SWAP
);
12251 #ifdef DEBUG_TRIEWALK
12252 sprintf(changename
[depth
], "%.*s-%s: swap %c and %c",
12253 sp
->ts_twordlen
, tword
, fword
+ sp
->ts_fidx
,
12256 sp
->ts_state
= STATE_UNSWAP
;
12261 fl
= mb_char2len(c2
);
12262 mch_memmove(p
, p
+ n
, fl
);
12263 mb_char2bytes(c
, p
+ fl
);
12264 stack
[depth
].ts_fidxtry
= sp
->ts_fidx
+ n
+ fl
;
12271 stack
[depth
].ts_fidxtry
= sp
->ts_fidx
+ 2;
12275 /* If this swap doesn't work then SWAP3 won't either. */
12276 sp
->ts_state
= STATE_REP_INI
;
12280 /* Undo the STATE_SWAP swap: "21" -> "12". */
12281 p
= fword
+ sp
->ts_fidx
;
12285 n
= MB_BYTE2LEN(*p
);
12286 c
= mb_ptr2char(p
+ n
);
12287 mch_memmove(p
+ MB_BYTE2LEN(p
[n
]), p
, n
);
12288 mb_char2bytes(c
, p
);
12300 /* Swap two bytes, skipping one: "123" -> "321". We change
12301 * "fword" here, it's changed back afterwards at STATE_UNSWAP3. */
12302 p
= fword
+ sp
->ts_fidx
;
12306 n
= mb_cptr2len(p
);
12307 c
= mb_ptr2char(p
);
12308 fl
= mb_cptr2len(p
+ n
);
12309 c2
= mb_ptr2char(p
+ n
);
12310 if (!soundfold
&& !spell_iswordp(p
+ n
+ fl
, curbuf
))
12311 c3
= c
; /* don't swap non-word char */
12313 c3
= mb_ptr2char(p
+ n
+ fl
);
12320 if (!soundfold
&& !spell_iswordp(p
+ 2, curbuf
))
12321 c3
= c
; /* don't swap non-word char */
12326 /* When characters are identical: "121" then SWAP3 result is
12327 * identical, ROT3L result is same as SWAP: "211", ROT3L result is
12328 * same as SWAP on next char: "112". Thus skip all swapping.
12329 * Also skip when c3 is NUL.
12330 * Also get here when the third character is not a word character.
12331 * Second character may any char: "a.b" -> "b.a" */
12332 if (c
== c3
|| c3
== NUL
)
12334 sp
->ts_state
= STATE_REP_INI
;
12337 if (TRY_DEEPER(su
, stack
, depth
, SCORE_SWAP3
))
12339 go_deeper(stack
, depth
, SCORE_SWAP3
);
12340 #ifdef DEBUG_TRIEWALK
12341 sprintf(changename
[depth
], "%.*s-%s: swap3 %c and %c",
12342 sp
->ts_twordlen
, tword
, fword
+ sp
->ts_fidx
,
12345 sp
->ts_state
= STATE_UNSWAP3
;
12350 tl
= mb_char2len(c3
);
12351 mch_memmove(p
, p
+ n
+ fl
, tl
);
12352 mb_char2bytes(c2
, p
+ tl
);
12353 mb_char2bytes(c
, p
+ fl
+ tl
);
12354 stack
[depth
].ts_fidxtry
= sp
->ts_fidx
+ n
+ fl
+ tl
;
12361 stack
[depth
].ts_fidxtry
= sp
->ts_fidx
+ 3;
12365 sp
->ts_state
= STATE_REP_INI
;
12368 case STATE_UNSWAP3
:
12369 /* Undo STATE_SWAP3: "321" -> "123" */
12370 p
= fword
+ sp
->ts_fidx
;
12374 n
= MB_BYTE2LEN(*p
);
12375 c2
= mb_ptr2char(p
+ n
);
12376 fl
= MB_BYTE2LEN(p
[n
]);
12377 c
= mb_ptr2char(p
+ n
+ fl
);
12378 tl
= MB_BYTE2LEN(p
[n
+ fl
]);
12379 mch_memmove(p
+ fl
+ tl
, p
, n
);
12380 mb_char2bytes(c
, p
);
12381 mb_char2bytes(c2
, p
+ tl
);
12393 if (!soundfold
&& !spell_iswordp(p
, curbuf
))
12395 /* Middle char is not a word char, skip the rotate. First and
12396 * third char were already checked at swap and swap3. */
12397 sp
->ts_state
= STATE_REP_INI
;
12401 /* Rotate three characters left: "123" -> "231". We change
12402 * "fword" here, it's changed back afterwards at STATE_UNROT3L. */
12403 if (TRY_DEEPER(su
, stack
, depth
, SCORE_SWAP3
))
12405 go_deeper(stack
, depth
, SCORE_SWAP3
);
12406 #ifdef DEBUG_TRIEWALK
12407 p
= fword
+ sp
->ts_fidx
;
12408 sprintf(changename
[depth
], "%.*s-%s: rotate left %c%c%c",
12409 sp
->ts_twordlen
, tword
, fword
+ sp
->ts_fidx
,
12412 sp
->ts_state
= STATE_UNROT3L
;
12414 p
= fword
+ sp
->ts_fidx
;
12418 n
= mb_cptr2len(p
);
12419 c
= mb_ptr2char(p
);
12420 fl
= mb_cptr2len(p
+ n
);
12421 fl
+= mb_cptr2len(p
+ n
+ fl
);
12422 mch_memmove(p
, p
+ n
, fl
);
12423 mb_char2bytes(c
, p
+ fl
);
12424 stack
[depth
].ts_fidxtry
= sp
->ts_fidx
+ n
+ fl
;
12433 stack
[depth
].ts_fidxtry
= sp
->ts_fidx
+ 3;
12437 sp
->ts_state
= STATE_REP_INI
;
12440 case STATE_UNROT3L
:
12441 /* Undo ROT3L: "231" -> "123" */
12442 p
= fword
+ sp
->ts_fidx
;
12446 n
= MB_BYTE2LEN(*p
);
12447 n
+= MB_BYTE2LEN(p
[n
]);
12448 c
= mb_ptr2char(p
+ n
);
12449 tl
= MB_BYTE2LEN(p
[n
]);
12450 mch_memmove(p
+ tl
, p
, n
);
12451 mb_char2bytes(c
, p
);
12462 /* Rotate three bytes right: "123" -> "312". We change "fword"
12463 * here, it's changed back afterwards at STATE_UNROT3R. */
12464 if (TRY_DEEPER(su
, stack
, depth
, SCORE_SWAP3
))
12466 go_deeper(stack
, depth
, SCORE_SWAP3
);
12467 #ifdef DEBUG_TRIEWALK
12468 p
= fword
+ sp
->ts_fidx
;
12469 sprintf(changename
[depth
], "%.*s-%s: rotate right %c%c%c",
12470 sp
->ts_twordlen
, tword
, fword
+ sp
->ts_fidx
,
12473 sp
->ts_state
= STATE_UNROT3R
;
12475 p
= fword
+ sp
->ts_fidx
;
12479 n
= mb_cptr2len(p
);
12480 n
+= mb_cptr2len(p
+ n
);
12481 c
= mb_ptr2char(p
+ n
);
12482 tl
= mb_cptr2len(p
+ n
);
12483 mch_memmove(p
+ tl
, p
, n
);
12484 mb_char2bytes(c
, p
);
12485 stack
[depth
].ts_fidxtry
= sp
->ts_fidx
+ n
+ tl
;
12494 stack
[depth
].ts_fidxtry
= sp
->ts_fidx
+ 3;
12498 sp
->ts_state
= STATE_REP_INI
;
12501 case STATE_UNROT3R
:
12502 /* Undo ROT3R: "312" -> "123" */
12503 p
= fword
+ sp
->ts_fidx
;
12507 c
= mb_ptr2char(p
);
12508 tl
= MB_BYTE2LEN(*p
);
12509 n
= MB_BYTE2LEN(p
[tl
]);
12510 n
+= MB_BYTE2LEN(p
[tl
+ n
]);
12511 mch_memmove(p
, p
+ tl
, n
);
12512 mb_char2bytes(c
, p
+ n
);
12524 case STATE_REP_INI
:
12525 /* Check if matching with REP items from the .aff file would work.
12527 * - there are no REP items and we are not in the soundfold trie
12528 * - the score is going to be too high anyway
12529 * - already applied a REP item or swapped here */
12530 if ((lp
->lp_replang
== NULL
&& !soundfold
)
12531 || sp
->ts_score
+ SCORE_REP
>= su
->su_maxscore
12532 || sp
->ts_fidx
< sp
->ts_fidxtry
)
12534 sp
->ts_state
= STATE_FINAL
;
12538 /* Use the first byte to quickly find the first entry that may
12539 * match. If the index is -1 there is none. */
12541 sp
->ts_curi
= slang
->sl_repsal_first
[fword
[sp
->ts_fidx
]];
12543 sp
->ts_curi
= lp
->lp_replang
->sl_rep_first
[fword
[sp
->ts_fidx
]];
12545 if (sp
->ts_curi
< 0)
12547 sp
->ts_state
= STATE_FINAL
;
12551 sp
->ts_state
= STATE_REP
;
12555 /* Try matching with REP items from the .aff file. For each match
12556 * replace the characters and check if the resulting word is
12558 p
= fword
+ sp
->ts_fidx
;
12561 gap
= &slang
->sl_repsal
;
12563 gap
= &lp
->lp_replang
->sl_rep
;
12564 while (sp
->ts_curi
< gap
->ga_len
)
12566 ftp
= (fromto_T
*)gap
->ga_data
+ sp
->ts_curi
++;
12567 if (*ftp
->ft_from
!= *p
)
12569 /* past possible matching entries */
12570 sp
->ts_curi
= gap
->ga_len
;
12573 if (STRNCMP(ftp
->ft_from
, p
, STRLEN(ftp
->ft_from
)) == 0
12574 && TRY_DEEPER(su
, stack
, depth
, SCORE_REP
))
12576 go_deeper(stack
, depth
, SCORE_REP
);
12577 #ifdef DEBUG_TRIEWALK
12578 sprintf(changename
[depth
], "%.*s-%s: replace %s with %s",
12579 sp
->ts_twordlen
, tword
, fword
+ sp
->ts_fidx
,
12580 ftp
->ft_from
, ftp
->ft_to
);
12582 /* Need to undo this afterwards. */
12583 sp
->ts_state
= STATE_REP_UNDO
;
12585 /* Change the "from" to the "to" string. */
12587 fl
= (int)STRLEN(ftp
->ft_from
);
12588 tl
= (int)STRLEN(ftp
->ft_to
);
12591 STRMOVE(p
+ tl
, p
+ fl
);
12592 repextra
+= tl
- fl
;
12594 mch_memmove(p
, ftp
->ft_to
, tl
);
12595 stack
[depth
].ts_fidxtry
= sp
->ts_fidx
+ tl
;
12597 stack
[depth
].ts_tcharlen
= 0;
12603 if (sp
->ts_curi
>= gap
->ga_len
&& sp
->ts_state
== STATE_REP
)
12604 /* No (more) matches. */
12605 sp
->ts_state
= STATE_FINAL
;
12609 case STATE_REP_UNDO
:
12610 /* Undo a REP replacement and continue with the next one. */
12612 gap
= &slang
->sl_repsal
;
12614 gap
= &lp
->lp_replang
->sl_rep
;
12615 ftp
= (fromto_T
*)gap
->ga_data
+ sp
->ts_curi
- 1;
12616 fl
= (int)STRLEN(ftp
->ft_from
);
12617 tl
= (int)STRLEN(ftp
->ft_to
);
12618 p
= fword
+ sp
->ts_fidx
;
12621 STRMOVE(p
+ fl
, p
+ tl
);
12622 repextra
-= tl
- fl
;
12624 mch_memmove(p
, ftp
->ft_from
, fl
);
12625 sp
->ts_state
= STATE_REP
;
12629 /* Did all possible states at this level, go up one level. */
12632 if (depth
>= 0 && stack
[depth
].ts_prefixdepth
== PFD_PREFIXTREE
)
12634 /* Continue in or go back to the prefix tree. */
12639 /* Don't check for CTRL-C too often, it takes time. */
12640 if (--breakcheckcount
== 0)
12643 breakcheckcount
= 1000;
12651 * Go one level deeper in the tree.
12654 go_deeper(stack
, depth
, score_add
)
12659 stack
[depth
+ 1] = stack
[depth
];
12660 stack
[depth
+ 1].ts_state
= STATE_START
;
12661 stack
[depth
+ 1].ts_score
= stack
[depth
].ts_score
+ score_add
;
12662 stack
[depth
+ 1].ts_curi
= 1; /* start just after length byte */
12663 stack
[depth
+ 1].ts_flags
= 0;
12668 * Case-folding may change the number of bytes: Count nr of chars in
12669 * fword[flen] and return the byte length of that many chars in "word".
12672 nofold_len(fword
, flen
, word
)
12680 for (p
= fword
; p
< fword
+ flen
; mb_ptr_adv(p
))
12682 for (p
= word
; i
> 0; mb_ptr_adv(p
))
12684 return (int)(p
- word
);
12689 * "fword" is a good word with case folded. Find the matching keep-case
12690 * words and put it in "kword".
12691 * Theoretically there could be several keep-case words that result in the
12692 * same case-folded word, but we only find one...
12695 find_keepcap_word(slang
, fword
, kword
)
12700 char_u uword
[MAXWLEN
]; /* "fword" in upper-case */
12704 /* The following arrays are used at each depth in the tree. */
12705 idx_T arridx
[MAXWLEN
];
12706 int round
[MAXWLEN
];
12707 int fwordidx
[MAXWLEN
];
12708 int uwordidx
[MAXWLEN
];
12709 int kwordlen
[MAXWLEN
];
12717 char_u
*byts
= slang
->sl_kbyts
; /* array with bytes of the words */
12718 idx_T
*idxs
= slang
->sl_kidxs
; /* array with indexes */
12722 /* array is empty: "cannot happen" */
12727 /* Make an all-cap version of "fword". */
12728 allcap_copy(fword
, uword
);
12731 * Each character needs to be tried both case-folded and upper-case.
12732 * All this gets very complicated if we keep in mind that changing case
12733 * may change the byte length of a multi-byte character...
12743 if (fword
[fwordidx
[depth
]] == NUL
)
12745 /* We are at the end of "fword". If the tree allows a word to end
12746 * here we have found a match. */
12747 if (byts
[arridx
[depth
] + 1] == 0)
12749 kword
[kwordlen
[depth
]] = NUL
;
12753 /* kword is getting too long, continue one level up */
12756 else if (++round
[depth
] > 2)
12758 /* tried both fold-case and upper-case character, continue one
12765 * round[depth] == 1: Try using the folded-case character.
12766 * round[depth] == 2: Try using the upper-case character.
12771 flen
= mb_cptr2len(fword
+ fwordidx
[depth
]);
12772 ulen
= mb_cptr2len(uword
+ uwordidx
[depth
]);
12777 if (round
[depth
] == 1)
12779 p
= fword
+ fwordidx
[depth
];
12784 p
= uword
+ uwordidx
[depth
];
12788 for (tryidx
= arridx
[depth
]; l
> 0; --l
)
12790 /* Perform a binary search in the list of accepted bytes. */
12791 len
= byts
[tryidx
++];
12794 hi
= tryidx
+ len
- 1;
12800 else if (byts
[m
] < c
)
12809 /* Stop if there is no matching byte. */
12810 if (hi
< lo
|| byts
[lo
] != c
)
12813 /* Continue at the child (if there is one). */
12820 * Found the matching char. Copy it to "kword" and go a
12823 if (round
[depth
] == 1)
12825 STRNCPY(kword
+ kwordlen
[depth
], fword
+ fwordidx
[depth
],
12827 kwordlen
[depth
+ 1] = kwordlen
[depth
] + flen
;
12831 STRNCPY(kword
+ kwordlen
[depth
], uword
+ uwordidx
[depth
],
12833 kwordlen
[depth
+ 1] = kwordlen
[depth
] + ulen
;
12835 fwordidx
[depth
+ 1] = fwordidx
[depth
] + flen
;
12836 uwordidx
[depth
+ 1] = uwordidx
[depth
] + ulen
;
12839 arridx
[depth
] = tryidx
;
12845 /* Didn't find it: "cannot happen". */
12850 * Compute the sound-a-like score for suggestions in su->su_ga and add them to
12858 char_u badsound
[MAXWLEN
];
12865 if (ga_grow(&su
->su_sga
, su
->su_ga
.ga_len
) == FAIL
)
12868 /* Use the sound-folding of the first language that supports it. */
12869 for (lpi
= 0; lpi
< curbuf
->b_langp
.ga_len
; ++lpi
)
12871 lp
= LANGP_ENTRY(curbuf
->b_langp
, lpi
);
12872 if (lp
->lp_slang
->sl_sal
.ga_len
> 0)
12874 /* soundfold the bad word */
12875 spell_soundfold(lp
->lp_slang
, su
->su_fbadword
, TRUE
, badsound
);
12877 for (i
= 0; i
< su
->su_ga
.ga_len
; ++i
)
12879 stp
= &SUG(su
->su_ga
, i
);
12881 /* Case-fold the suggested word, sound-fold it and compute the
12882 * sound-a-like score. */
12883 score
= stp_sal_score(stp
, su
, lp
->lp_slang
, badsound
);
12884 if (score
< SCORE_MAXMAX
)
12886 /* Add the suggestion. */
12887 sstp
= &SUG(su
->su_sga
, su
->su_sga
.ga_len
);
12888 sstp
->st_word
= vim_strsave(stp
->st_word
);
12889 if (sstp
->st_word
!= NULL
)
12891 sstp
->st_wordlen
= stp
->st_wordlen
;
12892 sstp
->st_score
= score
;
12893 sstp
->st_altscore
= 0;
12894 sstp
->st_orglen
= stp
->st_orglen
;
12895 ++su
->su_sga
.ga_len
;
12905 * Combine the list of suggestions in su->su_ga and su->su_sga.
12906 * They are intwined.
12919 char_u badsound
[MAXWLEN
];
12922 slang_T
*slang
= NULL
;
12924 /* Add the alternate score to su_ga. */
12925 for (lpi
= 0; lpi
< curbuf
->b_langp
.ga_len
; ++lpi
)
12927 lp
= LANGP_ENTRY(curbuf
->b_langp
, lpi
);
12928 if (lp
->lp_slang
->sl_sal
.ga_len
> 0)
12930 /* soundfold the bad word */
12931 slang
= lp
->lp_slang
;
12932 spell_soundfold(slang
, su
->su_fbadword
, TRUE
, badsound
);
12934 for (i
= 0; i
< su
->su_ga
.ga_len
; ++i
)
12936 stp
= &SUG(su
->su_ga
, i
);
12937 stp
->st_altscore
= stp_sal_score(stp
, su
, slang
, badsound
);
12938 if (stp
->st_altscore
== SCORE_MAXMAX
)
12939 stp
->st_score
= (stp
->st_score
* 3 + SCORE_BIG
) / 4;
12941 stp
->st_score
= (stp
->st_score
* 3
12942 + stp
->st_altscore
) / 4;
12943 stp
->st_salscore
= FALSE
;
12949 if (slang
== NULL
) /* Using "double" without sound folding. */
12951 (void)cleanup_suggestions(&su
->su_ga
, su
->su_maxscore
,
12956 /* Add the alternate score to su_sga. */
12957 for (i
= 0; i
< su
->su_sga
.ga_len
; ++i
)
12959 stp
= &SUG(su
->su_sga
, i
);
12960 stp
->st_altscore
= spell_edit_score(slang
,
12961 su
->su_badword
, stp
->st_word
);
12962 if (stp
->st_score
== SCORE_MAXMAX
)
12963 stp
->st_score
= (SCORE_BIG
* 7 + stp
->st_altscore
) / 8;
12965 stp
->st_score
= (stp
->st_score
* 7 + stp
->st_altscore
) / 8;
12966 stp
->st_salscore
= TRUE
;
12969 /* Remove bad suggestions, sort the suggestions and truncate at "maxcount"
12970 * for both lists. */
12971 check_suggestions(su
, &su
->su_ga
);
12972 (void)cleanup_suggestions(&su
->su_ga
, su
->su_maxscore
, su
->su_maxcount
);
12973 check_suggestions(su
, &su
->su_sga
);
12974 (void)cleanup_suggestions(&su
->su_sga
, su
->su_maxscore
, su
->su_maxcount
);
12976 ga_init2(&ga
, (int)sizeof(suginfo_T
), 1);
12977 if (ga_grow(&ga
, su
->su_ga
.ga_len
+ su
->su_sga
.ga_len
) == FAIL
)
12981 for (i
= 0; i
< su
->su_ga
.ga_len
|| i
< su
->su_sga
.ga_len
; ++i
)
12983 /* round 1: get a suggestion from su_ga
12984 * round 2: get a suggestion from su_sga */
12985 for (round
= 1; round
<= 2; ++round
)
12987 gap
= round
== 1 ? &su
->su_ga
: &su
->su_sga
;
12988 if (i
< gap
->ga_len
)
12990 /* Don't add a word if it's already there. */
12991 p
= SUG(*gap
, i
).st_word
;
12992 for (j
= 0; j
< ga
.ga_len
; ++j
)
12993 if (STRCMP(stp
[j
].st_word
, p
) == 0)
12995 if (j
== ga
.ga_len
)
12996 stp
[ga
.ga_len
++] = SUG(*gap
, i
);
13003 ga_clear(&su
->su_ga
);
13004 ga_clear(&su
->su_sga
);
13006 /* Truncate the list to the number of suggestions that will be displayed. */
13007 if (ga
.ga_len
> su
->su_maxcount
)
13009 for (i
= su
->su_maxcount
; i
< ga
.ga_len
; ++i
)
13010 vim_free(stp
[i
].st_word
);
13011 ga
.ga_len
= su
->su_maxcount
;
13018 * For the goodword in "stp" compute the soundalike score compared to the
13022 stp_sal_score(stp
, su
, slang
, badsound
)
13026 char_u
*badsound
; /* sound-folded badword */
13031 char_u badsound2
[MAXWLEN
];
13032 char_u fword
[MAXWLEN
];
13033 char_u goodsound
[MAXWLEN
];
13034 char_u goodword
[MAXWLEN
];
13037 lendiff
= (int)(su
->su_badlen
- stp
->st_orglen
);
13042 /* soundfold the bad word with more characters following */
13043 (void)spell_casefold(su
->su_badptr
, stp
->st_orglen
, fword
, MAXWLEN
);
13045 /* When joining two words the sound often changes a lot. E.g., "t he"
13046 * sounds like "t h" while "the" sounds like "@". Avoid that by
13047 * removing the space. Don't do it when the good word also contains a
13049 if (vim_iswhite(su
->su_badptr
[su
->su_badlen
])
13050 && *skiptowhite(stp
->st_word
) == NUL
)
13051 for (p
= fword
; *(p
= skiptowhite(p
)) != NUL
; )
13054 spell_soundfold(slang
, fword
, TRUE
, badsound2
);
13060 /* Add part of the bad word to the good word, so that we soundfold
13061 * what replaces the bad word. */
13062 STRCPY(goodword
, stp
->st_word
);
13063 vim_strncpy(goodword
+ stp
->st_wordlen
,
13064 su
->su_badptr
+ su
->su_badlen
- lendiff
, lendiff
);
13068 pgood
= stp
->st_word
;
13070 /* Sound-fold the word and compute the score for the difference. */
13071 spell_soundfold(slang
, pgood
, FALSE
, goodsound
);
13073 return soundalike_score(goodsound
, pbad
);
13076 /* structure used to store soundfolded words that add_sound_suggest() has
13077 * handled already. */
13080 short sft_score
; /* lowest score used */
13081 char_u sft_word
[1]; /* soundfolded word, actually longer */
13084 static sftword_T dumsft
;
13085 #define HIKEY2SFT(p) ((sftword_T *)(p - (dumsft.sft_word - (char_u *)&dumsft)))
13086 #define HI2SFT(hi) HIKEY2SFT((hi)->hi_key)
13089 * Prepare for calling suggest_try_soundalike().
13092 suggest_try_soundalike_prep()
13098 /* Do this for all languages that support sound folding and for which a
13099 * .sug file has been loaded. */
13100 for (lpi
= 0; lpi
< curbuf
->b_langp
.ga_len
; ++lpi
)
13102 lp
= LANGP_ENTRY(curbuf
->b_langp
, lpi
);
13103 slang
= lp
->lp_slang
;
13104 if (slang
->sl_sal
.ga_len
> 0 && slang
->sl_sbyts
!= NULL
)
13105 /* prepare the hashtable used by add_sound_suggest() */
13106 hash_init(&slang
->sl_sounddone
);
13111 * Find suggestions by comparing the word in a sound-a-like form.
13112 * Note: This doesn't support postponed prefixes.
13115 suggest_try_soundalike(su
)
13118 char_u salword
[MAXWLEN
];
13123 /* Do this for all languages that support sound folding and for which a
13124 * .sug file has been loaded. */
13125 for (lpi
= 0; lpi
< curbuf
->b_langp
.ga_len
; ++lpi
)
13127 lp
= LANGP_ENTRY(curbuf
->b_langp
, lpi
);
13128 slang
= lp
->lp_slang
;
13129 if (slang
->sl_sal
.ga_len
> 0 && slang
->sl_sbyts
!= NULL
)
13131 /* soundfold the bad word */
13132 spell_soundfold(slang
, su
->su_fbadword
, TRUE
, salword
);
13134 /* try all kinds of inserts/deletes/swaps/etc. */
13135 /* TODO: also soundfold the next words, so that we can try joining
13137 suggest_trie_walk(su
, lp
, salword
, TRUE
);
13143 * Finish up after calling suggest_try_soundalike().
13146 suggest_try_soundalike_finish()
13154 /* Do this for all languages that support sound folding and for which a
13155 * .sug file has been loaded. */
13156 for (lpi
= 0; lpi
< curbuf
->b_langp
.ga_len
; ++lpi
)
13158 lp
= LANGP_ENTRY(curbuf
->b_langp
, lpi
);
13159 slang
= lp
->lp_slang
;
13160 if (slang
->sl_sal
.ga_len
> 0 && slang
->sl_sbyts
!= NULL
)
13162 /* Free the info about handled words. */
13163 todo
= (int)slang
->sl_sounddone
.ht_used
;
13164 for (hi
= slang
->sl_sounddone
.ht_array
; todo
> 0; ++hi
)
13165 if (!HASHITEM_EMPTY(hi
))
13167 vim_free(HI2SFT(hi
));
13171 /* Clear the hashtable, it may also be used by another region. */
13172 hash_clear(&slang
->sl_sounddone
);
13173 hash_init(&slang
->sl_sounddone
);
13179 * A match with a soundfolded word is found. Add the good word(s) that
13180 * produce this soundfolded word.
13183 add_sound_suggest(su
, goodword
, score
, lp
)
13186 int score
; /* soundfold score */
13189 slang_T
*slang
= lp
->lp_slang
; /* language for sound folding */
13193 char_u theword
[MAXWLEN
];
13209 * It's very well possible that the same soundfold word is found several
13210 * times with different scores. Since the following is quite slow only do
13211 * the words that have a better score than before. Use a hashtable to
13212 * remember the words that have been done.
13214 hash
= hash_hash(goodword
);
13215 hi
= hash_lookup(&slang
->sl_sounddone
, goodword
, hash
);
13216 if (HASHITEM_EMPTY(hi
))
13218 sft
= (sftword_T
*)alloc((unsigned)(sizeof(sftword_T
)
13219 + STRLEN(goodword
)));
13222 sft
->sft_score
= score
;
13223 STRCPY(sft
->sft_word
, goodword
);
13224 hash_add_item(&slang
->sl_sounddone
, hi
, sft
->sft_word
, hash
);
13230 if (score
>= sft
->sft_score
)
13232 sft
->sft_score
= score
;
13236 * Find the word nr in the soundfold tree.
13238 sfwordnr
= soundfold_find(slang
, goodword
);
13241 EMSG2(_(e_intern2
), "add_sound_suggest()");
13246 * go over the list of good words that produce this soundfold word
13248 nrline
= ml_get_buf(slang
->sl_sugbuf
, (linenr_T
)(sfwordnr
+ 1), FALSE
);
13250 while (*nrline
!= NUL
)
13252 /* The wordnr was stored in a minimal nr of bytes as an offset to the
13253 * previous wordnr. */
13254 orgnr
+= bytes2offset(&nrline
);
13256 byts
= slang
->sl_fbyts
;
13257 idxs
= slang
->sl_fidxs
;
13259 /* Lookup the word "orgnr" one of the two tries. */
13266 if (wordcount
== orgnr
&& byts
[n
+ 1] == NUL
)
13267 break; /* found end of word */
13269 if (byts
[n
+ 1] == NUL
)
13272 /* skip over the NUL bytes */
13273 for ( ; byts
[n
+ i
] == NUL
; ++i
)
13274 if (i
> byts
[n
]) /* safety check */
13276 STRCPY(theword
+ wlen
, "BAD");
13280 /* One of the siblings must have the word. */
13281 for ( ; i
< byts
[n
]; ++i
)
13283 wc
= idxs
[idxs
[n
+ i
]]; /* nr of words under this byte */
13284 if (wordcount
+ wc
> orgnr
)
13289 theword
[wlen
++] = byts
[n
+ i
];
13293 theword
[wlen
] = NUL
;
13295 /* Go over the possible flags and regions. */
13296 for (; i
<= byts
[n
] && byts
[n
+ i
] == NUL
; ++i
)
13298 char_u cword
[MAXWLEN
];
13300 int flags
= (int)idxs
[n
+ i
];
13302 /* Skip words with the NOSUGGEST flag */
13303 if (flags
& WF_NOSUGGEST
)
13306 if (flags
& WF_KEEPCAP
)
13308 /* Must find the word in the keep-case tree. */
13309 find_keepcap_word(slang
, theword
, cword
);
13314 flags
|= su
->su_badflags
;
13315 if ((flags
& WF_CAPMASK
) != 0)
13317 /* Need to fix case according to "flags". */
13318 make_case_word(theword
, cword
, flags
);
13325 /* Add the suggestion. */
13326 if (sps_flags
& SPS_DOUBLE
)
13328 /* Add the suggestion if the score isn't too bad. */
13329 if (score
<= su
->su_maxscore
)
13330 add_suggestion(su
, &su
->su_sga
, p
, su
->su_badlen
,
13331 score
, 0, FALSE
, slang
, FALSE
);
13335 /* Add a penalty for words in another region. */
13336 if ((flags
& WF_REGION
)
13337 && (((unsigned)flags
>> 16) & lp
->lp_region
) == 0)
13338 goodscore
= SCORE_REGION
;
13342 /* Add a small penalty for changing the first letter from
13343 * lower to upper case. Helps for "tath" -> "Kath", which is
13344 * less common thatn "tath" -> "path". Don't do it when the
13345 * letter is the same, that has already been counted. */
13347 if (SPELL_ISUPPER(gc
))
13349 bc
= PTR2CHAR(su
->su_badword
);
13350 if (!SPELL_ISUPPER(bc
)
13351 && SPELL_TOFOLD(bc
) != SPELL_TOFOLD(gc
))
13352 goodscore
+= SCORE_ICASE
/ 2;
13355 /* Compute the score for the good word. This only does letter
13356 * insert/delete/swap/replace. REP items are not considered,
13357 * which may make the score a bit higher.
13358 * Use a limit for the score to make it work faster. Use
13359 * MAXSCORE(), because RESCORE() will change the score.
13360 * If the limit is very high then the iterative method is
13361 * inefficient, using an array is quicker. */
13362 limit
= MAXSCORE(su
->su_sfmaxscore
- goodscore
, score
);
13363 if (limit
> SCORE_LIMITMAX
)
13364 goodscore
+= spell_edit_score(slang
, su
->su_badword
, p
);
13366 goodscore
+= spell_edit_score_limit(slang
, su
->su_badword
,
13369 /* When going over the limit don't bother to do the rest. */
13370 if (goodscore
< SCORE_MAXMAX
)
13372 /* Give a bonus to words seen before. */
13373 goodscore
= score_wordcount_adj(slang
, goodscore
, p
, FALSE
);
13375 /* Add the suggestion if the score isn't too bad. */
13376 goodscore
= RESCORE(goodscore
, score
);
13377 if (goodscore
<= su
->su_sfmaxscore
)
13378 add_suggestion(su
, &su
->su_ga
, p
, su
->su_badlen
,
13379 goodscore
, score
, TRUE
, slang
, TRUE
);
13383 /* smsg("word %s (%d): %s (%d)", sftword, sftnr, theword, orgnr); */
13388 * Find word "word" in fold-case tree for "slang" and return the word number.
13391 soundfold_find(slang
, word
)
13399 char_u
*ptr
= word
;
13404 byts
= slang
->sl_sbyts
;
13405 idxs
= slang
->sl_sidxs
;
13409 /* First byte is the number of possible bytes. */
13410 len
= byts
[arridx
++];
13412 /* If the first possible byte is a zero the word could end here.
13413 * If the word ends we found the word. If not skip the NUL bytes. */
13415 if (byts
[arridx
] == NUL
)
13420 /* Skip over the zeros, there can be several. */
13421 while (len
> 0 && byts
[arridx
] == NUL
)
13427 return -1; /* no children, word should have ended here */
13431 /* If the word ends we didn't find it. */
13435 /* Perform a binary search in the list of accepted bytes. */
13436 if (c
== TAB
) /* <Tab> is handled like <Space> */
13438 while (byts
[arridx
] < c
)
13440 /* The word count is in the first idxs[] entry of the child. */
13441 wordnr
+= idxs
[idxs
[arridx
]];
13443 if (--len
== 0) /* end of the bytes, didn't find it */
13446 if (byts
[arridx
] != c
) /* didn't find the byte */
13449 /* Continue at the child (if there is one). */
13450 arridx
= idxs
[arridx
];
13453 /* One space in the good word may stand for several spaces in the
13456 while (ptr
[wlen
] == ' ' || ptr
[wlen
] == TAB
)
13464 * Copy "fword" to "cword", fixing case according to "flags".
13467 make_case_word(fword
, cword
, flags
)
13472 if (flags
& WF_ALLCAP
)
13473 /* Make it all upper-case */
13474 allcap_copy(fword
, cword
);
13475 else if (flags
& WF_ONECAP
)
13476 /* Make the first letter upper-case */
13477 onecap_copy(fword
, cword
, TRUE
);
13479 /* Use goodword as-is. */
13480 STRCPY(cword
, fword
);
13484 * Use map string "map" for languages "lp".
13487 set_map_str(lp
, map
)
13498 lp
->sl_has_map
= FALSE
;
13501 lp
->sl_has_map
= TRUE
;
13503 /* Init the array and hash tables empty. */
13504 for (i
= 0; i
< 256; ++i
)
13505 lp
->sl_map_array
[i
] = 0;
13507 hash_init(&lp
->sl_map_hash
);
13511 * The similar characters are stored separated with slashes:
13512 * "aaa/bbb/ccc/". Fill sl_map_array[c] with the character before c and
13513 * before the same slash. For characters above 255 sl_map_hash is used.
13515 for (p
= map
; *p
!= NUL
; )
13518 c
= mb_cptr2char_adv(&p
);
13530 /* Characters above 255 don't fit in sl_map_array[], put them in
13531 * the hash table. Each entry is the char, a NUL the headchar and
13535 int cl
= mb_char2len(c
);
13536 int headcl
= mb_char2len(headc
);
13541 b
= alloc((unsigned)(cl
+ headcl
+ 2));
13544 mb_char2bytes(c
, b
);
13546 mb_char2bytes(headc
, b
+ cl
+ 1);
13547 b
[cl
+ 1 + headcl
] = NUL
;
13548 hash
= hash_hash(b
);
13549 hi
= hash_lookup(&lp
->sl_map_hash
, b
, hash
);
13550 if (HASHITEM_EMPTY(hi
))
13551 hash_add_item(&lp
->sl_map_hash
, hi
, b
, hash
);
13554 /* This should have been checked when generating the .spl
13556 EMSG(_("E783: duplicate char in MAP entry"));
13562 lp
->sl_map_array
[c
] = headc
;
13568 * Return TRUE if "c1" and "c2" are similar characters according to the MAP
13569 * lines in the .aff file.
13572 similar_chars(slang
, c1
, c2
)
13579 char_u buf
[MB_MAXBYTES
];
13584 buf
[mb_char2bytes(c1
, buf
)] = 0;
13585 hi
= hash_find(&slang
->sl_map_hash
, buf
);
13586 if (HASHITEM_EMPTY(hi
))
13589 m1
= mb_ptr2char(hi
->hi_key
+ STRLEN(hi
->hi_key
) + 1);
13593 m1
= slang
->sl_map_array
[c1
];
13601 buf
[mb_char2bytes(c2
, buf
)] = 0;
13602 hi
= hash_find(&slang
->sl_map_hash
, buf
);
13603 if (HASHITEM_EMPTY(hi
))
13606 m2
= mb_ptr2char(hi
->hi_key
+ STRLEN(hi
->hi_key
) + 1);
13610 m2
= slang
->sl_map_array
[c2
];
13616 * Add a suggestion to the list of suggestions.
13617 * For a suggestion that is already in the list the lowest score is remembered.
13620 add_suggestion(su
, gap
, goodword
, badlenarg
, score
, altscore
, had_bonus
,
13623 garray_T
*gap
; /* either su_ga or su_sga */
13625 int badlenarg
; /* len of bad word replaced with "goodword" */
13628 int had_bonus
; /* value for st_had_bonus */
13629 slang_T
*slang
; /* language for sound folding */
13630 int maxsf
; /* su_maxscore applies to soundfold score,
13631 su_sfmaxscore to the total score. */
13633 int goodlen
; /* len of goodword changed */
13634 int badlen
; /* len of bad word changed */
13638 char_u
*pgood
, *pbad
;
13640 /* Minimize "badlen" for consistency. Avoids that changing "the the" to
13641 * "thee the" is added next to changing the first "the" the "thee". */
13642 pgood
= goodword
+ STRLEN(goodword
);
13643 pbad
= su
->su_badptr
+ badlenarg
;
13646 goodlen
= (int)(pgood
- goodword
);
13647 badlen
= (int)(pbad
- su
->su_badptr
);
13648 if (goodlen
<= 0 || badlen
<= 0)
13650 mb_ptr_back(goodword
, pgood
);
13651 mb_ptr_back(su
->su_badptr
, pbad
);
13655 if (mb_ptr2char(pgood
) != mb_ptr2char(pbad
))
13660 if (*pgood
!= *pbad
)
13664 if (badlen
== 0 && goodlen
== 0)
13665 /* goodword doesn't change anything; may happen for "the the" changing
13666 * the first "the" to itself. */
13669 if (gap
->ga_len
== 0)
13673 /* Check if the word is already there. Also check the length that is
13674 * being replaced "thes," -> "these" is a different suggestion from
13675 * "thes" -> "these". */
13676 stp
= &SUG(*gap
, 0);
13677 for (i
= gap
->ga_len
; --i
>= 0; ++stp
)
13678 if (stp
->st_wordlen
== goodlen
13679 && stp
->st_orglen
== badlen
13680 && STRNCMP(stp
->st_word
, goodword
, goodlen
) == 0)
13683 * Found it. Remember the word with the lowest score.
13685 if (stp
->st_slang
== NULL
)
13686 stp
->st_slang
= slang
;
13688 new_sug
.st_score
= score
;
13689 new_sug
.st_altscore
= altscore
;
13690 new_sug
.st_had_bonus
= had_bonus
;
13692 if (stp
->st_had_bonus
!= had_bonus
)
13694 /* Only one of the two had the soundalike score computed.
13695 * Need to do that for the other one now, otherwise the
13696 * scores can't be compared. This happens because
13697 * suggest_try_change() doesn't compute the soundalike
13698 * word to keep it fast, while some special methods set
13699 * the soundalike score to zero. */
13701 rescore_one(su
, stp
);
13704 new_sug
.st_word
= stp
->st_word
;
13705 new_sug
.st_wordlen
= stp
->st_wordlen
;
13706 new_sug
.st_slang
= stp
->st_slang
;
13707 new_sug
.st_orglen
= badlen
;
13708 rescore_one(su
, &new_sug
);
13712 if (stp
->st_score
> new_sug
.st_score
)
13714 stp
->st_score
= new_sug
.st_score
;
13715 stp
->st_altscore
= new_sug
.st_altscore
;
13716 stp
->st_had_bonus
= new_sug
.st_had_bonus
;
13722 if (i
< 0 && ga_grow(gap
, 1) == OK
)
13724 /* Add a suggestion. */
13725 stp
= &SUG(*gap
, gap
->ga_len
);
13726 stp
->st_word
= vim_strnsave(goodword
, goodlen
);
13727 if (stp
->st_word
!= NULL
)
13729 stp
->st_wordlen
= goodlen
;
13730 stp
->st_score
= score
;
13731 stp
->st_altscore
= altscore
;
13732 stp
->st_had_bonus
= had_bonus
;
13733 stp
->st_orglen
= badlen
;
13734 stp
->st_slang
= slang
;
13737 /* If we have too many suggestions now, sort the list and keep
13738 * the best suggestions. */
13739 if (gap
->ga_len
> SUG_MAX_COUNT(su
))
13742 su
->su_sfmaxscore
= cleanup_suggestions(gap
,
13743 su
->su_sfmaxscore
, SUG_CLEAN_COUNT(su
));
13746 i
= su
->su_maxscore
;
13747 su
->su_maxscore
= cleanup_suggestions(gap
,
13748 su
->su_maxscore
, SUG_CLEAN_COUNT(su
));
13756 * Suggestions may in fact be flagged as errors. Esp. for banned words and
13757 * for split words, such as "the the". Remove these from the list here.
13760 check_suggestions(su
, gap
)
13762 garray_T
*gap
; /* either su_ga or su_sga */
13766 char_u longword
[MAXWLEN
+ 1];
13770 stp
= &SUG(*gap
, 0);
13771 for (i
= gap
->ga_len
- 1; i
>= 0; --i
)
13773 /* Need to append what follows to check for "the the". */
13774 STRCPY(longword
, stp
[i
].st_word
);
13775 len
= stp
[i
].st_wordlen
;
13776 vim_strncpy(longword
+ len
, su
->su_badptr
+ stp
[i
].st_orglen
,
13779 (void)spell_check(curwin
, longword
, &attr
, NULL
, FALSE
);
13780 if (attr
!= HLF_COUNT
)
13782 /* Remove this entry. */
13783 vim_free(stp
[i
].st_word
);
13785 if (i
< gap
->ga_len
)
13786 mch_memmove(stp
+ i
, stp
+ i
+ 1,
13787 sizeof(suggest_T
) * (gap
->ga_len
- i
));
13794 * Add a word to be banned.
13797 add_banned(su
, word
)
13805 hash
= hash_hash(word
);
13806 hi
= hash_lookup(&su
->su_banned
, word
, hash
);
13807 if (HASHITEM_EMPTY(hi
))
13809 s
= vim_strsave(word
);
13811 hash_add_item(&su
->su_banned
, hi
, s
, hash
);
13816 * Recompute the score for all suggestions if sound-folding is possible. This
13817 * is slow, thus only done for the final results.
13820 rescore_suggestions(su
)
13825 if (su
->su_sallang
!= NULL
)
13826 for (i
= 0; i
< su
->su_ga
.ga_len
; ++i
)
13827 rescore_one(su
, &SUG(su
->su_ga
, i
));
13831 * Recompute the score for one suggestion if sound-folding is possible.
13834 rescore_one(su
, stp
)
13838 slang_T
*slang
= stp
->st_slang
;
13839 char_u sal_badword
[MAXWLEN
];
13842 /* Only rescore suggestions that have no sal score yet and do have a
13844 if (slang
!= NULL
&& slang
->sl_sal
.ga_len
> 0 && !stp
->st_had_bonus
)
13846 if (slang
== su
->su_sallang
)
13847 p
= su
->su_sal_badword
;
13850 spell_soundfold(slang
, su
->su_fbadword
, TRUE
, sal_badword
);
13854 stp
->st_altscore
= stp_sal_score(stp
, su
, slang
, p
);
13855 if (stp
->st_altscore
== SCORE_MAXMAX
)
13856 stp
->st_altscore
= SCORE_BIG
;
13857 stp
->st_score
= RESCORE(stp
->st_score
, stp
->st_altscore
);
13858 stp
->st_had_bonus
= TRUE
;
13863 #ifdef __BORLANDC__
13866 sug_compare
__ARGS((const void *s1
, const void *s2
));
13869 * Function given to qsort() to sort the suggestions on st_score.
13870 * First on "st_score", then "st_altscore" then alphabetically.
13873 #ifdef __BORLANDC__
13876 sug_compare(s1
, s2
)
13880 suggest_T
*p1
= (suggest_T
*)s1
;
13881 suggest_T
*p2
= (suggest_T
*)s2
;
13882 int n
= p1
->st_score
- p2
->st_score
;
13886 n
= p1
->st_altscore
- p2
->st_altscore
;
13888 n
= STRICMP(p1
->st_word
, p2
->st_word
);
13894 * Cleanup the suggestions:
13896 * - Remove words that won't be displayed.
13897 * Returns the maximum score in the list or "maxscore" unmodified.
13900 cleanup_suggestions(gap
, maxscore
, keep
)
13903 int keep
; /* nr of suggestions to keep */
13905 suggest_T
*stp
= &SUG(*gap
, 0);
13908 /* Sort the list. */
13909 qsort(gap
->ga_data
, (size_t)gap
->ga_len
, sizeof(suggest_T
), sug_compare
);
13911 /* Truncate the list to the number of suggestions that will be displayed. */
13912 if (gap
->ga_len
> keep
)
13914 for (i
= keep
; i
< gap
->ga_len
; ++i
)
13915 vim_free(stp
[i
].st_word
);
13916 gap
->ga_len
= keep
;
13917 return stp
[keep
- 1].st_score
;
13922 #if defined(FEAT_EVAL) || defined(PROTO)
13924 * Soundfold a string, for soundfold().
13925 * Result is in allocated memory, NULL for an error.
13928 eval_soundfold(word
)
13932 char_u sound
[MAXWLEN
];
13935 if (curwin
->w_p_spell
&& *curbuf
->b_p_spl
!= NUL
)
13936 /* Use the sound-folding of the first language that supports it. */
13937 for (lpi
= 0; lpi
< curbuf
->b_langp
.ga_len
; ++lpi
)
13939 lp
= LANGP_ENTRY(curbuf
->b_langp
, lpi
);
13940 if (lp
->lp_slang
->sl_sal
.ga_len
> 0)
13942 /* soundfold the word */
13943 spell_soundfold(lp
->lp_slang
, word
, FALSE
, sound
);
13944 return vim_strsave(sound
);
13948 /* No language with sound folding, return word as-is. */
13949 return vim_strsave(word
);
13954 * Turn "inword" into its sound-a-like equivalent in "res[MAXWLEN]".
13956 * There are many ways to turn a word into a sound-a-like representation. The
13957 * oldest is Soundex (1918!). A nice overview can be found in "Approximate
13958 * swedish name matching - survey and test of different algorithms" by Klas
13961 * We support two methods:
13962 * 1. SOFOFROM/SOFOTO do a simple character mapping.
13963 * 2. SAL items define a more advanced sound-folding (and much slower).
13966 spell_soundfold(slang
, inword
, folded
, res
)
13969 int folded
; /* "inword" is already case-folded */
13972 char_u fword
[MAXWLEN
];
13975 if (slang
->sl_sofo
)
13976 /* SOFOFROM and SOFOTO used */
13977 spell_soundfold_sofo(slang
, inword
, res
);
13980 /* SAL items used. Requires the word to be case-folded. */
13985 (void)spell_casefold(inword
, (int)STRLEN(inword
), fword
, MAXWLEN
);
13991 spell_soundfold_wsal(slang
, word
, res
);
13994 spell_soundfold_sal(slang
, word
, res
);
13999 * Perform sound folding of "inword" into "res" according to SOFOFROM and
14003 spell_soundfold_sofo(slang
, inword
, res
)
14018 /* The sl_sal_first[] table contains the translation for chars up to
14019 * 255, sl_sal the rest. */
14020 for (s
= inword
; *s
!= NUL
; )
14022 c
= mb_cptr2char_adv(&s
);
14023 if (enc_utf8
? utf_class(c
) == 0 : vim_iswhite(c
))
14026 c
= slang
->sl_sal_first
[c
];
14029 ip
= ((int **)slang
->sl_sal
.ga_data
)[c
& 0xff];
14030 if (ip
== NULL
) /* empty list, can't match */
14033 for (;;) /* find "c" in the list */
14035 if (*ip
== 0) /* not found */
14040 if (*ip
== c
) /* match! */
14049 if (c
!= NUL
&& c
!= prevc
)
14051 ri
+= mb_char2bytes(c
, res
+ ri
);
14052 if (ri
+ MB_MAXBYTES
> MAXWLEN
)
14061 /* The sl_sal_first[] table contains the translation. */
14062 for (s
= inword
; (c
= *s
) != NUL
; ++s
)
14064 if (vim_iswhite(c
))
14067 c
= slang
->sl_sal_first
[c
];
14068 if (c
!= NUL
&& (ri
== 0 || res
[ri
- 1] != c
))
14077 spell_soundfold_sal(slang
, inword
, res
)
14083 char_u word
[MAXWLEN
];
14084 char_u
*s
= inword
;
14098 /* Remove accents, if wanted. We actually remove all non-word characters.
14099 * But keep white space. We need a copy, the word may be changed here. */
14100 if (slang
->sl_rem_accents
)
14105 if (vim_iswhite(*s
))
14112 if (spell_iswordp_nmw(s
))
14122 smp
= (salitem_T
*)slang
->sl_sal
.ga_data
;
14125 * This comes from Aspell phonet.cpp. Converted from C++ to C.
14126 * Changed to keep spaces.
14128 i
= reslen
= z
= 0;
14129 while ((c
= word
[i
]) != NUL
)
14131 /* Start with the first rule that has the character in the word. */
14132 n
= slang
->sl_sal_first
[c
];
14137 /* check all rules for the same letter */
14138 for (; (s
= smp
[n
].sm_lead
)[0] == c
; ++n
)
14140 /* Quickly skip entries that don't match the word. Most
14141 * entries are less then three chars, optimize for that. */
14142 k
= smp
[n
].sm_leadlen
;
14145 if (word
[i
+ 1] != s
[1])
14149 for (j
= 2; j
< k
; ++j
)
14150 if (word
[i
+ j
] != s
[j
])
14157 if ((pf
= smp
[n
].sm_oneof
) != NULL
)
14159 /* Check for match with one of the chars in "sm_oneof". */
14160 while (*pf
!= NUL
&& *pf
!= word
[i
+ k
])
14166 s
= smp
[n
].sm_rules
;
14167 pri
= 5; /* default priority */
14171 while (*s
== '-' && k
> 1)
14178 if (VIM_ISDIGIT(*s
))
14180 /* determine priority */
14184 if (*s
== '^' && *(s
+ 1) == '^')
14189 && (i
== 0 || !(word
[i
- 1] == ' '
14190 || spell_iswordp(word
+ i
- 1, curbuf
)))
14191 && (*(s
+ 1) != '$'
14192 || (!spell_iswordp(word
+ i
+ k0
, curbuf
))))
14193 || (*s
== '$' && i
> 0
14194 && spell_iswordp(word
+ i
- 1, curbuf
)
14195 && (!spell_iswordp(word
+ i
+ k0
, curbuf
))))
14197 /* search for followup rules, if: */
14198 /* followup and k > 1 and NO '-' in searchstring */
14199 c0
= word
[i
+ k
- 1];
14200 n0
= slang
->sl_sal_first
[c0
];
14202 if (slang
->sl_followup
&& k
> 1 && n0
>= 0
14203 && p0
!= '-' && word
[i
+ k
] != NUL
)
14205 /* test follow-up rule for "word[i + k]" */
14206 for ( ; (s
= smp
[n0
].sm_lead
)[0] == c0
; ++n0
)
14208 /* Quickly skip entries that don't match the word.
14210 k0
= smp
[n0
].sm_leadlen
;
14213 if (word
[i
+ k
] != s
[1])
14217 pf
= word
+ i
+ k
+ 1;
14218 for (j
= 2; j
< k0
; ++j
)
14227 if ((pf
= smp
[n0
].sm_oneof
) != NULL
)
14229 /* Check for match with one of the chars in
14231 while (*pf
!= NUL
&& *pf
!= word
[i
+ k0
])
14239 s
= smp
[n0
].sm_rules
;
14242 /* "k0" gets NOT reduced because
14243 * "if (k0 == k)" */
14248 if (VIM_ISDIGIT(*s
))
14255 /* *s == '^' cuts */
14257 && !spell_iswordp(word
+ i
+ k0
,
14261 /* this is just a piece of the string */
14265 /* priority too low */
14267 /* rule fits; stop search */
14272 if (p0
>= pri
&& smp
[n0
].sm_lead
[0] == c0
)
14276 /* replace string */
14280 pf
= smp
[n
].sm_rules
;
14281 p0
= (vim_strchr(pf
, '<') != NULL
) ? 1 : 0;
14282 if (p0
== 1 && z
== 0)
14284 /* rule with '<' is used */
14285 if (reslen
> 0 && *s
!= NUL
&& (res
[reslen
- 1] == c
14286 || res
[reslen
- 1] == *s
))
14291 while (*s
!= NUL
&& word
[i
+ k0
] != NUL
)
14298 STRMOVE(word
+ i
+ k0
, word
+ i
+ k
);
14300 /* new "actual letter" */
14305 /* no '<' rule used */
14308 while (*s
!= NUL
&& s
[1] != NUL
&& reslen
< MAXWLEN
)
14310 if (reslen
== 0 || res
[reslen
- 1] != *s
)
14311 res
[reslen
++] = *s
;
14314 /* new "actual letter" */
14316 if (strstr((char *)pf
, "^^") != NULL
)
14320 STRMOVE(word
, word
+ i
+ 1);
14329 else if (vim_iswhite(c
))
14337 if (k
&& !p0
&& reslen
< MAXWLEN
&& c
!= NUL
14338 && (!slang
->sl_collapse
|| reslen
== 0
14339 || res
[reslen
- 1] != c
))
14340 /* condense only double letters */
14354 * Turn "inword" into its sound-a-like equivalent in "res[MAXWLEN]".
14355 * Multi-byte version of spell_soundfold().
14358 spell_soundfold_wsal(slang
, inword
, res
)
14363 salitem_T
*smp
= (salitem_T
*)slang
->sl_sal
.ga_data
;
14381 int did_white
= FALSE
;
14384 * Convert the multi-byte string to a wide-character string.
14385 * Remove accents, if wanted. We actually remove all non-word characters.
14386 * But keep white space.
14389 for (s
= inword
; *s
!= NUL
; )
14392 c
= mb_cptr2char_adv(&s
);
14393 if (slang
->sl_rem_accents
)
14395 if (enc_utf8
? utf_class(c
) == 0 : vim_iswhite(c
))
14405 if (!spell_iswordp_nmw(t
))
14414 * This comes from Aspell phonet.cpp.
14415 * Converted from C++ to C. Added support for multi-byte chars.
14416 * Changed to keep spaces.
14418 i
= reslen
= z
= 0;
14419 while ((c
= word
[i
]) != NUL
)
14421 /* Start with the first rule that has the character in the word. */
14422 n
= slang
->sl_sal_first
[c
& 0xff];
14427 /* check all rules for the same index byte */
14428 for (; ((ws
= smp
[n
].sm_lead_w
)[0] & 0xff) == (c
& 0xff); ++n
)
14430 /* Quickly skip entries that don't match the word. Most
14431 * entries are less then three chars, optimize for that. */
14434 k
= smp
[n
].sm_leadlen
;
14437 if (word
[i
+ 1] != ws
[1])
14441 for (j
= 2; j
< k
; ++j
)
14442 if (word
[i
+ j
] != ws
[j
])
14449 if ((pf
= smp
[n
].sm_oneof_w
) != NULL
)
14451 /* Check for match with one of the chars in "sm_oneof". */
14452 while (*pf
!= NUL
&& *pf
!= word
[i
+ k
])
14458 s
= smp
[n
].sm_rules
;
14459 pri
= 5; /* default priority */
14463 while (*s
== '-' && k
> 1)
14470 if (VIM_ISDIGIT(*s
))
14472 /* determine priority */
14476 if (*s
== '^' && *(s
+ 1) == '^')
14481 && (i
== 0 || !(word
[i
- 1] == ' '
14482 || spell_iswordp_w(word
+ i
- 1, curbuf
)))
14483 && (*(s
+ 1) != '$'
14484 || (!spell_iswordp_w(word
+ i
+ k0
, curbuf
))))
14485 || (*s
== '$' && i
> 0
14486 && spell_iswordp_w(word
+ i
- 1, curbuf
)
14487 && (!spell_iswordp_w(word
+ i
+ k0
, curbuf
))))
14489 /* search for followup rules, if: */
14490 /* followup and k > 1 and NO '-' in searchstring */
14491 c0
= word
[i
+ k
- 1];
14492 n0
= slang
->sl_sal_first
[c0
& 0xff];
14494 if (slang
->sl_followup
&& k
> 1 && n0
>= 0
14495 && p0
!= '-' && word
[i
+ k
] != NUL
)
14497 /* Test follow-up rule for "word[i + k]"; loop over
14498 * all entries with the same index byte. */
14499 for ( ; ((ws
= smp
[n0
].sm_lead_w
)[0] & 0xff)
14500 == (c0
& 0xff); ++n0
)
14502 /* Quickly skip entries that don't match the word.
14506 k0
= smp
[n0
].sm_leadlen
;
14509 if (word
[i
+ k
] != ws
[1])
14513 pf
= word
+ i
+ k
+ 1;
14514 for (j
= 2; j
< k0
; ++j
)
14515 if (*pf
++ != ws
[j
])
14523 if ((pf
= smp
[n0
].sm_oneof_w
) != NULL
)
14525 /* Check for match with one of the chars in
14527 while (*pf
!= NUL
&& *pf
!= word
[i
+ k0
])
14535 s
= smp
[n0
].sm_rules
;
14538 /* "k0" gets NOT reduced because
14539 * "if (k0 == k)" */
14544 if (VIM_ISDIGIT(*s
))
14551 /* *s == '^' cuts */
14553 && !spell_iswordp_w(word
+ i
+ k0
,
14557 /* this is just a piece of the string */
14561 /* priority too low */
14563 /* rule fits; stop search */
14568 if (p0
>= pri
&& (smp
[n0
].sm_lead_w
[0] & 0xff)
14573 /* replace string */
14574 ws
= smp
[n
].sm_to_w
;
14575 s
= smp
[n
].sm_rules
;
14576 p0
= (vim_strchr(s
, '<') != NULL
) ? 1 : 0;
14577 if (p0
== 1 && z
== 0)
14579 /* rule with '<' is used */
14580 if (reslen
> 0 && ws
!= NULL
&& *ws
!= NUL
14581 && (wres
[reslen
- 1] == c
14582 || wres
[reslen
- 1] == *ws
))
14588 while (*ws
!= NUL
&& word
[i
+ k0
] != NUL
)
14590 word
[i
+ k0
] = *ws
;
14595 mch_memmove(word
+ i
+ k0
, word
+ i
+ k
,
14596 sizeof(int) * (STRLEN(word
+ i
+ k
) + 1));
14598 /* new "actual letter" */
14603 /* no '<' rule used */
14607 while (*ws
!= NUL
&& ws
[1] != NUL
14608 && reslen
< MAXWLEN
)
14610 if (reslen
== 0 || wres
[reslen
- 1] != *ws
)
14611 wres
[reslen
++] = *ws
;
14614 /* new "actual letter" */
14619 if (strstr((char *)s
, "^^") != NULL
)
14622 wres
[reslen
++] = c
;
14623 mch_memmove(word
, word
+ i
+ 1,
14624 sizeof(int) * (STRLEN(word
+ i
+ 1) + 1));
14633 else if (vim_iswhite(c
))
14641 if (k
&& !p0
&& reslen
< MAXWLEN
&& c
!= NUL
14642 && (!slang
->sl_collapse
|| reslen
== 0
14643 || wres
[reslen
- 1] != c
))
14644 /* condense only double letters */
14645 wres
[reslen
++] = c
;
14653 /* Convert wide characters in "wres" to a multi-byte string in "res". */
14655 for (n
= 0; n
< reslen
; ++n
)
14657 l
+= mb_char2bytes(wres
[n
], res
+ l
);
14658 if (l
+ MB_MAXBYTES
> MAXWLEN
)
14666 * Compute a score for two sound-a-like words.
14667 * This permits up to two inserts/deletes/swaps/etc. to keep things fast.
14668 * Instead of a generic loop we write out the code. That keeps it fast by
14669 * avoiding checks that will not be possible.
14672 soundalike_score(goodstart
, badstart
)
14673 char_u
*goodstart
; /* sound-folded good word */
14674 char_u
*badstart
; /* sound-folded bad word */
14676 char_u
*goodsound
= goodstart
;
14677 char_u
*badsound
= badstart
;
14685 /* adding/inserting "*" at the start (word starts with vowel) shouldn't be
14686 * counted so much, vowels halfway the word aren't counted at all. */
14687 if ((*badsound
== '*' || *goodsound
== '*') && *badsound
!= *goodsound
)
14689 if (badsound
[1] == goodsound
[1]
14690 || (badsound
[1] != NUL
14691 && goodsound
[1] != NUL
14692 && badsound
[2] == goodsound
[2]))
14694 /* handle like a substitute */
14698 score
= 2 * SCORE_DEL
/ 3;
14699 if (*badsound
== '*')
14706 goodlen
= (int)STRLEN(goodsound
);
14707 badlen
= (int)STRLEN(badsound
);
14709 /* Return quickly if the lengths are too different to be fixed by two
14711 n
= goodlen
- badlen
;
14712 if (n
< -2 || n
> 2)
14713 return SCORE_MAXMAX
;
14717 pl
= goodsound
; /* goodsound is longest */
14722 pl
= badsound
; /* badsound is longest */
14726 /* Skip over the identical part. */
14727 while (*pl
== *ps
&& *pl
!= NUL
)
14738 * Must delete two characters from "pl".
14740 ++pl
; /* first delete */
14746 /* strings must be equal after second delete */
14747 if (STRCMP(pl
+ 1, ps
) == 0)
14748 return score
+ SCORE_DEL
* 2;
14750 /* Failed to compare. */
14756 * Minimal one delete from "pl" required.
14762 while (*pl2
== *ps2
)
14764 if (*pl2
== NUL
) /* reached the end */
14765 return score
+ SCORE_DEL
;
14770 /* 2: delete then swap, then rest must be equal */
14771 if (pl2
[0] == ps2
[1] && pl2
[1] == ps2
[0]
14772 && STRCMP(pl2
+ 2, ps2
+ 2) == 0)
14773 return score
+ SCORE_DEL
+ SCORE_SWAP
;
14775 /* 3: delete then substitute, then the rest must be equal */
14776 if (STRCMP(pl2
+ 1, ps2
+ 1) == 0)
14777 return score
+ SCORE_DEL
+ SCORE_SUBST
;
14779 /* 4: first swap then delete */
14780 if (pl
[0] == ps
[1] && pl
[1] == ps
[0])
14782 pl2
= pl
+ 2; /* swap, skip two chars */
14784 while (*pl2
== *ps2
)
14789 /* delete a char and then strings must be equal */
14790 if (STRCMP(pl2
+ 1, ps2
) == 0)
14791 return score
+ SCORE_SWAP
+ SCORE_DEL
;
14794 /* 5: first substitute then delete */
14795 pl2
= pl
+ 1; /* substitute, skip one char */
14797 while (*pl2
== *ps2
)
14802 /* delete a char and then strings must be equal */
14803 if (STRCMP(pl2
+ 1, ps2
) == 0)
14804 return score
+ SCORE_SUBST
+ SCORE_DEL
;
14806 /* Failed to compare. */
14811 * Lenghts are equal, thus changes must result in same length: An
14812 * insert is only possible in combination with a delete.
14813 * 1: check if for identical strings
14819 if (pl
[0] == ps
[1] && pl
[1] == ps
[0])
14821 pl2
= pl
+ 2; /* swap, skip two chars */
14823 while (*pl2
== *ps2
)
14825 if (*pl2
== NUL
) /* reached the end */
14826 return score
+ SCORE_SWAP
;
14830 /* 3: swap and swap again */
14831 if (pl2
[0] == ps2
[1] && pl2
[1] == ps2
[0]
14832 && STRCMP(pl2
+ 2, ps2
+ 2) == 0)
14833 return score
+ SCORE_SWAP
+ SCORE_SWAP
;
14835 /* 4: swap and substitute */
14836 if (STRCMP(pl2
+ 1, ps2
+ 1) == 0)
14837 return score
+ SCORE_SWAP
+ SCORE_SUBST
;
14840 /* 5: substitute */
14843 while (*pl2
== *ps2
)
14845 if (*pl2
== NUL
) /* reached the end */
14846 return score
+ SCORE_SUBST
;
14851 /* 6: substitute and swap */
14852 if (pl2
[0] == ps2
[1] && pl2
[1] == ps2
[0]
14853 && STRCMP(pl2
+ 2, ps2
+ 2) == 0)
14854 return score
+ SCORE_SUBST
+ SCORE_SWAP
;
14856 /* 7: substitute and substitute */
14857 if (STRCMP(pl2
+ 1, ps2
+ 1) == 0)
14858 return score
+ SCORE_SUBST
+ SCORE_SUBST
;
14860 /* 8: insert then delete */
14863 while (*pl2
== *ps2
)
14868 if (STRCMP(pl2
+ 1, ps2
) == 0)
14869 return score
+ SCORE_INS
+ SCORE_DEL
;
14871 /* 9: delete then insert */
14874 while (*pl2
== *ps2
)
14879 if (STRCMP(pl2
, ps2
+ 1) == 0)
14880 return score
+ SCORE_INS
+ SCORE_DEL
;
14882 /* Failed to compare. */
14886 return SCORE_MAXMAX
;
14890 * Compute the "edit distance" to turn "badword" into "goodword". The less
14891 * deletes/inserts/substitutes/swaps are required the lower the score.
14893 * The algorithm is described by Du and Chang, 1992.
14894 * The implementation of the algorithm comes from Aspell editdist.cpp,
14895 * edit_distance(). It has been converted from C++ to C and modified to
14896 * support multi-byte characters.
14899 spell_edit_score(slang
, badword
, goodword
)
14905 int badlen
, goodlen
; /* lengths including NUL */
14912 int wbadword
[MAXWLEN
];
14913 int wgoodword
[MAXWLEN
];
14917 /* Get the characters from the multi-byte strings and put them in an
14918 * int array for easy access. */
14919 for (p
= badword
, badlen
= 0; *p
!= NUL
; )
14920 wbadword
[badlen
++] = mb_cptr2char_adv(&p
);
14921 wbadword
[badlen
++] = 0;
14922 for (p
= goodword
, goodlen
= 0; *p
!= NUL
; )
14923 wgoodword
[goodlen
++] = mb_cptr2char_adv(&p
);
14924 wgoodword
[goodlen
++] = 0;
14929 badlen
= (int)STRLEN(badword
) + 1;
14930 goodlen
= (int)STRLEN(goodword
) + 1;
14933 /* We use "cnt" as an array: CNT(badword_idx, goodword_idx). */
14934 #define CNT(a, b) cnt[(a) + (b) * (badlen + 1)]
14935 cnt
= (int *)lalloc((long_u
)(sizeof(int) * (badlen
+ 1) * (goodlen
+ 1)),
14938 return 0; /* out of memory */
14941 for (j
= 1; j
<= goodlen
; ++j
)
14942 CNT(0, j
) = CNT(0, j
- 1) + SCORE_INS
;
14944 for (i
= 1; i
<= badlen
; ++i
)
14946 CNT(i
, 0) = CNT(i
- 1, 0) + SCORE_DEL
;
14947 for (j
= 1; j
<= goodlen
; ++j
)
14952 bc
= wbadword
[i
- 1];
14953 gc
= wgoodword
[j
- 1];
14958 bc
= badword
[i
- 1];
14959 gc
= goodword
[j
- 1];
14962 CNT(i
, j
) = CNT(i
- 1, j
- 1);
14965 /* Use a better score when there is only a case difference. */
14966 if (SPELL_TOFOLD(bc
) == SPELL_TOFOLD(gc
))
14967 CNT(i
, j
) = SCORE_ICASE
+ CNT(i
- 1, j
- 1);
14970 /* For a similar character use SCORE_SIMILAR. */
14972 && slang
->sl_has_map
14973 && similar_chars(slang
, gc
, bc
))
14974 CNT(i
, j
) = SCORE_SIMILAR
+ CNT(i
- 1, j
- 1);
14976 CNT(i
, j
) = SCORE_SUBST
+ CNT(i
- 1, j
- 1);
14979 if (i
> 1 && j
> 1)
14984 pbc
= wbadword
[i
- 2];
14985 pgc
= wgoodword
[j
- 2];
14990 pbc
= badword
[i
- 2];
14991 pgc
= goodword
[j
- 2];
14993 if (bc
== pgc
&& pbc
== gc
)
14995 t
= SCORE_SWAP
+ CNT(i
- 2, j
- 2);
15000 t
= SCORE_DEL
+ CNT(i
- 1, j
);
15003 t
= SCORE_INS
+ CNT(i
, j
- 1);
15010 i
= CNT(badlen
- 1, goodlen
- 1);
15023 * Like spell_edit_score(), but with a limit on the score to make it faster.
15024 * May return SCORE_MAXMAX when the score is higher than "limit".
15026 * This uses a stack for the edits still to be tried.
15027 * The idea comes from Aspell leditdist.cpp. Rewritten in C and added support
15028 * for multi-byte characters.
15031 spell_edit_score_limit(slang
, badword
, goodword
, limit
)
15037 limitscore_T stack
[10]; /* allow for over 3 * 2 edits */
15048 /* Multi-byte characters require a bit more work, use a different function
15049 * to avoid testing "has_mbyte" quite often. */
15051 return spell_edit_score_limit_w(slang
, badword
, goodword
, limit
);
15055 * The idea is to go from start to end over the words. So long as
15056 * characters are equal just continue, this always gives the lowest score.
15057 * When there is a difference try several alternatives. Each alternative
15058 * increases "score" for the edit distance. Some of the alternatives are
15059 * pushed unto a stack and tried later, some are tried right away. At the
15060 * end of the word the score for one alternative is known. The lowest
15061 * possible score is stored in "minscore".
15067 minscore
= limit
+ 1;
15071 /* Skip over an equal part, score remains the same. */
15076 if (bc
!= gc
) /* stop at a char that's different */
15078 if (bc
== NUL
) /* both words end */
15080 if (score
< minscore
)
15082 goto pop
; /* do next alternative */
15088 if (gc
== NUL
) /* goodword ends, delete badword chars */
15092 if ((score
+= SCORE_DEL
) >= minscore
)
15093 goto pop
; /* do next alternative */
15094 } while (badword
[++bi
] != NUL
);
15097 else if (bc
== NUL
) /* badword ends, insert badword chars */
15101 if ((score
+= SCORE_INS
) >= minscore
)
15102 goto pop
; /* do next alternative */
15103 } while (goodword
[++gi
] != NUL
);
15106 else /* both words continue */
15108 /* If not close to the limit, perform a change. Only try changes
15109 * that may lead to a lower score than "minscore".
15110 * round 0: try deleting a char from badword
15111 * round 1: try inserting a char in badword */
15112 for (round
= 0; round
<= 1; ++round
)
15114 score_off
= score
+ (round
== 0 ? SCORE_DEL
: SCORE_INS
);
15115 if (score_off
< minscore
)
15117 if (score_off
+ SCORE_EDIT_MIN
>= minscore
)
15119 /* Near the limit, rest of the words must match. We
15120 * can check that right now, no need to push an item
15121 * onto the stack. */
15122 bi2
= bi
+ 1 - round
;
15124 while (goodword
[gi2
] == badword
[bi2
])
15126 if (goodword
[gi2
] == NUL
)
15128 minscore
= score_off
;
15137 /* try deleting/inserting a character later */
15138 stack
[stackidx
].badi
= bi
+ 1 - round
;
15139 stack
[stackidx
].goodi
= gi
+ round
;
15140 stack
[stackidx
].score
= score_off
;
15146 if (score
+ SCORE_SWAP
< minscore
)
15148 /* If swapping two characters makes a match then the
15149 * substitution is more expensive, thus there is no need to
15151 if (gc
== badword
[bi
+ 1] && bc
== goodword
[gi
+ 1])
15153 /* Swap two characters, that is: skip them. */
15156 score
+= SCORE_SWAP
;
15161 /* Substitute one character for another which is the same
15162 * thing as deleting a character from both goodword and badword.
15163 * Use a better score when there is only a case difference. */
15164 if (SPELL_TOFOLD(bc
) == SPELL_TOFOLD(gc
))
15165 score
+= SCORE_ICASE
;
15168 /* For a similar character use SCORE_SIMILAR. */
15170 && slang
->sl_has_map
15171 && similar_chars(slang
, gc
, bc
))
15172 score
+= SCORE_SIMILAR
;
15174 score
+= SCORE_SUBST
;
15177 if (score
< minscore
)
15179 /* Do the substitution. */
15187 * Get here to try the next alternative, pop it from the stack.
15189 if (stackidx
== 0) /* stack is empty, finished */
15192 /* pop an item from the stack */
15194 gi
= stack
[stackidx
].goodi
;
15195 bi
= stack
[stackidx
].badi
;
15196 score
= stack
[stackidx
].score
;
15199 /* When the score goes over "limit" it may actually be much higher.
15200 * Return a very large number to avoid going below the limit when giving a
15202 if (minscore
> limit
)
15203 return SCORE_MAXMAX
;
15209 * Multi-byte version of spell_edit_score_limit().
15210 * Keep it in sync with the above!
15213 spell_edit_score_limit_w(slang
, badword
, goodword
, limit
)
15219 limitscore_T stack
[10]; /* allow for over 3 * 2 edits */
15229 int wbadword
[MAXWLEN
];
15230 int wgoodword
[MAXWLEN
];
15232 /* Get the characters from the multi-byte strings and put them in an
15233 * int array for easy access. */
15235 for (p
= badword
; *p
!= NUL
; )
15236 wbadword
[bi
++] = mb_cptr2char_adv(&p
);
15237 wbadword
[bi
++] = 0;
15239 for (p
= goodword
; *p
!= NUL
; )
15240 wgoodword
[gi
++] = mb_cptr2char_adv(&p
);
15241 wgoodword
[gi
++] = 0;
15244 * The idea is to go from start to end over the words. So long as
15245 * characters are equal just continue, this always gives the lowest score.
15246 * When there is a difference try several alternatives. Each alternative
15247 * increases "score" for the edit distance. Some of the alternatives are
15248 * pushed unto a stack and tried later, some are tried right away. At the
15249 * end of the word the score for one alternative is known. The lowest
15250 * possible score is stored in "minscore".
15256 minscore
= limit
+ 1;
15260 /* Skip over an equal part, score remains the same. */
15264 gc
= wgoodword
[gi
];
15266 if (bc
!= gc
) /* stop at a char that's different */
15268 if (bc
== NUL
) /* both words end */
15270 if (score
< minscore
)
15272 goto pop
; /* do next alternative */
15278 if (gc
== NUL
) /* goodword ends, delete badword chars */
15282 if ((score
+= SCORE_DEL
) >= minscore
)
15283 goto pop
; /* do next alternative */
15284 } while (wbadword
[++bi
] != NUL
);
15287 else if (bc
== NUL
) /* badword ends, insert badword chars */
15291 if ((score
+= SCORE_INS
) >= minscore
)
15292 goto pop
; /* do next alternative */
15293 } while (wgoodword
[++gi
] != NUL
);
15296 else /* both words continue */
15298 /* If not close to the limit, perform a change. Only try changes
15299 * that may lead to a lower score than "minscore".
15300 * round 0: try deleting a char from badword
15301 * round 1: try inserting a char in badword */
15302 for (round
= 0; round
<= 1; ++round
)
15304 score_off
= score
+ (round
== 0 ? SCORE_DEL
: SCORE_INS
);
15305 if (score_off
< minscore
)
15307 if (score_off
+ SCORE_EDIT_MIN
>= minscore
)
15309 /* Near the limit, rest of the words must match. We
15310 * can check that right now, no need to push an item
15311 * onto the stack. */
15312 bi2
= bi
+ 1 - round
;
15314 while (wgoodword
[gi2
] == wbadword
[bi2
])
15316 if (wgoodword
[gi2
] == NUL
)
15318 minscore
= score_off
;
15327 /* try deleting a character from badword later */
15328 stack
[stackidx
].badi
= bi
+ 1 - round
;
15329 stack
[stackidx
].goodi
= gi
+ round
;
15330 stack
[stackidx
].score
= score_off
;
15336 if (score
+ SCORE_SWAP
< minscore
)
15338 /* If swapping two characters makes a match then the
15339 * substitution is more expensive, thus there is no need to
15341 if (gc
== wbadword
[bi
+ 1] && bc
== wgoodword
[gi
+ 1])
15343 /* Swap two characters, that is: skip them. */
15346 score
+= SCORE_SWAP
;
15351 /* Substitute one character for another which is the same
15352 * thing as deleting a character from both goodword and badword.
15353 * Use a better score when there is only a case difference. */
15354 if (SPELL_TOFOLD(bc
) == SPELL_TOFOLD(gc
))
15355 score
+= SCORE_ICASE
;
15358 /* For a similar character use SCORE_SIMILAR. */
15360 && slang
->sl_has_map
15361 && similar_chars(slang
, gc
, bc
))
15362 score
+= SCORE_SIMILAR
;
15364 score
+= SCORE_SUBST
;
15367 if (score
< minscore
)
15369 /* Do the substitution. */
15377 * Get here to try the next alternative, pop it from the stack.
15379 if (stackidx
== 0) /* stack is empty, finished */
15382 /* pop an item from the stack */
15384 gi
= stack
[stackidx
].goodi
;
15385 bi
= stack
[stackidx
].badi
;
15386 score
= stack
[stackidx
].score
;
15389 /* When the score goes over "limit" it may actually be much higher.
15390 * Return a very large number to avoid going below the limit when giving a
15392 if (minscore
> limit
)
15393 return SCORE_MAXMAX
;
15410 if (no_spell_checking(curwin
))
15414 for (lpi
= 0; lpi
< curbuf
->b_langp
.ga_len
&& !got_int
; ++lpi
)
15416 lp
= LANGP_ENTRY(curbuf
->b_langp
, lpi
);
15417 msg_puts((char_u
*)"file: ");
15418 msg_puts(lp
->lp_slang
->sl_fname
);
15420 p
= lp
->lp_slang
->sl_info
;
15430 #define DUMPFLAG_KEEPCASE 1 /* round 2: keep-case tree */
15431 #define DUMPFLAG_COUNT 2 /* include word count */
15432 #define DUMPFLAG_ICASE 4 /* ignore case when finding matches */
15433 #define DUMPFLAG_ONECAP 8 /* pattern starts with capital */
15434 #define DUMPFLAG_ALLCAP 16 /* pattern is all capitals */
15443 buf_T
*buf
= curbuf
;
15445 if (no_spell_checking(curwin
))
15448 /* Create a new empty buffer by splitting the window. */
15449 do_cmdline_cmd((char_u
*)"new");
15450 if (!bufempty() || !buf_valid(buf
))
15453 spell_dump_compl(buf
, NULL
, 0, NULL
, eap
->forceit
? DUMPFLAG_COUNT
: 0);
15455 /* Delete the empty line that we started with. */
15456 if (curbuf
->b_ml
.ml_line_count
> 1)
15457 ml_delete(curbuf
->b_ml
.ml_line_count
, FALSE
);
15459 redraw_later(NOT_VALID
);
15463 * Go through all possible words and:
15464 * 1. When "pat" is NULL: dump a list of all words in the current buffer.
15465 * "ic" and "dir" are not used.
15466 * 2. When "pat" is not NULL: add matching words to insert mode completion.
15469 spell_dump_compl(buf
, pat
, ic
, dir
, dumpflags_arg
)
15470 buf_T
*buf
; /* buffer with spell checking */
15471 char_u
*pat
; /* leading part of the word */
15472 int ic
; /* ignore case */
15473 int *dir
; /* direction for adding matches */
15474 int dumpflags_arg
; /* DUMPFLAG_* */
15478 idx_T arridx
[MAXWLEN
];
15480 char_u word
[MAXWLEN
];
15489 char_u
*region_names
= NULL
; /* region names being used */
15490 int do_region
= TRUE
; /* dump region names and numbers */
15493 int dumpflags
= dumpflags_arg
;
15496 /* When ignoring case or when the pattern starts with capital pass this on
15497 * to dump_word(). */
15501 dumpflags
|= DUMPFLAG_ICASE
;
15504 n
= captype(pat
, NULL
);
15505 if (n
== WF_ONECAP
)
15506 dumpflags
|= DUMPFLAG_ONECAP
;
15507 else if (n
== WF_ALLCAP
15509 && (int)STRLEN(pat
) > mb_ptr2len(pat
)
15511 && (int)STRLEN(pat
) > 1
15514 dumpflags
|= DUMPFLAG_ALLCAP
;
15518 /* Find out if we can support regions: All languages must support the same
15519 * regions or none at all. */
15520 for (lpi
= 0; lpi
< buf
->b_langp
.ga_len
; ++lpi
)
15522 lp
= LANGP_ENTRY(buf
->b_langp
, lpi
);
15523 p
= lp
->lp_slang
->sl_regions
;
15526 if (region_names
== NULL
) /* first language with regions */
15528 else if (STRCMP(region_names
, p
) != 0)
15530 do_region
= FALSE
; /* region names are different */
15536 if (do_region
&& region_names
!= NULL
)
15540 vim_snprintf((char *)IObuff
, IOSIZE
, "/regions=%s", region_names
);
15541 ml_append(lnum
++, IObuff
, (colnr_T
)0, FALSE
);
15548 * Loop over all files loaded for the entries in 'spelllang'.
15550 for (lpi
= 0; lpi
< buf
->b_langp
.ga_len
; ++lpi
)
15552 lp
= LANGP_ENTRY(buf
->b_langp
, lpi
);
15553 slang
= lp
->lp_slang
;
15554 if (slang
->sl_fbyts
== NULL
) /* reloading failed */
15559 vim_snprintf((char *)IObuff
, IOSIZE
, "# file: %s", slang
->sl_fname
);
15560 ml_append(lnum
++, IObuff
, (colnr_T
)0, FALSE
);
15563 /* When matching with a pattern and there are no prefixes only use
15564 * parts of the tree that match "pat". */
15565 if (pat
!= NULL
&& slang
->sl_pbyts
== NULL
)
15566 patlen
= (int)STRLEN(pat
);
15570 /* round 1: case-folded tree
15571 * round 2: keep-case tree */
15572 for (round
= 1; round
<= 2; ++round
)
15576 dumpflags
&= ~DUMPFLAG_KEEPCASE
;
15577 byts
= slang
->sl_fbyts
;
15578 idxs
= slang
->sl_fidxs
;
15582 dumpflags
|= DUMPFLAG_KEEPCASE
;
15583 byts
= slang
->sl_kbyts
;
15584 idxs
= slang
->sl_kidxs
;
15587 continue; /* array is empty */
15592 while (depth
>= 0 && !got_int
15593 && (pat
== NULL
|| !compl_interrupted
))
15595 if (curi
[depth
] > byts
[arridx
[depth
]])
15597 /* Done all bytes at this node, go up one level. */
15600 ins_compl_check_keys(50);
15604 /* Do one more byte at this node. */
15605 n
= arridx
[depth
] + curi
[depth
];
15610 /* End of word, deal with the word.
15611 * Don't use keep-case words in the fold-case tree,
15612 * they will appear in the keep-case tree.
15613 * Only use the word when the region matches. */
15614 flags
= (int)idxs
[n
];
15615 if ((round
== 2 || (flags
& WF_KEEPCAP
) == 0)
15616 && (flags
& WF_NEEDCOMP
) == 0
15618 || (flags
& WF_REGION
) == 0
15619 || (((unsigned)flags
>> 16)
15620 & lp
->lp_region
) != 0))
15624 flags
&= ~WF_REGION
;
15626 /* Dump the basic word if there is no prefix or
15627 * when it's the first one. */
15628 c
= (unsigned)flags
>> 24;
15629 if (c
== 0 || curi
[depth
] == 2)
15631 dump_word(slang
, word
, pat
, dir
,
15632 dumpflags
, flags
, lnum
);
15637 /* Apply the prefix, if there is one. */
15639 lnum
= dump_prefixes(slang
, word
, pat
, dir
,
15640 dumpflags
, flags
, lnum
);
15645 /* Normal char, go one level deeper. */
15647 arridx
[depth
] = idxs
[n
];
15650 /* Check if this characters matches with the pattern.
15651 * If not skip the whole tree below it.
15652 * Always ignore case here, dump_word() will check
15653 * proper case later. This isn't exactly right when
15654 * length changes for multi-byte characters with
15655 * ignore case... */
15656 if (depth
<= patlen
15657 && MB_STRNICMP(word
, pat
, depth
) != 0)
15667 * Dump one word: apply case modifications and append a line to the buffer.
15668 * When "lnum" is zero add insert mode completion.
15671 dump_word(slang
, word
, pat
, dir
, dumpflags
, wordflags
, lnum
)
15680 int keepcap
= FALSE
;
15683 char_u cword
[MAXWLEN
];
15684 char_u badword
[MAXWLEN
+ 10];
15686 int flags
= wordflags
;
15688 if (dumpflags
& DUMPFLAG_ONECAP
)
15689 flags
|= WF_ONECAP
;
15690 if (dumpflags
& DUMPFLAG_ALLCAP
)
15691 flags
|= WF_ALLCAP
;
15693 if ((dumpflags
& DUMPFLAG_KEEPCASE
) == 0 && (flags
& WF_CAPMASK
) != 0)
15695 /* Need to fix case according to "flags". */
15696 make_case_word(word
, cword
, flags
);
15702 if ((dumpflags
& DUMPFLAG_KEEPCASE
)
15703 && ((captype(word
, NULL
) & WF_KEEPCAP
) == 0
15704 || (flags
& WF_FIXCAP
) != 0))
15711 /* Add flags and regions after a slash. */
15712 if ((flags
& (WF_BANNED
| WF_RARE
| WF_REGION
)) || keepcap
)
15714 STRCPY(badword
, p
);
15715 STRCAT(badword
, "/");
15717 STRCAT(badword
, "=");
15718 if (flags
& WF_BANNED
)
15719 STRCAT(badword
, "!");
15720 else if (flags
& WF_RARE
)
15721 STRCAT(badword
, "?");
15722 if (flags
& WF_REGION
)
15723 for (i
= 0; i
< 7; ++i
)
15724 if (flags
& (0x10000 << i
))
15725 sprintf((char *)badword
+ STRLEN(badword
), "%d", i
+ 1);
15729 if (dumpflags
& DUMPFLAG_COUNT
)
15733 /* Include the word count for ":spelldump!". */
15734 hi
= hash_find(&slang
->sl_wordcount
, tw
);
15735 if (!HASHITEM_EMPTY(hi
))
15737 vim_snprintf((char *)IObuff
, IOSIZE
, "%s\t%d",
15738 tw
, HI2WC(hi
)->wc_count
);
15743 ml_append(lnum
, p
, (colnr_T
)0, FALSE
);
15745 else if (((dumpflags
& DUMPFLAG_ICASE
)
15746 ? MB_STRNICMP(p
, pat
, STRLEN(pat
)) == 0
15747 : STRNCMP(p
, pat
, STRLEN(pat
)) == 0)
15748 && ins_compl_add_infercase(p
, (int)STRLEN(p
),
15749 p_ic
, NULL
, *dir
, 0) == OK
)
15750 /* if dir was BACKWARD then honor it just once */
15755 * For ":spelldump": Find matching prefixes for "word". Prepend each to
15756 * "word" and append a line to the buffer.
15757 * When "lnum" is zero add insert mode completion.
15758 * Return the updated line number.
15761 dump_prefixes(slang
, word
, pat
, dir
, dumpflags
, flags
, startlnum
)
15763 char_u
*word
; /* case-folded word */
15767 int flags
; /* flags with prefix ID */
15768 linenr_T startlnum
;
15770 idx_T arridx
[MAXWLEN
];
15772 char_u prefix
[MAXWLEN
];
15773 char_u word_up
[MAXWLEN
];
15774 int has_word_up
= FALSE
;
15778 linenr_T lnum
= startlnum
;
15784 /* If the word starts with a lower-case letter make the word with an
15785 * upper-case letter in word_up[]. */
15786 c
= PTR2CHAR(word
);
15787 if (SPELL_TOUPPER(c
) != c
)
15789 onecap_copy(word
, word_up
, TRUE
);
15790 has_word_up
= TRUE
;
15793 byts
= slang
->sl_pbyts
;
15794 idxs
= slang
->sl_pidxs
;
15795 if (byts
!= NULL
) /* array not is empty */
15798 * Loop over all prefixes, building them byte-by-byte in prefix[].
15799 * When at the end of a prefix check that it supports "flags".
15804 while (depth
>= 0 && !got_int
)
15808 if (curi
[depth
] > len
)
15810 /* Done all bytes at this node, go up one level. */
15816 /* Do one more byte at this node. */
15822 /* End of prefix, find out how many IDs there are. */
15823 for (i
= 1; i
< len
; ++i
)
15824 if (byts
[n
+ i
] != 0)
15826 curi
[depth
] += i
- 1;
15828 c
= valid_word_prefix(i
, n
, flags
, word
, slang
, FALSE
);
15831 vim_strncpy(prefix
+ depth
, word
, MAXWLEN
- depth
- 1);
15832 dump_word(slang
, prefix
, pat
, dir
, dumpflags
,
15833 (c
& WF_RAREPFX
) ? (flags
| WF_RARE
)
15839 /* Check for prefix that matches the word when the
15840 * first letter is upper-case, but only if the prefix has
15844 c
= valid_word_prefix(i
, n
, flags
, word_up
, slang
,
15848 vim_strncpy(prefix
+ depth
, word_up
,
15849 MAXWLEN
- depth
- 1);
15850 dump_word(slang
, prefix
, pat
, dir
, dumpflags
,
15851 (c
& WF_RAREPFX
) ? (flags
| WF_RARE
)
15860 /* Normal char, go one level deeper. */
15861 prefix
[depth
++] = c
;
15862 arridx
[depth
] = idxs
[n
];
15873 * Move "p" to the end of word "start".
15874 * Uses the spell-checking word characters.
15877 spell_to_word_end(start
, buf
)
15883 while (*p
!= NUL
&& spell_iswordp(p
, buf
))
15888 #if defined(FEAT_INS_EXPAND) || defined(PROTO)
15890 * For Insert mode completion CTRL-X s:
15891 * Find start of the word in front of column "startcol".
15892 * We don't check if it is badly spelled, with completion we can only change
15893 * the word in front of the cursor.
15894 * Returns the column number of the word.
15897 spell_word_start(startcol
)
15904 if (no_spell_checking(curwin
))
15907 /* Find a word character before "startcol". */
15908 line
= ml_get_curline();
15909 for (p
= line
+ startcol
; p
> line
; )
15911 mb_ptr_back(line
, p
);
15912 if (spell_iswordp_nmw(p
))
15916 /* Go back to start of the word. */
15919 col
= (int)(p
- line
);
15920 mb_ptr_back(line
, p
);
15921 if (!spell_iswordp(p
, curbuf
))
15930 * Need to check for 'spellcapcheck' now, the word is removed before
15931 * expand_spelling() is called. Therefore the ugly global variable.
15933 static int spell_expand_need_cap
;
15936 spell_expand_check_cap(col
)
15939 spell_expand_need_cap
= check_need_cap(curwin
->w_cursor
.lnum
, col
);
15943 * Get list of spelling suggestions.
15944 * Used for Insert mode completion CTRL-X ?.
15945 * Returns the number of matches. The matches are in "matchp[]", array of
15946 * allocated strings.
15950 expand_spelling(lnum
, col
, pat
, matchp
)
15958 spell_suggest_list(&ga
, pat
, 100, spell_expand_need_cap
, TRUE
);
15959 *matchp
= ga
.ga_data
;
15964 #endif /* FEAT_SPELL */